Attached files

file filename
EX-32.3 - EX-32.3 - First Eagle Alternative Capital BDC, Inc.d854678dex323.htm
EX-31.3 - EX-31.3 - First Eagle Alternative Capital BDC, Inc.d854678dex313.htm
EX-31.2 - EX-31.2 - First Eagle Alternative Capital BDC, Inc.d854678dex312.htm
EX-31.1 - EX-31.1 - First Eagle Alternative Capital BDC, Inc.d854678dex311.htm
EX-10.17 - EX-10.17 - First Eagle Alternative Capital BDC, Inc.d854678dex1017.htm
EX-32.2 - EX-32.2 - First Eagle Alternative Capital BDC, Inc.d854678dex322.htm
EX-10.23 - EX-10.23 - First Eagle Alternative Capital BDC, Inc.d854678dex1023.htm
EX-32.1 - EX-32.1 - First Eagle Alternative Capital BDC, Inc.d854678dex321.htm
Table of Contents

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

WASHINGTON, DC 20549

 

 

FORM 10-K

 

 

(Mark One)

x ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934.

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014

OR

 

¨ TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934.

For the transition period from             to             

Commission file number 814-00789

 

 

THL CREDIT, INC.

(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Its Charter)

 

 

 

Delaware   27-0344947

(State or Other Jurisdiction of

Incorporation or Organization)

 

(I.R.S. Employer

Identification No.)

100 Federal St., 31st Floor, Boston, MA   02110
(Address of Principal Executive Offices)   (Zip Code)

Registrant’s Telephone Number, Including Area Code: 800-450-4424

Securities registered pursuant to 12(b) of the Act:

 

Title of Each Class

 

Name of Each Exchange on Which Registered

Common Stock, par value $0.001 per share

  NASDAQ Global Select Market

6.75% Senior Notes due 2021

  The New York Stock Exchange

Securities registered pursuant to 12(g) of the Act:

None.

 

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.    Yes  ¨    No  x

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.    Yes  ¨    No  x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    Yes  x    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).    Yes  ¨    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of the Registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.    ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

 

Large accelerated filer

  ¨     Accelerated filer   x

Non-Accelerated filer

  ¨  

(Do not check if a smaller reporting company)

  Smaller reporting company   ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934).    Yes  ¨    No  x

The aggregate market value of common stock held by non-affiliates of the Registrant as of the last business day of the Registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter was approximately $474.7 million based on the closing price on that date of $14.00 on the NASDAQ Global Select Market. For the purposes of calculating this amount only, all directors and executive officers of the Registrant have been treated as affiliates.

As of March 10, 2015, there were 33,905,202 shares of the Registrant’s common stock outstanding.

Documents Incorporated by Reference

Portions of the Registrant’s definitive Proxy Statement relating to its 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A with the Securities and Exchange Commission, are incorporated by reference into Part III of this Annual Report on Form 10-K as indicated herein.

 

 

 

 


Table of Contents

THL CREDIT, INC.

FORM 10-K FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2014

Table of Contents

 

PART I   
Item 1.   

Business

     3   
Item 1A.   

Risk Factors

     34   
Item 1B.   

Unresolved Staff Comments

     60   
Item 2.   

Properties

     60   
Item 3.   

Legal proceedings

     60   
Item 4.   

Mine Safety Disclosures

     60   
PART II   
Item 5.   

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

     61   
Item 6.   

Selected Financial Data

     65   
Item 7.   

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

     67   
Item 7A.   

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

     104   
Item 8.   

Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

     105   
Item 9.   

Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

     156   
Item 9A.   

Controls and Procedures

     156   
Item 9B.   

Other Information

     157   
PART III   
Item 10.   

Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

     158   
Item 11.   

Executive Compensation

     158   
Item 12.   

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

     158   
Item 13.   

Certain Relationships and Related Transactions and Director Independence

     158   
Item 14.   

Principal Accountant Fees and Services

     158   
PART IV   
Item 15.   

Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

     159   
Signatures         162   

 

2


Table of Contents

PART I

In this annual report on Form 10-K, except where the context suggests otherwise, the terms “we,” “us,” “our” and “THL Credit” refer to THL Credit, Inc.; “THL Credit Advisors,” the “Advisor” or the “Administrator” refers to THL Credit Advisors LLC; “Greenway” refers to THL Credit Greenway Fund LLC; “Greenway II” refers to THL Credit Greenway Fund II LLC and related investment vehicle; “THL Credit Opportunities” refers to THL Credit Opportunities, L.P.; “BDC Holdings” refers to THL Credit Partners BDC Holdings, L.P.; “Logan JV” refers to THL Credit Logan JV LLC. Some of the statements in this annual report constitute forward-looking statements, which relate to future events, future performance or financial condition. These forward-looking statements involve risk and uncertainties and actual results could differ materially from those projected in the forward-looking statements for any reason, including those factors discussed in “Risk Factors” and elsewhere in this report.

 

Item 1. Business

THL Credit, Inc.

We are an externally managed, non-diversified closed-end management investment company incorporated in Delaware on May 26, 2009, that has elected to be regulated as a business development company, or BDC, under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, or the 1940 Act. In addition, we have elected to be treated for tax purposes as a regulated investment company, or RIC, under Subchapter M of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, or the Code. Our investment activities are managed by THL Credit Advisors and supervised by our board of directors, a majority of whom are independent of THL Credit Advisors and its affiliates. As a BDC, we are required to comply with certain regulatory requirements. See “-Business Development Company Regulations” for discussion of BDC regulation and other regulatory considerations. We are also registered as an investment adviser under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, as amended, or the Advisers Act.

Our investment objective is to generate both current income and capital appreciation, primarily through investments in privately negotiated debt and equity securities of middle market companies. We are a direct lender to middle-market companies and invest in first lien and second lien loans, including through unitranche investments, as well as subordinated debt, which may include an associated equity component such as warrants, preferred stock or similar securities. In certain instances, we will also make direct equity investments and may also selectively invest in the residual interests, or equity, of collateralized loan obligations, or CLOs. We may also provide advisory services to managed funds.

We define middle market companies to mean both public and privately-held companies with annual revenues of between $25 million and $500 million. We expect to generate returns through a combination of contractual interest payments on debt investments, equity appreciation (through options, warrants, conversion rights or direct equity investments) and origination and similar fees. We can offer no assurances that we will achieve our investment objective.

Since April 2010, after we completed our initial public offering and commenced principal operations, we have been responsible for making, on behalf of ourselves, managed funds and separately managed account, over approximately an aggregate $1,542 million in commitments to 79 separate portfolio companies through a combination of both initial and follow-on investments. Since April 2010, we, along with our managed funds and separately managed account, have received $783.8 million from paydowns and sales of investments. The Company alone has received $544.8 million from paydowns and sales of investments.

As a BDC, we are required to comply with certain regulatory requirements. See “-Business Development Company Regulations” for discussion of BDC regulation and other regulatory considerations. We are generally required to invest at least 70% of our total assets primarily in securities of private and certain U.S. public companies (other than certain financial institutions), cash, cash equivalents and U.S. government securities and other high quality debt investments that mature in one year or less.

 

3


Table of Contents

We are permitted to borrow money from time to time within the levels permitted by the 1940 Act (which generally allows us to incur leverage for up to one half of our assets). We have used, and expect to continue to use, our credit facilities and other borrowings, along with proceeds from the rotation of our portfolio and proceeds from public and private offerings of securities to finance our investment objectives. See “-Business Development Company Regulations” for discussion of BDC regulation and other regulatory considerations.

Organizational Overview

The Company was organized as a Delaware corporation on May 26, 2009 and initially funded on July 23, 2009. We commenced principal operations on April 21, 2010. The Company has formed wholly owned subsidiaries which serve as tax blockers, including THL Credit Holdings, Inc., THL Credit AIM Media Holdings, Inc. and THL Credit YP Holdings, Inc., and hold equity or equity-like investments in portfolio companies organized as limited liability companies or other forms of pass-through entities. The Company also has formed wholly owned subsidiaries which serve as the administrative agents on certain investment transactions, including THL Corporate Finance, Inc. and THL Corporate Finance, LLC.

 

LOGO

 

(1) 

THL Credit Advisors LLC is owned and controlled by certain of the THL Credit Investment Principals (defined below) and a partnership consisting of certain of the partners of THL Partners (defined below).

(2) 

THL Credit SLS Senior Loan Strategies LLC, a majority-owned subsidiary of THL Credit Advisors, focuses principally on broadly syndicated senior loans.

(3) 

Greenway I is an investment fund with $150 million of capital committed by affiliates of a single institutional investor, together with a nominal amount committed by the Company, all of which has been paid in and invested by Greenway I, which is managed by us.

(4) 

Greenway II is an investment fund and, together with a related vehicle, has $187 million of capital committed by third party investors, together with a nominal amount committed by the Company, which is managed by us.

THL Credit Advisors LLC

Our investment activities are managed by our investment adviser, THL Credit Advisors. THL Credit Advisors is responsible for sourcing potential investments, conducting research on prospective investments, analyzing investment opportunities, structuring our investments, and monitoring our investments and portfolio

 

4


Table of Contents

companies on an ongoing basis. We pay THL Credit Advisors a management fee as a percentage of our gross assets and incentive fees as a percentage of our ordinary income and capital gains.

THL Credit Advisors was formed as a Delaware limited liability company on June 26, 2009 and is registered as an investment adviser under the Advisers Act. THL Credit Advisors is an alternative credit investment manager for both direct lending and tradable credit investments through public and private vehicles, commingled funds including collateralized loan obligations, and separately managed accounts. THL Credit Advisors and its credit-focused affiliates managed assets of $4.8 billion as of December 31, 2014 across its two primary investment platforms: Direct Lending and Tradable Credit.

THL Credit Advisors benefits from a scaled and integrated business that draws on a diverse resource base and the credit and industry expertise of the entire platform. Fundamental credit analysis, rigorous and disciplined underwriting, well-structured investments and ongoing monitoring are the hallmarks of its credit culture.

THL Credit Advisors’ Direct Lending platform invests in first and second lien loans, including unitranche investments, as well as subordinated debt, which may include an associated equity component such as warrants, preferred stock or other similar securities. Direct Lending investments are made through us.

THL Credit Advisors’ Tradable Credit platform manages investments in secured bank loans, structured credit and high-yield securities through CLOs, separate accounts, sub-advisory and various fund formats, including THL Credit Senior Loan Fund (NYSE: TSLF) (“TSLF”), a non-diversified, closed-end management investment company. The Advisor maintains a variety of advisory or sub-advisory relationships across its investment platform. For example the Advisor may serve as an investment adviser to one or more private funds or registered closed-end funds and presently serves as an investment adviser to CLOs, THL Credit Wind River 2013-2 CLO, Ltd., THL Credit Wind River 2014-1 CLO, Ltd., THL Credit Wind River 2014-2 CLO, Ltd., and a subadviser to a closed-end fund, THL Credit Senior Loan Fund (NYSE: TSLF). See “-Material Conflicts of Interest” for information regarding the allocation of investment opportunities.

THL Credit Advisors is headquartered in Boston, with additional investment teams in Chicago, Houston, Los Angeles and New York, allowing it to be close to its portfolio companies as well as its origination and syndication sources. Over the years, THL Credit Advisors has developed deep and diverse national relationships that it leverages to maximize investment opportunities across its platforms.

THL Credit Advisors is led by Sam W. Tillinghast, Christopher J. Flynn, W. Hunter Stropp, Terrence W. Olson and Stephanie Paré Sullivan, who constitute its principals (collectively, “THL Credit Principals”). THL Credit Advisor’s Direct Lending investment committee is comprised of Messrs. Tillinghast, Flynn and Stropp (the “Investment Principals”).

THL Credit Advisors is owned and controlled by the THL Credit Principals and a partnership consisting of certain of the partners of THL Partners. The Investment Principals have worked together over the past seven years at THL Credit Advisors and its predecessor, and together with their prior investment experiences, have invested through multiple business and credit cycles across the entire capital structure. We believe the Investment Principals bring a unique investment perspective and skill set by virtue of their complementary, collective experience as both debt and equity investors. In addition, we believe they bring an active equity ownership mentality and intend to focus on adding value to portfolio companies through board representation, when possible, active monitoring and direct dialogue with management.

THL Credit Advisors also serves as our Administrator and leases office space to us and provides us with equipment and office services. The tasks of the Administrator include overseeing our financial records, preparing reports to our stockholders and reports filed with the SEC and generally monitoring the payment of our expenses and the performance of administrative and professional services rendered to us by others.

 

5


Table of Contents

Thomas H. Lee Partners, L.P. (“THL Partners”)

Founded in 1974, THL Partners is a leading private equity firm based in Boston, MA. THL Partners focuses on identifying and obtaining substantial ownership positions in large growth-oriented companies where it can add managerial and strategic expertise to create value for its partners. As one of the oldest and most experienced private equity firms, THL Partners has raised approximately $20 billion of equity capital and invested in more than 100 businesses with an aggregate purchase price of more than $150 billion. THL Partners seeks to build companies of lasting value while generating superior returns for its investors and operating partners. We believe we benefit from THL Credit Advisors’ relationship with THL Partners. THL Credit Advisors has access to the contacts and industry knowledge of THL Partners’ investment team to enhance its transaction sourcing capabilities and consults with the THL Partners team on specific industry issues, trends and other matters to complement our investment process.

Investment Approach

Our investment approach consists of the following four separate and distinct phases: (1) sourcing; (2) selecting; (3) structuring; and (4) supervising investments. Sourcing involves our efforts to generate as vast a universe of relevant and actionable investment opportunities as possible. Selecting represents our decision-making process regarding which of those investments to pursue. Structuring summarizes our creative approach to deploying capital on a case by case basis in a way that maximizes value. Supervising is a reference to our ongoing rigorous credit monitoring.

Sourcing

The elements of our sourcing efforts will include: (i) determining the market in which we intend to participate; (ii) identifying the opportunities within that market; (iii) having a clear strategy; (iv) knowing the competition; and (v) distinguishing our competitive advantages.

Determining the Market

We invest primarily in debt securities of sponsored and unsponsored issuers based mainly in the United States. Our debt investments are composed of first lien secured loans, second lien secured loans and subordinated or mezzanine debt, which may include an associated equity component such as warrants, preferred stock and other similar securities. Our first lien secured loans may be structured as traditional first lien loans or as unitranche loans. Unitranche structures combine characteristics of traditional first lien senior secured as well as second lien and subordinated loans. In certain instances we will also make direct equity investments.

It is our belief that having a combination of sponsored and unsponsored investments in debt securities will benefit us with the most attractive opportunities across investment cycles. To that end, our nationwide origination efforts target both private equity sponsors and referral sources of unsponsored companies.

With respect to sponsored transactions, which we define as those companies controlled by private equity firms, or sponsors, we expect the demand for leveraged buyouts to grow due to the continued inflow of capital to private equity managers, a robust mergers and acquisition environment supported by attractive valuations and a stabilized economic climate. Concurrently, traditional commercial lenders are reducing their offerings to middle market companies due to increased leverage lending regulation and an institutional focus on more liquid investments. We believe middle market debt providers will increasingly see opportunities to fill this growing financing gap. Additionally, we expect significant demand from sponsors who need to recapitalize the balance sheets of certain of their portfolio companies or, in certain situations, acquire portfolio companies.

We selectively invest in unsponsored companies, which are either privately-held companies typically owned and controlled by entrepreneurs rather than private equity firms or microcap public companies, or those public companies with market capitalization of less than $300 million. We believe that unsponsored middle market

 

6


Table of Contents

companies represent a large, attractive and less competitive investment opportunity for two primary reasons: (1) the number of unsponsored companies far exceeds the number of sponsored companies; and (2) many debt investors focus primarily on sponsored companies. We also believe because unsponsored companies often have less access to capital providers, they generally provide us more attractive economics, greater alignment of interests with management, and greater control over the business and capital structure.

Investment professionals across all five offices hold regularly scheduled meetings to update and assess the pipeline of transaction opportunities, review information on market trends obtained through discussions with market participants and share sourcing best practices for both sponsored and unsponsored opportunities.

Market opportunity

We believe the environment for investing in middle market companies is attractive for several reasons, including:

Improved company fundamentals creating favorable lending trends. Middle market companies are experiencing improved fundamentals driven by a stabilizing economy and an increase in confidence. In 2014, middle market companies displayed improvements in operating performance, resulting in stronger credit quality. Default levels remained relatively low, and volatility in the broader capital markets eased, resulting in more middle market companies seeking growth capital at attractive lender credit metrics.

Meaningful availability of investable capital at private equity firms. Recent private equity data show over $1 trillion of dry powder that private equity fund managers are actively looking to allocate to transactions involving new or existing portfolio companies. Private equity funds will often prefer to support these transactions with debt securities, including first lien, second lien and mezzanine loans from sources such as us.

Consolidation among commercial banks has reduced their focus on middle market business. We believe that many senior lenders have de-emphasized their service and product offerings to middle market companies in favor of lending to large corporate clients, managing capital markets transactions and providing other non-credit services to their customers. Further, many financial institutions and traditional lenders are faced with constrained balance sheets and are requiring existing issuers to reduce leverage.

Increased lending regulation has limited the ability of traditional lenders to provide capital to middle market companies. Heightened scrutiny of large bank institutions by regulatory bodies has prompted lending guidelines that have sought to limit leverage, deter banks from lengthening payment timelines and restrict banks from holding certain CLO securities. In response, banks have been participating less in the middle market lending arena, opening up opportunities for alternative lenders such as us. In addition to new lending activity, as companies look to refinance existing loans that do not abide by the current guidelines, the market opportunity should continue to expand.

Middle market companies are increasingly seeking lenders with long-term capital to provide flexible solutions for their debt and equity financing needs. We believe that many middle market companies prefer to execute transactions with private capital providers such as us, rather than execute high-yield bond or equity transactions in the public markets, which may necessitate increased financial and regulatory compliance and reporting obligations. Further, we believe many middle market companies are inclined to seek capital from a small number of skilled, reliable and predictable providers with access to permanent capital that can satisfy their specific needs and serve as value-added financial partners with an understanding of, and longer-term view oriented towards the growth of their businesses. We aim to develop a constructive partnership with our portfolio companies to help them navigate economic cycles and operational issues which will arise.

The current regulatory and market environment may mean more favorable opportunities for investing in middle market companies. The combination of bank consolidation and increased regulation has resulted in fewer lender participants and a greater opportunity for us to originate proprietary investment opportunities in the

 

7


Table of Contents

middle market. Fewer participants also results in a more disciplined approach to investment opportunities, a situation which we are well positioned to capitalize on given the extensive level of experience of the Investment Principals, who have worked closely together for seven years and, together with their previous investment experiences, have invested through multiple business and credit cycles.

The large yet fragmented middle market may offer lenders more attractive economic terms compared to the more efficient, syndicated markets. Investing in debt securities in the middle market may offer more favorable returns relative to their investment risk, when compared to investments in public high yield or syndicated bank loan securities. From a structural perspective, middle market debt securities generally involve better pricing terms and protective characteristics which defend against credit deterioration and preserve collateral value (i.e. financial covenants). From an underwriting perspective, middle market lending provides improved access to information and the ability to diligence and evaluate management teams.

Investment strategy

We believe a strategy focused primarily on debt securities in middle market companies has a number of compelling attributes. First, the market for these instruments is relatively inefficient, allowing an experienced investor an opportunity to produce high risk-adjusted returns. Second, downside risk can be managed through an extensive credit-oriented underwriting process, creative structuring techniques and intensive portfolio monitoring. We believe private debt investments generally require the highest level of credit and legal due diligence among debt or credit asset classes. Lastly, compared with equity investments, returns on debt investments tend to be less volatile given the substantial current return component and seniority in the capital structure relative to equity.

Competition

Our primary competitors in providing financing to middle market companies include other BDCs, public and private funds, commercial and investment banks, CLO funds, commercial finance companies and, to the extent they provide an alternative form of financing, private equity and hedge funds. Many of our competitors are substantially larger and have considerably greater financial and marketing resources than we do. For example, some competitors may have access to funding sources that are not available to us. In addition, some of our competitors may have higher risk tolerances or different risk assessments, which could allow them to consider a wider variety of investments and establish more relationships than us.

Competitive advantages

We believe that we possess the following competitive advantages over many other capital providers to middle market companies:

Experienced management team. As stated above, the Investment Principals are experienced and have worked together extensively, and together with their past investment experiences have invested through multiple business and credit cycles across the entire capital structure with the objective of generating attractive, long-term, risk-adjusted returns. Each of the Investment Principals brings a unique investment perspective and skill-set by virtue of their complementary collective experiences as both debt and equity investors.

Proactive Sourcing Platform. We take a proactive, hands-on, and creative approach to investment sourcing. Our disciplined origination process includes proprietary tools and resources and employs a national platform with a regional focus. With offices in Boston, Chicago, Houston, New York and Los Angeles, the THL Credit Principals have a deep and diverse relationship network in the debt capital and private equity markets. These activities and relationships provide an important channel through which we generate investment opportunities consistent with our investment strategy. The THL Credit Principals have activities and relationships with private equity sponsors, investment bankers, middle market senior lenders, commercial bankers (national, regional and local), lawyers, accountants and business brokers as well as access to the extensive network of THL Partners

 

8


Table of Contents

which has 40 years of experience. The THL Credit Principals actively utilize these activities, relationships and networks to source and execute attractive investments, and maintain a database and set of reports where the details of all potential investment opportunities are tracked. Further, we believe the investment history and long-standing reputation of the THL Credit Principals provides us an early look at new investment opportunities.

Significant institutional expertise and brand recognition gained from investing over $1.6 billion in 82 companies since June 2009 across direct lending credit platform. We have developed the institutional knowledge and operational infrastructure required to successfully achieve our investment objectives. We benefit from proprietary deal flow from strong relationships with sponsors cultivated over seven years of doing business in the middle market. Our comprehensive underwriting methodology and monitoring processes have been implemented across all five regional offices. Additionally, the THL Credit Principals are supported by an experienced operational and administrative team.

Ability to execute unsponsored transactions. We believe we are one of the few credit market participants that selectively seeks unsponsored investments and possesses the experience and resources, as a result of the long-standing relationships of the Investment Principals and ongoing development of new relationships with referral sources and equity sponsors, to source unsponsored debt transactions. Furthermore, we have the capability to perform the rigorous in-house due diligence, structuring and monitoring activities necessary to execute such transactions.

Affiliation with THL Partners and THL Credit SLS. We are managed by THL Credit Advisors, the credit affiliate of THL Partners and parent of THL Credit Senior Loan Strategies LLC (“THL Credit SLS”). As such, we have access to the relationship network and industry knowledge of both THL Partners and THL Credit SLS to enhance transaction sourcing capabilities. This also provides us with the opportunity to consult with investment teams from each organization on specific industry issues, trends and other complementary matters.

Selecting

Selecting investments to pursue requires us to have an employable investment philosophy, know our key metrics, have a process to consistently measure those metrics, and implement a repeatable underwriting process that enables our investment committee to make well-reasoned decisions.

Investment Philosophy

Our investment philosophy focuses on capital preservation, relative value, and establishing close relationships with portfolio companies. It is our expectation that this multifaceted focus should generate consistent, attractive, risk-adjusted returns coupled with low volatility.

Capital Preservation. We believe that the key to capital preservation is comprehensive and fundamental credit analysis. We take a long term view of our investments and portfolio with the perspective that most of our investments may need to endure through economic cycles. We refrain from market timing and generally do not enter into investments with the sole intention of realizing short term gains based on changes in market prices. However, we will not hesitate to sell an investment if we believe that it is deteriorating in value and that more recovery will be obtained by selling rather than holding the investment.

Relative Value. Relative value is an essential part of every investment decision. Relative value is determined in a variety of ways including comparisons to other opportunities available in the same asset class and with portfolio companies in the same or similar industries. Relative value is also analyzed across asset classes (senior vs. subordinate, secured vs. unsecured, debt vs. equity) to ensure that the return of a potential investment is appropriate relative to its position in the capital structure.

 

9


Table of Contents

Key Investment Metrics

Our value-oriented investment philosophy is primarily focused on maximizing yield relative to risk. Upon identifying a potential opportunity, we perform an initial screen to determine whether pursuing intensive due diligence is merited. As part of this process, we have identified several criteria we believe are important in evaluating and investing in prospective portfolio companies. These criteria provide general guidelines for our investment decisions. However, each prospective portfolio company in which we choose to invest may not meet all of these criteria.

Value orientation/positive cash flow. Our investment philosophy places a premium on fundamental credit analysis and has a distinct value orientation. We will generally focus on companies in which we can invest at relatively low multiples of operating cash flow and that are profitable at the time of investment on an operating cash flow basis. Although we obtain liens on collateral when appropriate and available, we are primarily focused on the predictability of future cash flow. We generally do not intend to invest in start-up companies or companies with speculative business plans.

Seasoned management with significant equity ownership. Strong, committed management teams are important to the success of an investment and we focus on companies where strong management teams are either already in place or where new management teams have been identified. Additionally, we generally require the portfolio companies to have in place compensation provisions that appropriately incentivize management to succeed and to act in our interests as investors.

Strong competitive position. We seek to invest in companies that have developed competitive advantages and defensible market positions within their respective markets, provide a needed product or service and are well positioned to capitalize on growth opportunities.

Exit strategy. We seek companies that we believe will generate consistent cash flow to repay our loans and reinvest in their respective businesses. We expect such internally generated cash flow in portfolio companies to be a key means by which we exit from our investments over time. In addition, we invest in companies whose business models and expected future cash flows offer attractive exit possibilities for the equity component of our returns. These companies include candidates for strategic acquisition by other industry participants and companies that may repay our investments through an initial public offering of common stock or another capital market transaction.

Due Diligence and Investment Process

We employ a rigorous and disciplined underwriting and due diligence process. Our process includes a comprehensive understanding of a portfolio company’s industry, market, operational, financial, organizational and legal position and prospects. In addition to our own analysis, we frequently use the service of third parties (either those of the sponsor, if applicable, or those which we retain) for quality of earnings reports, environmental diligence, legal reviews, industry and customer surveys, and background checks. We conduct thorough reference and background checks on senior management for all investments, including, but not limited to reference calls to several constituencies including senior management of past employers, business associates, customers, industry experts, such as equity research analysts and, when appropriate, competitors.

We seek portfolio companies that have proven management teams that have a vested interest in the company in the form of a meaningful level of equity ownership, that generate stable and predictable cash flow, and whose market position is defensible. We invest in companies with the expectation that we will own the investment through a complete business cycle, and possibly a recession, and we determine the appropriate amount of debt for the company accordingly. In addition, we view a sale of the company which might result in a refinancing of our investment as a possibility but not an expectation. Our intention is to craft strong and lender-friendly credit agreements with covenants, events of default, remedies and inter-creditor agreements being an integral part of our legal documents.

 

10


Table of Contents

Our due diligence typically includes the following elements (although not all elements necessarily form part of every due diligence project):

Portfolio Company Characteristics: key levers of the business including a focus on drivers of cash flow and growth; revenue visibility; customer and supplier concentrations; historical revenue and margin trends; fixed versus variable costs; free cash flow analysis; portfolio company performance in view of industry performance; and sensitivity analysis around various future performance scenarios (with a focus on downside scenario analysis);

Industry Analysis: including the portfolio company’s position within the context of the general economic environment and relevant industry cycles; industry size and growth rates; competitive landscape; barriers to entry and potential new entrants; product position and defensibility of market share; technological, regulatory and similar threats; and pricing power and cost considerations;

Management: including the quality, breadth and depth of the portfolio company’s management; track record and prior experience; background checks; reputation; compensation and equity incentives; corporate overhead; motivation; interviews with management, employees, customers and vendors;

Financial Analysis: an understanding of relevant financial ratios and statistics, including various leverage, liquidity, free cash flow and fixed charge coverage ratios; impact on ratios in various future performance scenarios and comparison of applicable ratios to industry competitors; satisfaction with the auditor of the financial statements; quality of earnings analysis;

Capital Structure: diverse considerations regarding leverage (including understanding seniority and leverage multiples); ability to service debt; collateral and security protections; covenants and guarantees; equity investment amounts and participants (where applicable); review of other significant structural terms and pertinent legal documentation; and

Collateral and Enterprise Value: analysis of relevant collateral coverage, including assets on a liquidation basis and enterprise value on a going concern basis; matrix analysis of cash flow and valuation multiples under different scenarios along with recovery estimates; comparison to recent transaction multiples and valuations.

Underwriting Process

We employ an extensive due diligence approach tailored to each particular investment opportunity. To begin, we review the information memorandum that the company presenting the investment opportunity or its intermediary has prepared, and discuss the opportunity at a high level with the company’s management team, the sponsor or the intermediary, as applicable. Based on that initial high-level review, the investment team submits a customized due diligence questions request to the company or intermediary. Sometimes the company or intermediary responds directly with materials, and other times there is an online data room that the investment team is invited to review. If the investment opportunity involves a sponsor that has performed a diligence review of the company, the investment team reviews the sponsor’s due diligence reports and analyses. The investment team supplements the document review with phone calls and meetings with the intermediary, sponsor and company’s management team, as applicable. Members of the investment team may also speak with business contacts who are industry experts who provide color on industry and market trends, without discussing the specific investment opportunity. Such industry experts may include employees of THL Partners or their portfolio companies, and persons in THL Credit Advisors’ and THL Partners’ vast network of business contacts. Members of the investment team build a preliminary financial model and review financial statements as part of the analysis on whether the opportunity is attractive.

If the investment team believes the opportunity to be compelling or worth further discussion with the larger group, it will prepare a screening memo outlining the opportunity, including a company overview, situation overview, financial summary, investment thesis, risk factors and recommendations for next steps. The screening memo will be reviewed and discussed by all investment professionals (including the investment committee).

 

11


Table of Contents

Members of the investment committee in particular will ask detailed questions about the investment opportunity of the investment team. While no formal vote of the investment committee occurs at this stage, if any member of the investment committee expresses significant concerns about the investment opportunity then the investment team will be unlikely to proceed further.

During such discussions, the investment team will compile diligence questions raised by the larger group, and formulate a strategy for engaging outside consultants, legal and financial advisors and additional industry experts, as needed.

Following such a discussion, if the investment professionals (including the investment committee) believe the opportunity to be compelling, the investment team will then pursue the next stages of diligence and draft a term sheet or initial indication of interest when appropriate. Such documentation will then be presented to the sponsor or intermediary, as appropriate, and shared with the company.

If the investment team decides that the opportunity offers an attractive risk-adjusted return and we are competitively positioned to be awarded the deal, it will begin to work towards final approval by the investment committee by performing confirmatory due diligence. As part of this process, members of the investment team will conduct, among others, in-person meetings with management, in-depth review of historical financial data, thorough reviews of loan documents and material contracts as well as research relating to the company’s industry, customers, suppliers and competitors.

THL Credit Advisors’ in-house counsel will engage outside legal counsel for the opportunity, as well as industry-specific consultants, if appropriate, and accountants. If the investment opportunity involves a sponsor, the investment team may coordinate with the sponsor on engaging such consultants and accountants, and if the investment opportunity involves a co-investor, the investment team will coordinate with the co-investor on engaging all such advisors. Legal counsel will perform legal due diligence, the accountants will perform accounting due diligence, including a quality of earnings report if one does not yet exist, and the industry-specific consultants will diligence various areas such as regulatory restrictions, specific vendor or customer relationships and background checks on the management team.

The investment team will then present its complete findings in the form of a comprehensive memo to the investment committee and ask for official approval of the proposed investment.

Investment Committee

The purpose of the investment committee is to evaluate and approve, as deemed appropriate, all investments by us. The committee process is intended to bring the diverse experience and perspectives of the committee’s members to the analysis and consideration of every investment. The committee also serves to provide investment consistency and adherence to THL Credit Advisors’ investment philosophies and policies. The investment committee also determines appropriate investment sizing and suggests ongoing monitoring requirements.

In addition to reviewing investments, the investment committee meetings serve as a forum to discuss credit views and outlooks. Potential transactions and investment sourcing are also reviewed on a regular basis. Members of our investment team are encouraged to share information and views on credits with the investment committee early in their analysis. This process improves the quality of the analysis and assists the deal team members to work more efficiently.

Each transaction is presented to the investment committee in a formal written report. Each potential sale or exit of an existing investment is also presented to the investment committee. Our investment committee currently consists of Sam W. Tillinghast, Christopher J. Flynn and W. Hunter Stropp. To approve a new investment, or to exit or sell an existing investment, the consent of a majority of the three members of the committee is required.

 

12


Table of Contents

Structuring

Our approach to structuring involves us choosing the most appropriate variety of security for each particular investment; and negotiating the best and most favorable terms.

Investment Structure

In order to achieve our investment objective, we invest in first lien and second lien secured loans, including unitranche investments, as well as subordinated debt, which may include an associated equity component such as warrants, preferred stock or other similar securities. In certain instances, we will also make direct equity investments. Typically, our investments will be approximately $10 million to $30 million of capital per transaction and have maturities of five to seven years. In determining whether a prospective investment satisfies our investment criteria, we generally seek a high total return potential on a risk-adjusted basis, although there can be no assurance we will find investments satisfying that criterion or that any such investments will perform in accordance with expectations.

We generally do not intend to invest in startup companies, operationally distressed situations or companies with speculative business plans. In addition, we may invest up to 30% of our portfolio in opportunistic investments which will be intended to diversify or complement the remainder of our portfolio and to enhance our returns to stockholders. There investments may include high yield bonds, private equity investments, securities of public companies that are broadly traded and securities of non-U.S. companies. We expect that these public companies generally will have debt securities that are non-investment grade.

Once we have determined that a prospective portfolio company is suitable for investment, we will work with the management of that portfolio company and its other capital providers, including, as applicable, senior, junior, and equity capital providers, to structure an investment. We will negotiate among these parties to agree on how our investment is expected to perform relative to the other capital in the portfolio company’s capital structure. Investments will include stringent structural and credit protections. The legal review process and documentation will be of paramount importance. Internal counsel of THL Credit Advisors will be closely involved in every investment that we make. Investment professionals working with internal counsel drive the principal negotiation of legal terms in connection with the issuance of term sheets. They continue to be involved in negotiations, along with outside counsel who lead the transactions, throughout the legal documentation process. This involvement on each transaction will provide consistent structural and credit protections across investments.

Security types we invest in include:

First Lien Senior Secured Loans. We invest in first lien or senior secured loans, and expect such loans to have terms of three to seven years. To the extent we invest in senior secured loans, we obtain first lien security interests in the assets of these portfolio companies that serve as collateral in support of the repayment of these loans. First lien secured loans may also include unitranche loan structures, which typically combine characteristics of traditional first lien senior secured and second lien and subordinated loans. We may obtain security interests in the assets of the portfolio company that serve as collateral in support of the repayment of these loans. This collateral may take the form of first-priority liens on the assets of the portfolio company and may provide for moderate loan amortization in the initial years of the facility, with the majority of the amortization deferred until loan maturity, although there can be no assurance we will find investments providing for such amortization. Unitranche loans generally allow the borrower to make a large lump sum payment of principal at the end of the loan term, and there is a risk of loss if the borrower is unable to pay the lump sum or refinance the amount owed at maturity.

Second Lien Loans. We structure our second lien investments as junior, secured loans. We obtain security interests in the assets of the portfolio company that serve as collateral in support of the repayment of such loans. This collateral may take the form of second priority liens on the assets of the portfolio company that serve as collateral in support of the repayment of these loans. Second lien loans may provide for moderate loan

 

13


Table of Contents

amortization in the initial years of the facility, with the majority of the amortization deferred until loan maturity, although there can be no assurance we will find investments providing for such amortization.

Mezzanine Loans. We structure our subordinated, or mezzanine investments, primarily as unsecured, subordinated loans that provide for relatively high, fixed interest rates that will provide us with current interest income. Generally, mezzanine loans rank subordinate in priority of payment to senior debt, such as senior bank debt, and are often unsecured. However, mezzanine loans rank senior to common and preferred equity in a borrowers’ capital structure. Mezzanine loans typically have interest-only payments in the early years, with amortization of principal deferred to the later years and may include an associated equity component such as warrants, preferred stock or other similar securities. The warrants associated with mezzanine loans are typically detachable, which allows lenders to receive repayment of their principal on an agreed amortization schedule while retaining their equity interest in the borrower. Also, in some cases our mezzanine loans will be collateralized by a subordinated lien on some or all of the assets of the borrower. Typically, our mezzanine loans will have maturities of five to ten years. In determining whether a prospective mezzanine loan investment satisfies our investment criteria, we generally seek a high total return potential, although there can be no assurance we will find investments satisfying that criterion or that any such investments will perform in accordance with expectations.

CLO Residual Interests. We have invested in residual interests, subordinated notes or income notes which are subordinated to the secured notes issued in connection with each CLO. The secured notes in each structure are collateralized by portfolios consisting primarily of broadly syndicated senior secured bank loans. The income notes are part of a class of subordinated notes, which are paid equal with other subordinated notes within this class. In each case, the subordinated notes do not have a stated rate of interest, but are entitled to receive distributions on quarterly payment dates subject to the priority of payments to secured note holders in the structures if and to the extent funds are available for such purpose. The payments on the subordinated notes are subordinated not only to the interest and principal claims of all secured notes issued, but to certain administrative expenses, taxes, and the base and subordinated fees paid to the collateral manager. Payments to the subordinated notes may vary significantly quarter to quarter for a variety of reasons and may be subject to 100% loss. Investments in subordinated notes, due to the structure of the CLO, can be significantly impacted by change in the market value of the assets, the distributions on the assets, defaults and recoveries on the assets, capital gains and losses on the assets along with prices, interest rates and other risks associated with the assets.

Logan JV. We have invested in Logan JV, which as of December 31, 2014 consisted of a portfolio of loans to 22 different borrowers in industries similar to the companies in our portfolio. Logan JV invests primarily in debt securities that are secured by a first lien on some or all of the issuer’s assets, including traditional senior debt and any related revolving or similar credit facility, in generally the same manner as our senior secured loans.

Investment Terms

We tailor the terms of each investment to the facts and circumstances of the transaction and the prospective portfolio company, negotiating a structure that protects our rights and manages our risk while creating incentives for the company to achieve its business plan and improve its profitability. We seek to limit the downside potential of our investments by:

 

   

requiring a total return on our investments (including both interest and potential equity appreciation) that compensates us for credit risk; and

 

   

negotiating covenants in connection with our investments that afford our portfolio companies as much flexibility in managing their businesses as possible, consistent with preservation of our capital. Such restrictions may include affirmative and negative covenants, default penalties, lien protection, change of control provisions and board rights, including either observation or rights to a seat on the board under some circumstances or participation rights. The intention will be to craft strong and investor-friendly agreements with covenants, events of default, remedies and intercreditor agreements, if applicable, being an integral part of such documents.

 

14


Table of Contents

Our investments may include equity features, such as warrants or options to buy a minority interest in the portfolio company. Any warrants we receive with our debt securities generally require only a nominal cost to exercise, and thus, as a portfolio company appreciates in value, we may achieve additional investment return from this equity interest. We may structure the warrants to provide provisions protecting our rights as a minority interest holder, as well as puts, or rights to sell such securities back to the company, upon the occurrence of specified events. In many cases, we also obtain registration rights in connection with these equity interests, which may include demand and “piggyback” registration rights.

Supervising

Successful supervision of our investments involves employing active monitoring methods; and developing strong underlying management teams at each portfolio company.

Monitoring

We employ the use of board observation and information rights, regular dialogue with company management and sponsors, and detailed internally generated monitoring reports to actively monitor performance. Additionally, THL Credit has developed a monitoring template that promotes compliance with these standards and that is used as a tool to assess investment performance relative to plan.

As part of the monitoring process, the Advisor assesses the risk profile of each of our investments and assigns each portfolio investment a score of a 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5

The revised investment performance scores, or IPS, are as follows:

1 – The portfolio investment is performing above our underwriting expectations.

2 – The portfolio investment is performing as expected at the time of underwriting. All new investments are initially scored a 2.

3 – The portfolio investment is operating below our underwriting expectations, and requires closer monitoring. The company may be out of compliance with financial covenants, however, principal or interest payments are generally not past due.

4 – The portfolio investment is performing materially below our underwriting expectations and returns on our investment are likely to be impaired. Principal or interest payments may be past due, however, full recovery of principal and interest payments are expected.

5 – The portfolio investment is performing substantially below expectations and the risk of the investment has increased substantially. The company is in payment default and the principal and interest payments are not expected to be repaid in full.

For any investment receiving a score of a 3 or lower THL Credit Advisors will increase their level of focus and prepare regular updates for the investment committee summarizing current operating results, material impending events and recommended actions.

 

15


Table of Contents

Our Advisor monitors and, when appropriate, changes the investment scores assigned to each investment in our portfolio. In connection with our investment valuation process, the Advisor and board of directors review these investment scores on a quarterly basis. Our average investment score was 2.07 and 2.13 at December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively. The following is a distribution of the investment scores of our portfolio investments at December 31, 2014 and 2013 (in millions):

 

     December 31, 2014     December 31, 2013  

Investment Score

   Fair Value      % of Total
Portfolio
    Fair Value      % of Total
Portfolio
 

1(a)

   $ 72.1         9.2   $ 58.9         9.1

2(b)

     569.5         72.7     484.5         74.7

3(c)

     136.0         17.3     72.9         11.2

4(d)

     6.6         0.8     32.6         5.0

5

     —           —          —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 784.2         100.0   $ 648.9         100.0
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) 

As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, Investment Score “1” included no loans to companies in which we also hold equity securities.

(b) 

As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, Investment Score “2” included $126.0 million and $62.4 million, respectively, of loans to companies in which we also hold equity securities.

(c) 

As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, Investment Score “3” included $24.7 million and $14.5 million, respectively, of loans to companies in which we also hold equity securities.

(d) 

As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, Investment Score “4” included $4.6 million and $10.2 million, respectively, of loans to companies in which we also hold equity securities.

Loans are placed on non-accrual status when principal or interest payments are past due 30 days or more and/or when it is no longer probable that principal or interest will be collected. However, we may make exceptions to this policy if the loan has sufficient collateral value and is in the process of collection. As of December 31, 2014, we had no loans on non-accrual. As of December 31, 2013, we had two loans on non-accrual with an amortized cost basis of $21.0 million and fair value of $16.8 million. We record the reversal of any previously accrued income against the same income category reflected in the Consolidated Statement of Operations.

Investment management agreement

THL Credit Advisors serves as our investment adviser. THL Credit Advisors is registered as an investment adviser under the Advisers Act. Subject to the overall supervision of our board of directors, THL Credit Advisors manages the day-to-day operations of, and provide investment advisory and management services to, THL Credit, Inc. The address of THL Credit Advisors is 100 Federal Street, 31st Floor, Boston, Massachusetts 02110.

Under the terms of our investment management agreement, THL Credit Advisors:

 

   

determines the composition of our portfolio, the nature and timing of the changes to our portfolio and the manner of implementing such changes;

 

   

identifies, evaluates and negotiates the structure of the investments we make (including performing due diligence on our prospective portfolio companies); and

 

   

closes, monitors and administers the investments we make, including the exercise of any voting or consent rights.

THL Credit Advisors’ services under the investment management agreement are not exclusive, and it is free to furnish similar services to other entities so long as its services to us are not impaired.

 

16


Table of Contents

Pursuant to our investment management agreement, we pay THL Credit Advisors a fee for investment advisory and management services consisting of a base management fee and a two-part incentive fee.

Management Fee. The base management fee is calculated at an annual rate of 1.5% of our gross assets payable quarterly in arrears on a calendar quarter basis. For purposes of calculating the base management fee, “gross assets” is determined without deduction for any liabilities. Base management fees for any partial quarter are appropriately prorated. For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, THL Credit Advisors earned base management fees of $11.1 million, $7.5 million and $4.9 million, respectively, from us.

Incentive Fee. The incentive fee has two components, ordinary income and capital gains, calculated as follows:

The ordinary income component is calculated, and payable, quarterly in arrears based on our preincentive fee net investment income for the immediately preceding calendar quarter, subject to a cumulative total return requirement and to deferral of non-cash amounts. The preincentive fee net investment income, which is expressed as a rate of return on the value of our net assets attributable to our common stock, for the immediately preceding calendar quarter, will have a 2.0% (which is 8.0% annualized) hurdle rate (also referred to as “minimum income level”). Preincentive fee net investment income means interest income, dividend income and any other income (including any other fees, such as commitment, origination, structuring, diligence, managerial assistance and consulting fees or other fees that we receive from portfolio companies) accrued during the calendar quarter, minus our operating expenses for the quarter (including the base management fee, expenses payable under our administration agreement (discussed below), and any interest expense and any dividends paid on any issued and outstanding preferred stock, but excluding the incentive fee and any offering expenses and other expenses not charged to operations but excluding certain reversals to the extent such reversals have the effect of reducing previously accrued incentive fees based on the deferral of non-cash interest. Preincentive fee net investment income includes, in the case of investments with a deferred interest feature (such as original issue discount, debt instruments with PIK interest and zero coupon securities), accrued income that we have not yet received in cash. The Advisor receives no incentive fee for any calendar quarter in which our preincentive fee net investment income does not exceed the minimum income level. Subject to the cumulative total return requirement described below, the Advisor receives 100% of our preincentive fee net investment income for any calendar quarter with respect to that portion of the preincentive net investment income for such quarter, if any, that exceeds the minimum income level but is less than 2.5% (which is 10.0% annualized) of net assets (also referred to as the “catch-up” provision) and 20.0% of our preincentive fee net investment income for such calendar quarter, if any, greater than 2.5% (10.0% annualized) of net assets. The foregoing incentive fee is subject to a total return requirement, which provides that no incentive fee in respect of our preincentive fee net investment income is payable except to the extent 20.0% of the cumulative net increase in net assets resulting from operations over the then current and 11 preceding calendar quarters exceeds the cumulative incentive fees accrued and/or paid for the 11 preceding quarters. In other words, any ordinary income incentive fee that is payable in a calendar quarter is limited to the lesser of (i) 20% of the amount by which our preincentive fee net investment income for such calendar quarter exceeds the 2.0% hurdle, subject to the “catch-up” provision, and (ii) (x) 20% of the cumulative net increase in net assets resulting from operations for the then current and 11 preceding quarters minus (y) the cumulative incentive fees accrued and/or paid for the 11 preceding calendar quarters. For the foregoing purpose, the “cumulative net increase in net assets resulting from operations” is the amount, if positive, of the sum of our preincentive fee net investment income, base management fees, realized gains and losses and unrealized appreciation and depreciation for the then current and 11 preceding calendar quarters. In addition, the portion of such incentive fee that is attributable to deferred interest (sometimes referred to as payment-in-kind interest, or PIK, or original issue discount, or OID) will be paid to THL Credit Advisors, together with interest thereon from the date of deferral to the date of payment, only if and to the extent we actually receive such interest in cash, and any accrual thereof will be reversed if and to the extent such interest is reversed in connection with any write-off or similar treatment of the investment giving rise to any deferred interest accrual. There is no accumulation of amounts on the hurdle rate from quarter to quarter and accordingly there is no clawback of amounts previously paid if subsequent quarters are below the quarterly hurdle rate and there is no delay of payment if prior quarters are below the quarterly hurdle rate.

 

17


Table of Contents

Preincentive fee net investment income does not include any realized capital gains, realized capital losses or unrealized capital appreciation or depreciation. Because of the structure of the incentive fee, it is possible that we may pay an incentive fee in a quarter where we incur a loss, subject to the total return requirement and deferral of non-cash amounts. For example, if we receive preincentive fee net investment income in excess of the quarterly minimum hurdle rate, we will pay the applicable incentive fee even if we have incurred a loss in that quarter due to realized and unrealized capital losses. Our net investment income used to calculate this component of the incentive fee is also included in the amount of our gross assets used to calculate the 1.5% base management fee. These calculations will be appropriately prorated for any period of less than three months and adjusted for any share issuances or repurchases during the current quarter.

The following is a graphical representation of the calculation of the income-related portion of the incentive fee:

Quarterly Incentive Fee Based on Net Investment Income

Pre-incentive fee net investment income (expressed as a percentage of the value of net assets)

 

LOGO

Pre-incentive fee net investment income allocated to first component of incentive fee

For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, we incurred $11.9 million, $10.4 million and $7.4 million, respectively, of incentive fees related to ordinary income. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $3.1 million and $2.1 million, respectively, of such incentive fees were payable to the Advisor. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $1.1 million and $1.3 million, respectively of incentive fees incurred by us were generated from deferred interest (i.e. PIK, certain discount accretion and deferred interest) and are not payable until such amounts are received in cash.

Additionally, if the investment management agreement is terminated as of a date that is not a calendar year end, the termination date will be treated as though it were a calendar year end for purposes of calculating and paying the capital gains incentive fee.

For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, THL Credit Advisors earned incentive fees of $11.2 million, $10.7 million and $7.0 million, respectively, from us.

Pre-incentive fee capital gains allocated to second component of incentive fee

The second component of the incentive fee (capital gains incentive fee) is determined and payable in arrears as of the end of each calendar year (or upon termination of the investment management agreement, as of the termination date). This component is equal to 20.0% of our cumulative aggregate realized capital gains from inception through the end of that calendar year, computed net of the cumulative aggregate realized capital losses and cumulative aggregate unrealized capital depreciation through the end of such year. The aggregate amount of any previously paid capital gains incentive fees is subtracted from such capital gains incentive fee calculated.

 

18


Table of Contents

Examples of Quarterly Incentive Fee Calculation

Example 1: Income Portion of Incentive Fee before Total Return Requirement Calculation:

Assumptions

 

   

Hurdle rate (1) = 2.00%

 

   

Base management fee (2) = 0.375%

 

   

Other expenses (legal, accounting, custodian, transfer agent, etc.)(3) = 0.40%

Alternative 1

Additional Assumptions

 

   

Investment income (including interest, dividends, fees, etc.) = 1.25%

 

   

Pre-incentive fee net investment income (investment income—(base management fee + other expenses)) = 0.475%

Pre-incentive net investment income does not exceed hurdle rate, therefore there is no incentive fee.

Alternative 2

Additional Assumptions

 

   

Investment income (including interest, dividends, fees, etc.) = 2.90%

 

   

Preincentive fee net investment income (investment income—(base management fee + other expenses)) = 2.125%

Preincentive fee net investment income exceeds hurdle rate, therefore there is an incentive fee.

Incentive fee = (100% × “Catch-Up”) + (the greater of 0% AND (20.0% × (preincentive fee net investment income—2.5%)))

= (100.0% x (preincentive fee net investment income—2.00%)) +0%

= (100.0% x (2.125%—2.00%))

= 100% x 0.125%

= 0.125%

Alternative 3

Additional Assumptions

 

   

Investment income (including interest, dividends, fees, etc.) = 3.50%

 

   

Preincentive fee net investment income (investment income—(base management fee + other expenses)) = 2.725%

Preincentive fee net investment income exceeds hurdle rate, therefore there is an incentive fee.

Incentive Fee = (100% × “Catch-Up”) + (the greater of 0% AND (20.0% × (preincentive fee net investment income—2.5%)))

= (100% × (2.5%—2.0%)) + (20.0% × (2.725%—2.5%))

= 0.5% + (20.0% × 0.225%)

= 0.5% + 0.045%

= 0.545%

 

19


Table of Contents

 

(1) 

Represents 8.0% annualized hurdle rate.

(2) 

Represents 1.5% annualized base management fee.

(3) 

Excludes organizational and offering expenses.

Example 2: Income Portion of Incentive Fee with Total Return Requirement Calculation:

Assumptions

 

   

Hurdle rate (1) = 2.00%

 

   

Base management fee (2) = 0.375%

 

   

Other expenses (legal, accounting, transfer agent, etc.) (3) = 0.40%

 

   

Cumulative incentive compensation accrued and/or paid for preceding 11 calendar quarters = $9,000,000

Alternative 1

Additional Assumptions

 

   

Investment income (including interest, dividends, fees, etc.) = 3.50%

 

   

Preincentive fee net investment income (investment income – (base management fee + other expenses)) = 2.725%

 

   

20.0% of cumulative net increase in net assets resulting from operations over current and preceding 11 calendar quarters = $8,000,000

Although our preincentive fee net investment income exceeds the hurdle rate of 2.0% (as shown in Alternative 3 of Example 1 above), no incentive fee is payable because 20.0% of the cumulative net increase in net assets resulting from operations over the then current and 11 preceding calendar quarters did not exceed the cumulative income and capital gains incentive fees accrued and/or paid for the preceding 11 calendar quarters.

Alternative 2

Additional Assumptions

 

   

Investment Income (including interest, dividends, fees, etc.) = 3.50%

 

   

Preincentive fee net investment income (investment income – (base management fee + other expenses)) = 2.725%.

 

   

20% of cumulative net increase in net assets resulting from operations over current and preceding 11 calendar quarters = $10,000,000

Because our preincentive fee net investment income exceeds the hurdle rate of 2.0% and because 20.0% of the cumulative net increase in net assets resulting from operations over the then current and 11 preceding calendar quarters exceeds the cumulative income and capital gains incentive fees accrued and/or paid for the preceding 11 calendar quarters, an incentive fee would be payable, as shown in Alternative 3 of Example 1 above.

 

(1) 

Represents 8.0% annualized hurdle rate.

(2) 

Represents 1.5% annualized base management fee.

(3) 

Excludes organizational and offering expenses.

 

20


Table of Contents

Example 3: Capital Gains Portion of Incentive Fee:

Alternative 1:

Assumptions

 

   

Year 1: $20 million investment made in Company A (“Investment A”), and $30 million investment made in Company B (“Investment B”)

 

   

Year 2: Investment A sold for $50 million and fair market value, or FMV, of Investment B determined to be $32 million

 

   

Year 3: FMV of Investment B determined to be $25 million

 

   

Year 4: Investment B sold for $31 million

The capital gains portion of the incentive fee would be:

 

   

Year 1: None

 

   

Year 2: Capital gains incentive fee of $6.0 million ($30 million realized capital gains on sale of Investment A multiplied by 20.0%)

 

   

Year 3: None; $5.0 million (20.0% multiplied by ($30 million cumulative capital gains less $5 million cumulative capital depreciation)) less $6.0 million (previous capital gains fee paid in Year 2)

 

   

Year 4: Capital gains incentive fee of $200,000; $6.20 million ($31 million cumulative realized capital gains multiplied by 20.0%) less $6.0 million (capital gains fee paid in Year 2)

Alternative 2

Assumptions

 

   

Year 1: $20 million investment made in Company A (“Investment A”), $30 million investment made in Company B (“Investment B”) and $25 million investment made in Company C (“Investment C”)

 

   

Year 2: Investment A sold for $50 million, FMV of Investment B determined to be $25 million and FMV of Investment C determined to be $25 million

 

   

Year 3: FMV of Investment B determined to be $27 million and Investment C sold for $30 million

 

   

Year 4: FMV of Investment B determined to be $35 million

Year 5: Investment B sold for $20 million The capital gains portion of the incentive fee would be:

 

   

Year 1: None

 

   

Year 2: Capital gains incentive fee of $5.0 million; 20.0% multiplied by $25 million ($30 million realized capital gains on Investment A less $5 million unrealized capital depreciation on Investment B)

 

   

Year 3: Capital gains incentive fee of $1.4 million; $6.4 million (20.0% multiplied by $32 million ($35 million cumulative realized capital gains less $3 million unrealized capital depreciation on Investment B)) less $5.0 million capital gains fee paid in Year 2

 

   

Year 4: None

 

   

Year 5: None; $5.0 million of capital gains incentive fee (20.0% multiplied by $25 million (cumulative realized capital gains of $35 million less realized capital losses of $10 million)) less $6.4 million cumulative capital gains fee paid in Year 2 and Year 3

Payment of our expenses

All investment professionals and staff of THL Credit Advisors, when and to the extent engaged in providing investment advisory and management services, and the compensation and routine overhead expenses of such

 

21


Table of Contents

personnel allocable to such services (including health insurance, 401(k) plan benefits, payroll taxes and other compensation related matters), are provided and paid for by THL Credit Advisors. We bear all other costs and expenses of our operations and transactions, including those relating to:

 

   

our organization;

 

   

calculating our net asset value and net asset value per share (including the cost and expenses of any independent valuation firm);

 

   

expenses, including travel-related expenses, incurred by THL Credit Advisors or payable to third parties in originating investments for the portfolio, performing due diligence on prospective portfolio companies, monitoring our investments and, if necessary, enforcing our rights;

 

   

interest payable on debt, if any, incurred to finance our investments;

 

   

the costs of future offerings of common shares and other securities, if any;

 

   

the base management fee and any incentive management fee;

 

   

distributions on our shares;

 

   

administrator expenses payable under our administration agreement;

 

   

transfer agent and custody fees and expenses;

 

   

the allocated costs incurred by THL Credit Advisors as our Administrator in providing managerial assistance to those portfolio companies that request it;

 

   

amounts payable to third parties relating to, or associated with, evaluating, making and disposing of investments;

 

   

brokerage fees and commissions;

 

   

registration fees;

 

   

listing fees;

 

   

taxes;

 

   

independent director fees and expenses;

 

   

costs of preparing and filing reports or other documents with the SEC;

 

   

the costs of any reports, proxy statements or other notices to our stockholders, including printing costs;

 

   

costs of holding stockholder meetings;

 

   

our fidelity bond;

 

   

directors and officers/errors and omissions liability insurance, and any other insurance premiums;

 

   

litigation, indemnification and other non-recurring or extraordinary expenses;

 

   

direct costs and expenses of administration and operation, including audit and legal costs;

 

   

fees and expenses associated with marketing efforts, including to investors, sponsors and other origination sources;

 

   

dues, fees and charges of any trade association of which we are a member; and

 

   

all other expenses reasonably incurred by us or the Administrator in connection with administering our business, such as the allocable portion of overhead under our administration agreement, including rent and other allocable portions of the cost of certain of our officers and their respective staffs.

 

22


Table of Contents

We reimburse THL Credit Advisors for costs and expenses incurred by THL Credit Advisors for office space rental, office equipment and utilities allocable to the performance by THL Credit Advisors of its duties under the investment management agreement, as well as any costs and expenses incurred by THL Credit Advisors relating to any non-investment advisory, administrative or operating services provided by THL Credit Advisors to us or in the form of managerial assistance to portfolio companies that request it.

THL Credit Advisors may pay amounts owed by us to third party providers of goods or services. We will subsequently reimburse THL Credit Advisors for such amounts paid on our behalf.

Limitation of liability and indemnification

The investment management agreement provides that THL Credit Advisors and its officers, directors, employees and affiliates are not liable to us or any of our stockholders for any act or omission by it or its employees in the supervision or management of our investment activities or for any loss sustained by us or our stockholders, except that the foregoing exculpation does not extend to any act or omission constituting willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross negligence or reckless disregard of its obligations under the investment management agreement. The investment management agreement also provides for indemnification by us of THL Credit Advisors’ members, directors, officers, employees, agents and control persons for liabilities incurred by it in connection with their services to us, subject to the same limitations and to certain conditions.

Duration and termination

The investment management agreement was approved by our board of directors on March 6, 2015, as described further below under “Business—Board Approval of the Investment Advisory Agreement.” Unless terminated earlier as described below, it will remain in effect from year to year if approved annually by our board of directors or by the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority of our outstanding voting securities, including, in either case, approval by a majority of our directors who are not interested persons. The investment management agreement will automatically terminate in the event of its assignment. The investment management agreement may be terminated by either party without penalty upon not less than 60 days written notice to the other. Any termination by us must be authorized either by our board of directors or by vote of our stockholders. See “Risk Factors—Risks relating to our business.” We are dependent upon senior management personnel of our investment adviser for our future success, and if our investment adviser is unable to retain qualified personnel or if our investment adviser loses any member of its senior management team, our ability to achieve our investment objective could be significantly harmed.

Board Approval of the Investment Advisory Agreement

At a meeting of our Board of Directors held on March 6, 2015, our board of directors unanimously voted to approve the investment advisory agreement. In reaching a decision to approve the investment advisory agreement, the board of directors reviewed a significant amount of information and considered, among other things:

 

   

the nature, quality and extent of the advisory and other services to be provided to us by THL Credit Advisors;

 

   

the fee structures of comparable externally managed business development companies that engage in similar investing activities;

 

   

our projected operating expenses and expense ratio compared to business development companies with similar investment objectives;

 

   

any existing and potential sources of indirect income to THL Credit Advisors from its relationship with us and the profitability of that relationship, including through the investment advisory agreement;

 

23


Table of Contents
   

information about the services to be performed and the personnel performing such services under the investment advisory agreement;

 

   

the organizational capability and financial condition of THL Credit Advisors and its affiliates; and

 

   

various other matters.

Based on the information reviewed and the discussions detailed above, the board of directors, including all of the directors who are not “interested persons” as defined in the 1940 Act, concluded that the investment advisory fee rates and terms are reasonable in relation to the services provided and approved the investment advisory agreement as being in the best interests of our stockholders.

Administration Agreement

We have entered into an administration agreement with THL Credit Advisors, which we refer to as the “administration agreement,” under which the Administrator provides administrative services to us. For providing these services, facilities and personnel, we reimburse the Administrator for our allocable portion of overhead and other expenses incurred by the Administrator in performing its obligations under the administration agreement, including rent and our allocable portion of the cost of certain of our officers and their respective staffs.

The Administrator may pay amounts owed by us to third-party providers of goods or services. We will subsequently reimburse the Administrator for such amounts paid on our behalf.

Additionally, at our request, the Administrator provides on our behalf significant managerial assistance to our portfolio companies to which we are required to provide such assistance.

License agreement

We and THL Credit Advisors have entered into a license agreement with THL Partners under which THL Partners has granted to us and THL Credit Advisors a non-exclusive, personal, revocable worldwide non-transferable license to use the trade name and service mark THL, which is a proprietary mark of THL Partners, for specified purposes in connection with our respective businesses. This license agreement is royalty-free, which means we are not charged a fee for our use of the trade name and service mark THL. The license agreement is terminable either in its entirety or with respect to us or THL Credit Advisors by THL Partners at any time in its sole discretion upon 60 days prior written notice, and is also terminable with respect to either us or THL Credit Advisors by THL Partners in the case of certain events of non-compliance. After the expiration of its first one year term, the entire license agreement is terminable by either us or THL Credit Advisors at our or its sole discretion upon 60 days prior written notice. Upon termination of the license agreement, we and THL Credit Advisors must cease to use the name and mark THL, including any use in our respective legal names, filings, listings and other uses that may require us to withdraw or replace our names and marks. Other than with respect to the limited rights contained in the license agreement, we and THL Credit Advisors have no right to use, or other rights in respect of, the THL name and mark. We are an entity operated independently from THL Partners, and third parties who deal with us have no recourse against THL Partners.

Staffing

We do not currently have any employees and do not expect to have any employees. Our Advisor and Administrator have hired and expect to continue to hire professionals with skills applicable to our business plan and investment objective, including experience in middle market investment, leveraged finance and capital markets. Each of our executive officers is an employee and executive officer of our Advisor or Administrator. Our day-to-day investment operations are managed by our Advisor. The services necessary for the origination and administration of our investment portfolio are provided by investment professionals employed by our Advisor. Our Advisor’s investment professionals focus on origination and transaction development and the

 

24


Table of Contents

ongoing monitoring of our investments. We reimburse our Administrator for costs and expenses incurred by our Administrator for office space rental, office equipment and utilities allocable to our Administrator under the administration agreement, as well as any costs and expenses incurred by our Advisor relating to any non-investment advisory, administrative or operating services provided by our Advisor to us. In addition, we reimburse our Administrator for our allocable portion of expenses it incurs in performing its obligations under the administration agreement, including rent and our allocable portion of the cost of certain of our officers and their respective staffs.

Material Conflicts of Interest

We entered into an investment management agreement on April 1, 2010 under which the Advisor, subject to the overall supervision of our board of directors manages the day-to-day operations of, and provides investment advisory services to us. The Advisor and its affiliates may also manage other funds in the future that may have investment mandates that are similar, in whole and in part, with ours. For example, the Advisor may serve as investment adviser to one or more private funds or registered closed-end funds, and presently serves as an investment adviser to CLOs, THL Credit Wind River 2013-2 CLO, Ltd., THL Credit Wind River 2014-1 CLO, Ltd., THL Credit Wind River 2014-2 CLO, Ltd., and a subadviser to a closed-end fund, THL Credit Senior Loan Fund (NYSE: TSLF). In addition, our officers may serve in similar capacities for one or more private funds or registered closed-end funds.

The Advisor’s policies are also designed to manage and mitigate the conflicts of interest associated with the allocation of investment opportunities if we are able to co-invest, either pursuant to SEC interpretive positions or an exemptive order, with other funds managed by the Adviser and its affiliates. In addition, we note that any affiliated fund currently formed or formed in the future and managed by the Advisor or its affiliates may have overlapping investment objectives with our own and, accordingly, may invest in asset classes similar to those targeted by us. However, in certain instances due to regulatory, tax, investment, or other restrictions, certain investment opportunities may not be appropriate for either us or other funds managed by the Advisor. Generally, unless otherwise provided in the allocation policy, if an investment opportunity is appropriate for both us and other investment funds and the investment opportunity requires more than the price to be negotiated, the investment opportunity will be made available to the other investment fund or us on an alternating basis based on the date of closing of each such investment opportunity. As a result, the Advisor and/or its affiliates may face conflicts in allocating investment opportunities between us and such other entities. Although the Advisor and its affiliates will endeavor to allocate investment opportunities in a fair and equitable manner and consistent with applicable allocation procedures, it is possible that, in the future, we may not be given the opportunity to participate in investments made by investment funds managed by the Advisor or its affiliates.

The 1940 Act prohibits us from making certain negotiated co-investments with affiliates unless we receive an order from the SEC permitting us to do so. We, the Advisor and certain of its affiliates have submitted an exemptive application to the SEC to permit us to co-invest with other funds managed by the Advisor or its affiliates in a manner consistent with our investment objective, positions, policies, strategies and restrictions as well as regulatory requirements and other pertinent factors. There can be no assurance that any such exemptive order will be granted. If such relief is granted, then we will be permitted to co-invest with our affiliates if a “required majority” (as defined in Section 57(o) of the 1940 Act) or our independent directors make certain conclusions in connection with a co-investment transaction, including that (1) the terms of the transactions, including the consideration to be paid, are reasonable and fair to us and our stockholders and do not involve overreaching by us or our stockholders on the part of any person concerned and (2) the transaction is consistent with the interests of our stockholders and is consistent with our investment objective and strategies.

Business Development Company Regulations

We have elected to be regulated as a BDC under the 1940 Act. We have also elected to be treated for tax purposes as a RIC under Subchapter M of the Code. The 1940 Act contains prohibitions and restrictions relating

 

25


Table of Contents

to transactions between BDCs and their affiliates (including any investment advisers or sub-advisers), principal underwriters and affiliates of those affiliates or underwriters and requires that a majority of the directors be persons other than “interested persons,” as that term is defined in the 1940 Act.

In addition, the 1940 Act provides that we may not change the nature of our business so as to cease to be, or to withdraw our election as, a BDC unless approved by “a majority of our outstanding voting securities” as defined in the 1940 Act. A majority of the outstanding voting securities of a company is defined under the 1940 Act as the lesser of: (a) 67% or more of such company’s voting securities present at a meeting if more than 50% of the outstanding voting securities of such company are present or represented by proxy, or (b) more than 50% of the outstanding voting securities of such company. We do not anticipate any substantial change in the nature of our business.

We are not generally able to issue and sell our common stock at a price below net asset value per share. We may, however, issue and sell our common stock, or warrants, options or rights to acquire our common stock, at a price below the then-current net asset value of our common stock if (1) our board of directors determines that such sale is in our best interests and the best interests of our stockholders, and (2) our stockholders have approved our policy and practice of making such sales within the preceding 12 months. In any such case, the price at which our securities are to be issued and sold may not be less than a price which, in the determination of our board of directors, closely approximates the market value of such securities. At our Annual Meeting of Stockholders on June 3, 2014, our stockholders approved a proposal authorizing us to sell up to 25% of our common stock at a price below our then-current net asset value per share, subject to approval by our board of directors for the offering. The authorization expires on the earlier of June 3, 2015 and the date of our 2015 Annual Meeting of Stock holders, which is expected to be held in June 2015. Our stockholders also approved a proposal to authorize us to offer and issue debt with warrants or debt convertible into shares of our common stock at an exercise or conversion price that, at the time such warrants or convertible debt are issued, will not be less than the market value per share but may be below our then-current net asset value per share.

As a BDC, we are required to meet a coverage ratio of the value of total assets to senior securities, which include all of our borrowings and any preferred stock we may issue in the future, of at least 200%. We may also be prohibited under the 1940 Act from knowingly participating in certain transactions with our affiliates without the prior approval of our board of directors who are not interested persons and, in some cases, prior approval by the SEC.

Legislation introduced in the U.S. House of Representatives during the 113th Congress intended to revise certain regulations applicable to BDCs. The legislation provided for (i) modifying the asset coverage ratio from 200% to 150%, (ii) permitting BDCs to file registration statements with the SEC that incorporate information from already-filed reports by reference, (iii) utilizing other streamlined registration processes afforded to operating companies, and (iv) allowing BDCs to own investment adviser subsidiaries. The legislation was not enacted by the previous Congress and has not been introduced to the 114th Congress. There are no assurances as to when the legislation will be enacted by Congress, if at all, or, if enacted, what final form the legislation would take.

We may invest up to 100% of our assets in securities acquired directly from issuers in privately negotiated transactions. With respect to such securities, we may, for the purpose of public resale, be deemed an “underwriter” as that term is defined in the Securities Act of 1933, or the Securities Act. We do not intend to acquire securities issued by any investment company that exceed the limits imposed by the 1940 Act. Under these limits, except for registered money market funds, we generally cannot acquire more than 3% of the voting stock of any investment company, invest more than 5% of the value of our total assets in the securities of one investment company or invest more than 10% of the value of our total assets in the securities of more than one investment company. With regard to that portion of our portfolio invested in securities issued by investment companies, it should be noted that such investments might indirectly subject our stockholders to additional expenses as they will indirectly be responsible for the costs and expenses of such companies. None of our investment policies are fundamental and any may be changed without stockholder approval.

 

26


Table of Contents

Qualifying assets

Under the 1940 Act, a BDC may not acquire any asset other than assets of the type listed in section 55(a) of the 1940 Act, which are referred to as qualifying assets, unless, at the time the acquisition is made, qualifying assets represent at least 70% of the company’s total assets. The principal categories of qualifying assets relevant to our business are the following: -

 

   

Securities purchased in transactions not involving any public offering from the issuer of such securities, which issuer (subject to certain limited exceptions) is an eligible portfolio company, or from any person who is, or has been during the preceding 13 months, an affiliated person of an eligible portfolio company, or from any other person, subject to such rules as may be prescribed by the SEC. An eligible portfolio company is defined in the 1940 Act as any issuer which:

 

   

is organized under the laws of, and has its principal place of business in, the United States;

 

   

is not an investment company (other than a small business investment company wholly owned by the BDC) or a company that would be an investment company but for certain exclusions under the 1940 Act; and

 

   

satisfies either of the following:

 

   

has a market capitalization of less than $250 million or does not have any class of securities listed on a national securities exchange; or

 

   

is controlled by a BDC or a group of companies including a BDC, the BDC actually exercises a controlling influence over the management or policies of the eligible portfolio company, and, as a result thereof, the BDC has an affiliated person who is a director of the eligible portfolio company.

 

   

Securities of any eligible portfolio company which we control.

 

   

Securities purchased in a private transaction from a U.S. issuer that is not an investment company or from an affiliated person of the issuer, or in transactions incident thereto, if the issuer is in bankruptcy and subject to reorganization or if the issuer, immediately prior to the purchase of its securities was unable to meet its obligations as they came due without material assistance other than conventional lending or financing arrangements.

 

   

Securities of an eligible portfolio company purchased from any person in a private transaction if there is no ready market for such securities and we already own 60% of the outstanding equity of the eligible portfolio company.

 

   

Securities received in exchange for or distributed on or with respect to securities described above, or pursuant to the exercise of warrants or rights relating to such securities.

 

   

Cash, cash equivalents, U.S. Government securities or high-quality debt securities maturing in one year or less from the time of investment.

Control, as defined by the 1940 Act, is presumed to exist where a BDC beneficially owns more than 25% of the outstanding voting securities of the portfolio company.

Significant managerial assistance to portfolio companies

A BDC must have been organized and have its principal place of business in the United States and must be operated for the purpose of making investments in the types of securities described in “Business—Business Development Company Regulations—Qualifying assets” above. Business development companies generally must offer to make available to the issuer of the securities significant managerial assistance, except in circumstances where either (i) the business development company controls such issuer of securities or (ii) the business development company purchases such securities in conjunction with one or more other persons acting

 

27


Table of Contents

together and one of the other persons in the group makes available such managerial assistance. Making available managerial assistance means, among other things, any arrangement whereby the BDC, through its directors, officers or employees, offers to provide, and, if accepted, does so provide, significant guidance and counsel concerning the management, operations or business objectives and policies of a portfolio company.

Temporary investments

Pending investment in other types of “qualifying assets,” as described above, our investments may consist of cash, cash equivalents, U.S. government securities or high-quality debt securities maturing in one year or less from the time of investment, which we refer to, collectively, as temporary investments, so that 70% of our assets are qualifying assets. Typically, we invest in highly rated commercial paper, U.S. Government agency notes, U.S. Treasury bills or in repurchase agreements relating to such securities that are fully collateralized by cash or securities issued by the U.S. government or its agencies. A repurchase agreement involves the purchase by an investor, such as us, of a specified security and the simultaneous agreement by the seller to repurchase it at an agreed-upon future date and at a price which is greater than the purchase price by an amount that reflects an agreed-upon interest rate. Consequently, repurchase agreements are functionally similar to loans. There is no percentage restriction on the proportion of our assets that may be invested in such repurchase agreements. However, the 1940 Act and certain diversification tests in order to qualify as a RIC for federal income tax purposes typically require us to limit the amount we invest with any one counterparty. Our investment Advisor monitors the creditworthiness of the counterparties with which we enter into repurchase agreement transactions.

Warrants and Options

Under the 1940 Act, a BDC is subject to restrictions on the amount of warrants, options, restricted stock or rights to purchase shares of capital stock that it may have outstanding at any time. Under the 1940 Act, we may generally only offer warrants provided that (i) the warrants expire by their terms within ten years, (ii) the exercise or conversion price is not less than the current market value at the date of issuance, (iii) our stockholders authorize the proposal to issue such warrants, and our board of directors approves such issuance on the basis that the issuance is in the best interests of THL Credit and its stockholders and (iv) if the warrants are accompanied by other securities, the warrants are not separately transferable unless no class of such warrants and the securities accompanying them has been publicly distributed. The 1940 Act also provides that the amount of our voting securities that would result from the exercise of all outstanding warrants, as well as options and rights, at the time of issuance may not exceed 25% of our outstanding voting securities. In particular, the amount of capital stock that would result from the conversion or exercise of all outstanding warrants, options or rights to purchase capital stock cannot exceed 25% of the BDC’s total outstanding shares of capital stock.

Senior securities

We are permitted, under specified conditions, to issue multiple classes of indebtedness and one class of stock senior to our common stock if our asset coverage, as defined in the 1940 Act, is at least equal to 200% immediately after each such issuance. In addition, while any preferred stock or publicly traded debt securities are outstanding, we must make provisions to prohibit any distribution to our stockholders or the repurchase of such securities or shares unless we meet the applicable asset coverage ratios at the time of the distribution or repurchase. We may also borrow amounts up to 5% of the value of our total assets for temporary or emergency purposes without regard to asset coverage. For a discussion of the risks associated with leverage, see “Risks—Risks related to our operations as a BDC.”

No-action relief from registration as a commodity pool operator

We are relying on a no-action letter (the “No-Action Letter”) issued by the staff of the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (the “CFTC”) as a basis to avoid registration with the CFTC as a commodity pool operator (“CPO”). The No-Action Letter allows an entity to engage in CFTC-regulated transactions (“commodity interest

 

28


Table of Contents

transactions”) that are “bona fide hedging” transactions (as that term is defined and interpreted by the CFTC and its staff), but prohibit an entity from entering into commodity interest transactions if they are non-bona fide hedging transactions, unless immediately after entering such non-bona fide hedging transaction (a) the sum of the amount of initial margin deposits on the entity’s existing futures or swaps positions and option or swaption premiums does not exceed 5% of the market value of the entity’s liquidating value, after taking into account unrealized profits and unrealized losses on any such transactions, or (b) the aggregate net notional value of the entity’s commodity interest transactions would not exceed 100% of the market value of the entity’s liquidating value, after taking into account unrealized profits and unrealized losses on any such transactions. We are required to operate pursuant to these trading restrictions if we intend to continue to rely on the No-Action Letter as a basis to avoid CPO registration.

Proxy voting policies and procedures

We have delegated our proxy voting responsibility to THL Credit Advisors. The Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures of THL Credit Advisors are set forth below. The guidelines are reviewed periodically by THL Credit Advisors and our independent directors, and, accordingly, are subject to change.

Introduction

THL Credit Advisors is registered as an investment adviser under the Advisers Act. As an investment adviser registered under the Advisers Act, THL Credit Advisors has fiduciary duties to us. As part of this duty, THL Credit Advisors recognizes that it must vote client securities in a timely manner free of conflicts of interest and in our best interests and the best interests of our stockholders. THL Credit Advisors’ Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures have been formulated to ensure decision-making consistent with these fiduciary duties.

These policies and procedures for voting proxies for our investment advisory clients are intended to comply with Section 206 of, and Rule 206(4)-6 under, the Advisers Act.

Proxy policies

THL Credit Advisors evaluates routine proxy matters, such as proxy proposals, amendments or resolutions on a case-by-case basis. Routine matters are typically proposed by management and THL Credit Advisors will normally support such matters so long as they do not measurably change the structure, management control, or operation of the corporation and are consistent with industry standards as well as the corporate laws of the state of incorporation.

THL Credit Advisors also evaluates non-routine matters on a case-by-case basis. Non-routine proposals concerning social issues are typically proposed by stockholders who believe that the corporation’s internally adopted policies are ill-advised or misguided. If THL Credit Advisors has determined that management is generally socially responsible, THL Credit Advisors will generally vote against these types of non-routine proposals. Non-routine proposals concerning financial or corporate issues are usually offered by management and seek to change a corporation’s legal, business or financial structure. THL Credit Advisors will generally vote in favor of such proposals provided the position of current stockholders is preserved or enhanced. Non-routine proposals concerning stockholder rights are made regularly by both management and stockholders. They can be generalized as involving issues that transfer or realign board or stockholder voting power. THL Credit Advisors typically would oppose any proposal aimed solely at thwarting potential takeovers by requiring, for example, super-majority approval. At the same time, THL Credit Advisors believes stability and continuity promote profitability. THL Credit Advisors’ guidelines in this area seek a middle road and individual proposals will be carefully assessed in the context of their particular circumstances.

If a vote may involve a material conflict of interest, prior to approving such vote, THL Credit Advisors must consult with its chief compliance officer to determine whether the potential conflict is material and if so, the

 

29


Table of Contents

appropriate method to resolve such conflict. If the conflict is determined not to be material, THL Credit Advisors’ employees shall vote the proxy in accordance with THL Credit Advisors’ proxy voting policy.

Proxy voting records

You may obtain information about how we voted proxies by making a written request for proxy voting information to:

General Counsel

THL Credit, Inc.

100 Federal Street, 31st Floor

Boston, MA 02110

Code of ethics

We have adopted a code of ethics pursuant to Rule 17j-1 under the 1940 Act and we have also approved our investment adviser’s code of ethics under Rule 17j-1 under the 1940 Act and Rule 204A-1 of the Advisers Act. These codes establish procedures for personal investments and restrict certain personal securities transactions. Personnel subject to the code may invest in securities for their personal investment accounts so long as such investments are made in accordance with the code’s requirements. You may read and copy our code of ethics and our code of ethics and business conduct at the SEC’s Public Reference Room located at 100 F Street, NE, Washington, DC 20549. You may obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. In addition, our code of ethics and our code of ethics and business conduct are available on the EDGAR Database on the SEC’s Internet site at http://www.sec.gov and are available on our corporate governance webpage at http://investor.thlcredit.com/governance.

Privacy Principles

We are committed to maintaining the privacy of stockholders and to safeguarding our non-public personal information. The following information is provided to help you understand what personal information we collect, how we protect that information and why, in certain cases, we may share information with select other parties.

Generally, we do not receive any nonpublic personal information relating to our stockholders, although certain nonpublic personal information of our stockholders may become available to us. We do not disclose any nonpublic personal information about our stockholders or former stockholders to anyone, except as permitted by law or as is necessary in order to service stockholder accounts (for example, to a transfer agent or third party administrator).

We restrict access to nonpublic personal information about our stockholders to our investment adviser’s employees with a legitimate business need for the information. We maintain physical, electronic and procedural safeguards designed to protect the nonpublic personal information of our stockholders.

Compliance with Corporate Governance Regulations

The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (the “Sarbanes-Oxley Act”) imposes a wide variety of regulatory requirements on publicly-held companies and their insiders. Many of these requirements affect us. The Sarbanes-Oxley Act has required us to review our policies and procedures to determine whether we comply with the Sarbanes-Oxley Act and the regulations promulgated thereunder. We will continue to monitor our compliance with all future regulations that are adopted under the Sarbanes-Oxley Act and will take actions necessary to ensure that we are in compliance therewith.

In addition, The NASDAQ Global Select Market has adopted various corporate governance requirements as part of its listing standards. We believe we are in compliance with such corporate governance listing standards. We will continue to monitor our compliance with all future listing standards and will take actions necessary to ensure that we are in compliance therewith.

 

30


Table of Contents

Other

We have adopted an investment policy that mirrors the requirements applicable to us as a BDC under the 1940 Act.

We are subject to periodic examination by the SEC for compliance with the Exchange Act and the 1940 Act.

We are required to provide and maintain a bond issued by a reputable fidelity insurance company to protect us against larceny and embezzlement. Furthermore, as a BDC, we are prohibited from protecting any director or officer against any liability to us or our stockholders arising from willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross negligence or reckless disregard of the duties involved in the conduct of such person’s office.

We and THL Credit Advisors have adopted and implemented written policies and procedures reasonably designed to prevent violation of the federal securities laws, and will review these policies and procedures annually for their adequacy and the effectiveness of their implementation. We and THL Credit Advisors have designated a chief compliance officer to be responsible for administering the policies and procedures.

The 1940 Act prohibits us from making certain negotiated co-investments with affiliates unless we receive an order from the SEC permitting us to do so. We, the Advisor and certain our affiliates have submitted an exemptive application to the SEC to permit us to co-invest with other funds managed by the Advisor or its affiliates in a manner consistent with our investment objective, positions, policies, strategies and restrictions as well as regulatory requirements and other pertinent factors. There can be no assurance that any such exemptive order will be granted. If such relief is granted, then we will be permitted to co-invest with our affiliates if a “required majority” (as defined in Section 57(o) of the 1940 Act) or our independent directors make certain conclusions in connection with a co-investment transaction, including that (1) the terms of the transactions, including the consideration to be paid, are reasonable and fair to us and our stockholders and do not involve overreaching by us or our stockholders on the part of any person concerned and (2) the transaction is consistent with the interests of our stockholders and is consistent with our investment objective and strategies.

You may read and copy any materials we file with the SEC at the SEC’s Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, NE, Washington, DC 20549, on official business days during the hours of 10:00 am to 3:00 pm. You may obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at (202)551-8090. The SEC maintains an Internet site that contains reports, proxy and information statements, and other information regarding issuers that file electronically with the SEC. The address of that site is http://www.sec.gov.

Our internet address is www.thlcredit.com. We make available free of charge on our website our annual report on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K and amendments to those reports as soon as reasonably practicable after we electronically file such material with, or furnish it to, the SEC.

Certain U.S Federal Income Tax Considerations

We have elected to be treated as a RIC under Subchapter M of the Code. As a RIC, we generally do not have to pay corporate-level federal income taxes on any income that we distribute to our stockholders from our tax earnings and profits. To maintain our qualification as a RIC, we must, among other things, meet certain source of income and asset diversification requirements (as described below). In addition, in order maintain RIC tax treatment, we must distribute to our stockholders, for each taxable year, at least 90% of our “investment company taxable income,” which is generally our net ordinary income plus the excess, if any, of realized net short-term capital gains over realized net long-term capital losses (the “Annual Distribution Requirement”).

Taxation as a Regulated Investment Company

If we:

 

   

maintain our qualification as a RIC; and

 

   

satisfy the Annual Distribution Requirement,

 

31


Table of Contents

then we will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax on the portion of our income we distribute (or are deemed to distribute) to stockholders. We will be subject to U.S. federal income tax at the regular corporate rates on any income or capital gains not distributed (or deemed distributed) to our stockholders.

In order to maintain our qualification as a RIC for federal income tax purposes, we must, among other things:

 

   

continue to qualify as a BDC under the 1940 Act at all times during each taxable year;

 

   

derive in each taxable year at least 90% of our gross income from dividends, interest, payments with respect to certain securities loans, gains from the sale of stock or other securities, net income from certain “qualified publicly traded partnerships,” or other income derived with respect to our business of investing in such stock or securities (the “90% Income Test”); and

 

   

diversify our holdings so that at the end of each quarter of the taxable year:

 

   

at least 50% of the value of our assets consists of cash, cash equivalents, U.S. Government securities, securities of other RICs, and other securities if such other securities of any one issuer do not represent more than 5% of the value of our assets or more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of the issuer; and

 

   

no more than 25% of the value of our assets is invested in the securities, other than U.S. Government securities or securities of other RICs, of one issuer, of two or more issuers that are controlled, as determined under applicable Code rules, by us and that are engaged in the same or similar or related trades or businesses or of certain “qualified publicly traded partnerships” (the “Diversification Tests”).

We will be subject to a 4% nondeductible federal excise tax on certain undistributed income unless we distribute in a timely manner an amount at least equal to the sum of (1) 98% of our net ordinary income for each calendar year, (2) 98.2% of our capital gain net income for each calendar year and (3) any income recognized, but not distributed, in preceding years and on which we paid no federal income tax (the “Excise Tax Avoidance Requirement”). We may choose to retain a portion of our ordinary income and/or capital gain net income in any year and pay the 4% U.S. federal excise tax on the retained amounts. For federal income tax purposes, we may be required to recognize taxable income in circumstances in which we do not receive a corresponding payment in cash. For example, if we hold debt obligations that are treated under applicable tax rules as having original issue discount (such as debt instruments with PIK interest or, in certain cases, increasing interest rates or debt instruments that were issued with warrants), we must include in income each year a portion of the original issue discount that accrues over the life of the obligation, regardless of whether cash representing such income is received by us in the same taxable year. We may also have to include in income other amounts that we have not yet received in cash, such as deferred loan origination fees that are paid after origination of the loan or are paid in non-cash compensation such as warrants or stock. Certain consolidated subsidiaries of the Company are subject to U.S. federal and state income taxes. These taxable entities are not consolidated with the Company for income tax purposes and may generate income tax liabilities or assets from temporary differences in the recognition of items for financial reporting and income tax purposes at the subsidiaries.

Because any original issue discount or other amounts accrued will be included in our investment company taxable income for the year of the accrual, we may be required to make a distribution to our stockholders in order to satisfy the Annual Distribution Requirement, even though we will not have received any corresponding cash amount. As a result, we may have difficulty meeting the annual distribution requirement necessary to obtain and maintain RIC tax treatment under the Code. We may have to sell some of our investments at times and/or at prices we would not consider advantageous, raise additional debt or equity capital or forgo new investment opportunities for this purpose. If we are not able to obtain cash from other sources, we may fail to qualify for RIC tax treatment and thus become subject to corporate-level income tax.

We are authorized to borrow funds and to sell assets in order to satisfy distribution requirements. However, under the 1940 Act, we are not permitted to make distributions to our stockholders while our debt obligations and

 

32


Table of Contents

other senior securities are outstanding unless certain “asset coverage” tests are met. Moreover, our ability to dispose of assets to meet our distribution requirements may be limited by (1) the illiquid nature of our portfolio and/or (2) other requirements relating to our status as a RIC, including the Diversification Tests. If we dispose of assets in order to meet the Annual Distribution Requirement or the Excise Tax Avoidance Requirement, we may make such dispositions at times that, from an investment standpoint, are not advantageous.

Certain of our investment practices may be subject to special and complex federal income tax provisions that may, among other things, (1) treat dividends that would otherwise qualify for the dividends received deduction or constitute qualified dividend income as ineligible for such treatment, (2) disallow, suspend or otherwise limit the allowance of certain losses or deductions, (3) convert lower-taxed long-term capital gain into higher-taxed short-term capital gain or ordinary income, (4) convert an ordinary loss or a deduction into a capital loss (the deductibility of which is more limited), (5) cause us to recognize income or gain without receipt of a corresponding distribution of cash, (6) adversely affect the time as to when a purchase or sale of stock or securities is deemed to occur, (7) adversely alter the characterization of certain complex financial transactions and (8) produce income that will not be qualifying income for purposes of the 90% Income Test. We will monitor our transactions and may make certain tax elections to mitigate the potential adverse effect of these provisions, but there can be no assurance that any adverse effects of these provisions will be mitigated.

If we purchase shares in a “passive foreign investment company” (a “PFIC”), we may be subject to federal income tax on its allocable share of a portion of any “excess distribution” received on, or any gain from the disposition of, such shares even if our allocable share of such income is distributed as a taxable dividend to its stockholders. Additional charges in the nature of interest generally will be imposed on us in respect of deferred taxes arising from any such excess distribution or gain. If we invest in a PFIC and elect to treat the PFIC as a “qualified electing fund” under the Code (a “QEF”), in lieu of the foregoing requirements, we will be required to include in income each year our proportionate share of the ordinary earnings and net capital gain of the QEF, even if such income is not distributed by the QEF. Alternatively, we may be able to elect to mark-to-market at the end of each taxable year our shares in a PFIC; in this case, we will recognize as ordinary income our allocable share of any increase in the value of such shares, and as ordinary loss our allocable share of any decrease in such value to the extent that any such decrease does not exceed prior increases included in its income. Under either election, we may be required to recognize in a year income in excess of distributions from PFICs and proceeds from dispositions of PFIC stock during that year, and such income will nevertheless be subject to the Annual Distribution Requirement and will be taken into account for purposes of the 4% excise tax.

 

33


Table of Contents
Item 1A. Risk Factors

Before you invest in our securities, you should be aware of various risks, including those described below. You should carefully consider these risk factors, together with all of the other information included in this prospectus, before you decide whether to make an investment in our securities. The risks set out below are not the only risks we face, but they are the principal risks associated with an investment in the Company. If any of the following events occur, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be materially adversely affected. In such case, our net asset value and the trading price of our common stock could decline, and you may lose all or part of your investment.

RISKS RELATED TO OUR BUSINESS

We may suffer credit losses.

Investment in middle market companies is highly speculative and involves a high degree of risk of credit loss, and therefore our securities may not be suitable for someone with a low tolerance for risk. These risks are likely to increase during an economic recession.

The lack of liquidity in our investments may adversely affect our business.

Our investments generally are made in private companies. Substantially all of these securities are subject to legal and other restrictions on resale or will be otherwise less liquid than publicly traded securities. The illiquidity of our investments may make it difficult for us to sell such investments if the need arises. In addition, if we are required to liquidate all or a portion of our portfolio quickly, we may realize significantly less than the value at which we had previously recorded our investments. Further, we may face other restrictions on our ability to liquidate an investment in a portfolio company to the extent that we or an affiliated manager have material non-public information regarding such portfolio company.

There will be uncertainty as to the value of our portfolio investments.

A large percentage of our portfolio investments are in the form of securities that are not publicly traded. The fair value of securities and other investments that are not publicly traded may not be readily determinable. We value these securities on a quarterly basis in accordance with our valuation policy, which is at all times consistent with U.S. generally accepted accounting policies (“GAAP”). Our board of directors utilizes the services of third-party valuation firms to aid it in determining the fair value of these securities. The board of directors discusses valuations and determines the fair value in good faith based on the input of our investment adviser and the respective third-party valuation firms. The factors that may be considered in fair value pricing our investments include the nature and realizable value of any collateral, the portfolio company’s ability to make payments and its earnings, the markets in which the portfolio company does business, comparisons to publicly traded companies, discounted cash flow and other relevant factors. Because such valuations, and particularly valuations of private securities and private companies, are inherently uncertain, may fluctuate over short periods of time and may be based on estimates, our determinations of fair value may differ materially from the values that would have been used if a ready market for these securities existed. Our net asset value could be adversely affected if our determinations regarding the fair value of our investments were materially higher than the values that we ultimately realize upon the disposal of such securities.

Our financial condition and results of operations depend on our ability to manage future growth effectively.

Our ability to achieve our investment objective depends on our ability to acquire suitable investments and monitor and administer those investments, which depends, in turn, on THL Credit Advisors ability to identify, invest in and monitor companies that meet our investment criteria.

 

34


Table of Contents

Accomplishing this result on a cost-effective basis is largely a function of the structuring of our investment process and the ability of our investment adviser to provide competent, attentive and efficient services to us. Our executive officers and the members of our investment adviser’s investment committee have substantial responsibilities in connection with their roles at THL Credit and with the other THL Credit funds, as well as responsibilities under the investment advisory and management agreement. They may also be called upon to provide significant managerial assistance to certain of our portfolio companies. These demands on their time, which will increase as the number of investments grow, may distract them or slow the rate of investment. In order to grow, THL Credit Advisors will need to hire, train, supervise, manage and retain new employees. However, we cannot assure you that we will be able to do so effectively. Any failure to manage our future growth effectively could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

In addition, as we grow, we may open up new offices in new geographic regions that may increase our direct operating expenses without corresponding revenue growth.

We may experience fluctuations in our periodic operating results.

We could experience fluctuations in our periodic operating results due to a number of factors, including the interest rates payable on the debt securities we acquire, the default rates on such securities, the level of our expenses (including the interest rates payable on our borrowings), the dividend rates payable on preferred stock we issue, variations in and the timing of the recognition of realized and unrealized gains or losses, the degree to which we encounter competition in our markets and general economic conditions. As a result of these factors, results for any period should not be relied upon as being indicative of performance in future periods.

We are exposed to risks associated with changes in interest rates, including fluctuations in interest rates which could adversely affect our profitability.

General interest rate fluctuations may have a substantial negative impact on our investments and investment opportunities, and, accordingly, may have a material adverse effect on our investment objective and rate of return on investment capital. A portion of our income will depend upon the difference between the rate at which we borrow funds and the interest rate on the debt securities in which we invest. Because we will borrow money to make investments and may issue debt securities, preferred stock or other securities, our net investment income is dependent upon the difference between the rate at which we borrow funds or pay interest or dividends on such debt securities, preferred stock or other securities and the rate at which we invest these funds. Typically, we anticipate that our interest earning investments will accrue and pay interest at both variable and fixed rates, and that our interest-bearing liabilities will accrue interest at variable rates. The benchmarks used to determine the floating rates earned on our interest earning investments are London Interbank Offered Rate, or LIBOR, with maturities that range between one and twelve months and alternate base rate, or ABR, (commonly based on the Prime Rate or the Federal Funds Rate), with no fixed maturity date. As a result, there can be no assurance that a significant change in market interest rates will not have a material adverse effect on our net investment income. We use a combination of equity and long-term and short-term borrowings to finance our investment activities.

A significant increase in market interest rates could harm our ability to attract new portfolio companies and originate new loans and investments. We expect that a portion of our investments in debt will be at floating rates with a floor. However, in the event that we make investments in debt at variable rates, a significant increase in market interest rates could also result in an increase in our non-performing assets and a decrease in the value of our portfolio because our floating-rate loan portfolio companies may be unable to meet higher payment obligations. In periods of rising interest rates, our cost of funds would increase, resulting in a decrease in our net investment income. In addition, a decrease in interest rates may reduce net income, because new investments may be made at lower rates despite the increased demand for our capital that the decrease in interest rates may produce. We may, but will not be required to, hedge against the risk of adverse movement in interest rates in our short-term and long-term borrowings relative to our portfolio of assets. If we engage in hedging activities, it may

 

35


Table of Contents

limit our ability to participate in the benefits of lower interest rates with respect to the hedged portfolio. Adverse developments resulting from changes in interest rates or hedging transactions could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, and results of operations.

Any failure on our part to maintain our status as a BDC would reduce our operating flexibility.

If we fail to continue to qualify as a BDC, we might be regulated as a closed-end investment company under the 1940 Act, which would subject us to substantially more regulatory restrictions under the 1940 Act and correspondingly decrease our operating flexibility and could significantly increase our costs of doing business. Furthermore, any failure to comply with the requirements imposed on BDCs by the 1940 Act could cause the SEC to bring an enforcement action against us.

To the extent we use debt or preferred stock to finance our investments, changes in interest rates will affect our cost of capital and net investment income.

To the extent we borrow money, or issue preferred stock, to make investments, our net investment income will depend, in part, upon the difference between the rate at which we borrow funds or pay dividends on preferred stock and the rate at which we invest those funds. As a result, we can offer no assurance that a significant change in market interest rates will not have a material adverse effect on our net investment income in the event we use debt to finance our investments. In periods of rising interest rates, our cost of funds would increase, except to the extent we issue fixed rate debt or preferred stock, which could reduce our net investment income. We expect that our long-term fixed-rate investments will be financed primarily with equity and long-term debt. We may use interest rate risk management techniques in an effort to limit our exposure to interest rate fluctuations. Such techniques may include various interest rate hedging activities to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act.

A rise in the general level of interest rates can be expected to lead to higher interest rates applicable to our debt investments. Accordingly, an increase in interest rates would make it easier for us to meet or exceed the incentive fee hurdle rate and may result in a substantial increase of the amount of incentive fees payable to our investment adviser with respect to our pre-incentive fee net investment income.

Because we have substantial indebtedness, there could be increased risk in investing in our company.

Lenders have fixed dollar claims on our assets that are superior to the claims of stockholders, and we have granted, and may in the future grant, lenders a security interest in our assets in connection with borrowings. In the case of a liquidation event, those lenders would receive proceeds before our stockholders. In addition, borrowings, also known as leverage, magnify the potential for gain or loss on amounts invested and, therefore, increase the risks associated with investing in our securities. Leverage is generally considered a speculative investment technique. If the value of our assets increases, then leveraging would cause the net asset value attributable to our common stock to increase more than it otherwise would have had we not leveraged.

Conversely, if the value of our assets decreases, leveraging would cause the net asset value attributable to our common stock to decline more than it otherwise would have had we not leveraged. Similarly, any increase in our revenue in excess of interest expense on our borrowed funds would cause our net income to increase more than it would without the leverage. Any decrease in our revenue would cause our net income to decline more than it would have had we not borrowed funds and could negatively affect our ability to make distributions on common stock. Our ability to service any debt that we incur will depend largely on our financial performance and will be subject to prevailing economic conditions and competitive pressures. We and, indirectly, our stockholders will bear the cost associated with our leverage activity.

As of December 31, 2014, there was $303.5 million of commitments under our revolving credit agreement, or Revolving Facility, and $106.5 million of commitments under our term loan agreement, or Term Loan Facility.

 

36


Table of Contents

The Revolving Facility has a maturity date of April 2018 (with a one year term out period beginning in April 2017). The one year term out period is the one year anniversary between the revolver termination date, or the end of the availability period, and the maturity date. During this time, we are required to make mandatory prepayments on our loans from the proceeds we receive from the sale of assets, extraordinary receipts, returns of capital or the issuances of equity or debt. The Term Loan Facility has a maturity date of April 2019. Each of the Revolving Facility and Term Loan Facility, together the Facilities, includes an accordion feature permitting us to expand the Facilities, if certain conditions are satisfied; provided, however, that the aggregate amount of the Facilities, collectively, is capped at $600.0 million. ING serves as administrative agent, lead arranger and bookrunner under each of the Facilities.

On November 18, 2014, we closed a public offering of $50.0 million in aggregate principal amount of 6.75% notes, or the Notes, which included the subsequent exercise of an overallotment. The Notes mature on November 15, 2021, and may be redeemed in whole or in part at any time or from time to time at the Company’s option on or after November 15, 2017. The Notes bear interest at a rate of 6.75% per year.

As of December 31, 2014, there was $294.9 million of borrowings outstanding against the Facilities at a weighted average interest rate of 2.96%. As of December 31, 2014, there was $50.0 million of Notes payable at an interest rate of 6.75%. As of December 31, 2014, our asset coverage ratio was over 200%. This example is for illustrative purposes only, and actual interest rates on our Facility borrowing are likely to fluctuate. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Financial Condition, Liquidity and Capital resources—Credit Facility” and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Financial Condition, Liquidity and Capital resources— Notes” for additional information about the Facilities and Notes.

As a BDC, generally we are not permitted to incur indebtedness unless immediately after such borrowing we have an asset coverage for total borrowings of at least 200% (i.e., the amount of debt may not exceed 50% of the value of our assets). In addition, we may not be permitted to declare any cash dividend or other distribution on our outstanding common shares, or purchase any such shares, unless, at the time of such declaration or purchase, we have asset coverage of at least 200% after deducting the amount of such dividend, distribution, or purchase price. If this ratio declines below 200%, we may not be able to incur additional debt and may need to sell a portion of our investments to repay some debt when it is disadvantageous to do so, and we may not be able to make distributions.

The following table is designed to illustrate the effect on the return to a holder of our common stock on the leverage created by our use of borrowing at December 31, 2014 of $344.9 million at an average interest rate at the time of 3.51%, and assuming hypothetical annual returns on our portfolio of minus 10 to plus 10 percent. The table also assumes that we maintain a constant level of leverage and a constant weighted average interest rate. The amount of leverage we use will vary from time to time. As can be seen, leverage generally increases the return to stockholders when the portfolio return is positive and decreases return to stockholders when the portfolio return is negative. Actual returns may be greater or less than those appearing in the table below.

 

Assumed return on portfolio (net of expenses)(1)

     (10.00%)         (5.00%)         0.00%         5.00     10.00

Corresponding return to common stockholders(2)

     (17.53%)         (10.10%)         (2.67%)         4.76     12.19

 

(1) 

The assumed portfolio return is required by regulation of the SEC and is not a prediction of, and does not represent, our projected or actual performance.

(2) 

In order to compute the “corresponding return to common stockholders,” the “assumed return on the portfolio” is multiplied by the total value of our assets at the beginning of the period ($672.9 million as of December 31, 2013) to obtain an assumed return to us. From this amount, all interest expense expected to be accrued during the period ($12.1 million) is subtracted to determine the return available to stockholders. The return available to stockholders is then divided by the total value of our net assets as of the beginning of the period ($452.9 million) to determine the “corresponding return to common stockholders.”

 

37


Table of Contents

The Notes are structurally subordinated to the indebtedness and other liabilities of our subsidiaries.

The Notes are obligations exclusively of THL Credit, Inc. and not of any of our subsidiaries. None of our subsidiaries are a guarantor of the Notes and the Notes are not required to be guaranteed by any subsidiaries we may acquire or create in the future. Except to the extent we are a creditor with recognized claims against our subsidiaries, all claims of creditors of our subsidiaries will have priority over our equity interests in such subsidiaries (and therefore the claims of our creditors, including holders of the Notes) with respect to the assets of such subsidiaries. Even if we are recognized as a creditor of one or more of our subsidiaries, our claims would still be effectively subordinated to any security interests in the assets of any such subsidiary and to any indebtedness or other liabilities of any such subsidiary senior to our claims. Consequently, the Notes are structurally subordinated to all indebtedness and other liabilities of any of our subsidiaries and any subsidiaries that we may in the future acquire or establish. In addition, our subsidiaries may incur substantial additional indebtedness in the future, all of which would be structurally senior to the Notes.

The indenture under which our Notes were issued contains limited protection for holders of our Notes.

The indenture under which the Notes were issued offers limited protection to holders of the Notes. The terms of the indenture and the Notes do not restrict our or any of our subsidiaries’ ability to engage in, or otherwise be a party to, a variety of corporate transactions, circumstances or events that could have an adverse impact on your investment in the Notes. In particular, the terms of the indenture and the Notes will not place any restrictions on our or our subsidiaries’ ability to:

 

   

issue securities or otherwise incur additional indebtedness or other obligations, including (1) any indebtedness or other obligations that would be equal in right of payment to the Notes, (2) any indebtedness or other obligations that would be secured and therefore rank effectively senior in right of payment to the Notes to the extent of the values of the assets securing such debt, (3) indebtedness of ours that is guaranteed by one or more of our subsidiaries and which therefore is structurally senior to the Notes and (4) securities, indebtedness or obligations issued or incurred by our subsidiaries that would be senior to our equity interests in our subsidiaries and therefore rank structurally senior to the Notes with respect to the assets of our subsidiaries, in each case other than an incurrence of indebtedness or other obligation that would cause a violation of Section 18(a)(1)(A) as modified by Section 61(a)(1) of the 1940 Act or any successor provisions, whether or not we continue to be subject to such provisions of the 1940 Act, but giving effect, in either case, to any exemptive relief granted to us by the SEC (these provisions generally prohibit us from making additional borrowings, including through the issuance of additional debt or the sale of additional debt securities, unless our asset coverage, as defined in the 1940 Act, equals at least 200% after such borrowings);

 

   

pay dividends on, or purchase or redeem or make any payments in respect of, capital stock or other securities ranking junior in right of payment to the Notes;

 

   

sell assets (other than certain limited restrictions on our ability to consolidate, merge or sell all or substantially all of our assets);

 

   

enter into transactions with affiliates;

 

   

create liens (including liens on the shares of our subsidiaries) or enter into sale and leaseback transactions;

 

   

make investments; or

 

   

create restrictions on the payment of dividends or other amounts to us from our subsidiaries.

In addition, the indenture will not require us to offer to purchase the Notes in connection with a change of control or any other event.

Furthermore, the terms of the indenture and the Notes do not protect holders of the Notes in the event that we experience changes (including significant adverse changes) in our financial condition, results of operations or

 

38


Table of Contents

credit ratings, as they do not require that we or our subsidiaries adhere to any financial tests or ratios or specified levels of net worth, revenues, income, cash flow, or liquidity.

Our ability to recapitalize, incur additional debt and take a number of other actions that are not limited by the terms of the Notes may have important consequences for you as a holder of the Notes, including making it more difficult for us to satisfy our obligations with respect to the Notes or negatively affecting the trading value of the Notes.

Certain of our current debt instruments include more protections for their holders than the indenture and the Notes. In addition, other debt we issue or incur in the future could contain more protections for its holders than the indenture and the Notes, including additional covenants and events of default. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Financial condition, liquidity and capital resources—Credit Facility.” The issuance or incurrence of any such debt with incremental protections could affect the market for and trading levels and prices of the Notes.

If we default on our obligations to pay our other indebtedness, we may not be able to make payments on the Notes.

Any default under the agreements governing our indebtedness, including a default under the Revolving Facility, the Term Loan Facility or other indebtedness to which we may be a party that is not waived by the required lenders or holders, and the remedies sought by the holders of such indebtedness could make us unable to pay principal, premium, if any, and interest on the Notes and substantially decrease the market value of the Notes. If we are unable to generate sufficient cash flow and are otherwise unable to obtain funds necessary to meet required payments of principal, premium, if any, and interest on our indebtedness, or if we otherwise fail to comply with the various covenants, including financial and operating covenants, in the instruments governing our indebtedness, we could be in default under the terms of the agreements governing such indebtedness. In the event of such default, the holders of such indebtedness could elect to declare all the funds borrowed thereunder to be due and payable, together with accrued and unpaid interest, the lenders under the Revolving Facility or the Term Loan Facility or other debt we may incur in the future could elect to terminate their commitments, cease making further loans and institute foreclosure proceedings against our assets, and we could be forced into bankruptcy or liquidation. If our operating performance declines, we may in the future need to seek to obtain waivers from the required lenders under the Revolving Facility or the Term Loan Facility or other debt that we may incur in the future to avoid being in default. If we breach our covenants under the Revolving Facility or the Term Loan Facility or other debt and seek a waiver, we may not be able to obtain a waiver from the required lenders or holders. If this occurs, we would be in default under the Revolving Facility or the Term Loan Facility or other debt, the lenders or holders could exercise their rights as described above, and we could be forced into bankruptcy or liquidation. If we are unable to repay debt, lenders having secured obligations, including the lenders under the Revolving Facility and the Term Loan Facility, could proceed against the collateral securing the debt. Because the Revolving Facility and the Term Loan Facility have, and any future credit facilities will likely have, customary cross-default provisions, if the indebtedness under the Notes, the Revolving Facility or the Term Loan Facility or under any future credit facility is accelerated, we may be unable to repay or finance the amounts due.

We may default under the Facilities or any future borrowing facility we enter into or be unable to amend, repay or refinance any such facility on commercially reasonable terms, or at all, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

As of December 31, 2014, all of our assets were pledged as collateral under the Facilities. In the event we default under the Facilities or any other future borrowing facility, our business could be adversely affected as we may be forced to sell all or a portion of our investments quickly and prematurely at what may be disadvantageous prices to us in order to meet our outstanding payment obligations and/or support working capital requirements under the Facilities or such future borrowing facility, any of which would have a material adverse effect on our

 

39


Table of Contents

business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows. In addition, following any such default, the agent for the lenders under the Facilities or such future borrowing facility could assume control of the disposition of any or all of our assets, including the selection of such assets to be disposed and the timing of such disposition, which would have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

Substantially all of our assets are subject to security interests under the Facilities and if we default on our obligations under the Facilities we may suffer adverse consequences, including foreclosure on our assets.

As of December 31, 2014, all of our assets were pledged as collateral under the Facilities. If we default on our obligations under the Facilities, the lenders may have the right to foreclose upon and sell, or otherwise transfer, the collateral subject to their security interests or their superior claim. In such event, we may be forced to sell our investments to raise funds to repay our outstanding borrowings in order to avoid foreclosure and these forced sales may be at times and at prices we would not consider advantageous. Moreover, such deleveraging of our company could significantly impair our ability to effectively operate our business in the manner in which we have historically operated. As a result, we could be forced to curtail or cease new investment activities and lower or eliminate the dividends that we have historically paid to our stockholders.

In addition, if the lenders exercise their right to sell the assets pledged under the Facilities, such sales may be completed at distressed sale prices, thereby diminishing or potentially eliminating the amount of cash available to us after repayment of the amounts outstanding under the Facilities.

Because we use debt to finance our investments and have issued senior securities, and, in the future, may issue additional senior securities, including preferred stock and debt securities, if market interest rates were to increase, our cost of capital could increase, which could reduce our net investment income.

Because we borrow money to make investments and have issued senior securities and, in the future, may issue additional senior securities, including preferred stock and debt securities, our net investment income will depend, in part, upon the difference between the rate at which we borrow funds and the rate at which we invest those funds. As a result, we can offer no assurance that a significant change in market interest rates would not have a material adverse effect on our net investment income in the event we use debt to finance our investments. In periods of rising interest rates, our cost of funds would increase, which could reduce our net investment income. We may use interest rate risk management techniques in an effort to limit our exposure to interest rate fluctuations. We may utilize instruments such as forward contracts, currency options and interest rate swaps, caps, collars and floors to seek to hedge against fluctuations in the relative values of our portfolio positions from changes in currency exchange rates and market interest rates to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act. In addition, a rise in the general level of interest rates typically leads to higher interest rates applicable to our debt investments. Accordingly, an increase in interest rates may result in an increase of the amount of our pre-incentive fee net investment income and, as a result, an increase in incentive fees payable to THL Credit Advisors. Adverse developments resulting from changes in interest rates or hedging transactions could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We may in the future determine to fund a portion of our investments with preferred stock, which would magnify the potential for gain or loss and the risks of investing in us in the same way as our borrowings.

Preferred stock, which is another form of leverage, has the same risks to our common stockholders as borrowings because the dividends on any preferred stock we issue must be cumulative. Payment of such dividends and repayment of the liquidation preference of such preferred stock must take preference over any dividends or other payments to our common stockholders, and preferred stockholders are not subject to any of our expenses or losses and are not entitled to participate in any income or appreciation in excess of their stated preference.

 

40


Table of Contents

Our use of borrowed funds to make investments exposes us to risks typically associated with leverage.

We borrow money and may issue additional debt securities or preferred stock to leverage our capital structure. As a result:

 

   

our common shares would be exposed to incremental risk of loss; therefore, a decrease in the value of our investments would have a greater negative impact on the value of our common shares than if we did not use leverage;

 

   

any depreciation in the value of our assets may magnify losses associated with an investment and could totally eliminate the value of an asset to us;

 

   

if we do not appropriately match the assets and liabilities of our business and interest or dividend rates on such assets and liabilities, adverse changes in interest rates could reduce or eliminate the incremental income we make with the proceeds of any leverage;

 

   

our ability to pay dividends on our common stock may be restricted if our asset coverage ratio, as provided in the 1940 Act, is not at least 200%, and any amounts used to service indebtedness or preferred stock would not be available for such dividends;

 

   

any credit facility would be subject to periodic renewal by our lenders, whose continued participation cannot be guaranteed;

 

   

such securities would be governed by an indenture or other instrument containing covenants restricting our operating flexibility or affecting our investment or operating policies, and may require us to pledge assets or provide other security for such indebtedness;

 

   

we, and indirectly our common stockholders, bear the entire cost of issuing and paying interest or dividends on such securities;

 

   

if we issue preferred stock, the special voting rights and preferences of preferred stockholders may result in such stockholders’ having interests that are not aligned with the interests of our common stockholders, and the rights of our preferred stockholders to dividends and liquidation preferences will be senior to the rights of our common stockholders;

 

   

any convertible or exchangeable securities that we issue may have rights, preferences and privileges more favorable than those of our common shares; and

 

   

any custodial relationships associated with our use of leverage would conform to the requirements of the 1940 Act, and no creditor would have veto power over our investment policies, strategies, objectives or decisions except in an event of default or if our asset coverage was less than 200%.

Under the provisions of the 1940 Act, we are permitted, as a BDC, to issue senior securities only in amounts such that our asset coverage ratio equals at least 200% after each issuance of senior securities. If the value of our assets declines, we may be unable to satisfy this test and we may be required to sell a portion of our investments and, depending on the nature of our leverage, repay a portion of our senior securities at a time when such sales may be disadvantageous.

To the extent original issue discount and PIK interest constitute a portion of our income, we will be exposed to typical risks associated with such income being required to be included in taxable and accounting income prior to receipt of cash representing such income.

Our investments may include original issue discount, or OID, instruments and contractual PIK, interest, which represents contractual interest added to a loan balance and due at the end of such loan’s term. To the extent OID or PIK interest constitute a portion of our income, we are exposed to typical risks associated with such income being required to be included in taxable and accounting income prior to receipt of cash. Such risks include:

 

   

The higher interest rates of OID and PIK instruments reflect the payment deferral and increased credit risk associated with these instruments, and OID and PIK instruments generally represent a significantly higher credit risk than coupon loans.

 

41


Table of Contents
   

Even if the accounting conditions for income accrual are met, the borrower could still default when our actual collection is supposed to occur at the maturity of the obligation.

 

   

OID and PIK instruments may have unreliable valuations because their continuing accruals require continuing judgments about the collectability of the deferred payments and the value of any associated collateral. OID and PIK income may also create uncertainty about the source of our cash distributions.

 

   

For accounting purposes, any cash distributions to shareholders representing OID and PIK income are not treated as coming from paid-in capital, even though the cash to pay them comes from the offering proceeds. As a result, despite the fact that a distribution representing OID and PIK income could be paid out of amounts invested by our stockholders, the 1940 Act does not require that stockholders be given notice of this fact by reporting it as a return of capital.

 

   

PIK interest has the effect of generating investment income at a compounding rate, thereby further increasing the incentive fees payable to the Advisor. Similarly, all things being equal, the deferral associated with PIK interest also decreases the loan-to-value ratio at a compounding rate.

We may have difficulty paying our required distributions if we recognize income before or without receiving cash representing such income.

For federal income tax purposes, we may include in income certain amounts that we have not yet received in cash, such as original issue discount, which may arise if we receive warrants in connection with making a loan, or possibly in other circumstances, or PIK interest, which represents contractual interest added to the loan balance and due at the end of the loan term. Such original issue discount, which could be significant relative to our overall investment activities, or increases in loan balances as a result of PIK arrangements are included in income before we receive any corresponding cash payments. In addition, the PIK interest of many subordinated loans effectively operates as negative amortization of loan principal, thereby increasing credit risk exposure over the life of the loan because more will be owed at the end of the term of the loan than was owed when the loan was initially originated. We also may be required to include in income certain other amounts that we do not receive in cash.

Since we may recognize income before or without receiving cash representing such income, we may have difficulty meeting the tax requirement to distribute at least 90% of our ordinary income and realized net short-term capital gains in excess of realized net long-term capital losses, if any, to maintain our status as a RIC. Accordingly, we may have to sell some of our investments at times we would not consider advantageous, raise additional debt or equity capital or reduce new investment originations to meet these distribution requirements.

We may pay an incentive fee on income we do not receive in cash.

That part of the incentive fee payable by us that relates to our net investment income is computed and paid on income that may include interest that has been accrued but not yet received in cash. If a portfolio company defaults on a loan, it is possible that accrued interest previously used in the calculation of the incentive fee will become uncollectible. Consequently, while we may make incentive fee payments on income accruals that we may not collect in the future and with respect to which we do not have a formal clawback right against our investment adviser per se, the amount of accrued income written off in any period will reduce the income in the period in which such write-off was taken and thereby reduce such period’s incentive fee payment, but only to the extent that such an incentive fee is payable for that period because the write-off will not be carried forward to reduce any incentive fee payable in subsequent quarters.

The highly competitive market in which we operate may limit our investment opportunities.

A number of entities compete with us to make the types of investments that we make. We compete with other BDCs, public and private funds, commercial and investment banks, CLO funds, commercial finance companies, and, to the extent they provide an alternative form of financing, private equity and hedge funds. Additionally, because competition for investment opportunities generally has increased among alternative

 

42


Table of Contents

investment vehicles such as hedge funds, entities have begun to invest in areas in which they had not traditionally invested. As a result of these new entrants, competition for investment opportunities intensified in recent years and may intensify further in the future. Some of our existing and potential competitors are substantially larger and have considerably greater financial, technical and marketing resources than we do. For example, some competitors may have a lower cost of funds and access to funding sources that are not available to us. In addition, some of our competitors may have higher risk tolerances or different risk assessments, which could allow them to consider a wider variety of investments and establish more relationships than us. Furthermore, many of our competitors are not subject to the regulatory restrictions that the 1940 Act imposes on us as a BDC and that the Code imposes on us as a RIC. We cannot assure you that the competitive pressures we face will not have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. Also, as a result of this existing and potentially increasing competition, we may not be able to take advantage of attractive investment opportunities from time to time, and we can offer no assurance that we will be able to identify and make investments that are consistent with our investment objective.

With respect to the investments we make, we do not seek to compete based primarily on the interest rates we offer, and we believe that some of our competitors may make loans with interest rates that are lower than the rates we offer. With respect to all investments, we may lose some investment opportunities if we do not match our competitors’ pricing, terms and structure. However, if we match our competitors’ pricing, terms and structure, we may experience decreased net interest income, lower yields and increased risk of credit loss. We may also compete for investment opportunities with investment funds, accounts and investment vehicles managed by THL Credit Advisors. Although THL Credit Advisors will allocate opportunities in accordance with its policies and procedures, allocations to such investment funds, accounts and investment vehicles will reduce the amount and frequency of opportunities available to us and may not be in the best interests of us and our stockholders.

We are dependent upon senior management personnel of our investment adviser for our future success, and if our investment adviser is unable to retain qualified personnel or if our investment adviser loses any member of its senior management team, our ability to achieve our investment objective could be significantly harmed.

We depend on the members of senior management of THL Credit Advisors, particularly its Co-Chief Executive Officers, Sam W. Tillinghast and Christopher J. Flynn, its President, W. Hunter Stropp, its Chief Operating Officer and Chief Financial Officer, Terrence W. Olson, and its Chief Legal Officer, Stephanie Paré Sullivan, collectively, the THL Credit Principals. Messrs. Tillinghast Flynn and Stropp constitute the investment principals of THL Credit Advisors, or the THL Credit Investment Principals. The THL Credit Investment Principals and other investment professionals make up our investment team and are responsible for the identification, final selection, structuring, closing and monitoring of our investments. These investment team members have critical industry experience and relationships that we will rely on to implement our business plan. Our future success depends on the continued service of the THL Credit Principals and the rest of our investment adviser’s senior management team. The departure of any of the members of THL Credit Advisors’ senior management or a significant number of the members of its investment team could have a material adverse effect on our ability to achieve our investment objective. As a result, we may not be able to operate our business as we expect, and our ability to compete could be harmed, which could cause our operating results to suffer. In addition, we can offer no assurance that THL Credit Advisors will remain our investment adviser or our administrator.

Our investment adviser has the right to resign on 60 days’ notice, and we may not be able to find a suitable replacement within that time, resulting in a disruption in our operations that could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

THL Credit Advisors has the right, under our investment management agreement, to resign at any time upon not more than 60 days’ written notice, whether we have found a new replacement or not. If our investment adviser resigns, we may not be able to find a new investment adviser or hire internal management with similar

 

43


Table of Contents

expertise and ability to provide the same or equivalent services on acceptable terms within 60 days, or at all. If we are unable to do so quickly, our operations are likely to experience a disruption, our financial condition, business and results of operations as well as our ability to pay distributions are likely to be adversely affected and the market price of our shares may decline. In addition, the coordination of our internal management and investment activities is likely to suffer if we are unable to identify and reach an agreement with a single institution or group of executives having the expertise possessed by our investment adviser and its affiliates. Even if we are able to retain comparable management, whether internal or external, the integration of such management and their lack of familiarity with our investment objective may result in additional costs and time delays that may adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Because we expect to distribute substantially all of our net investment income and net realized capital gains to our stockholders, we will need additional capital to finance our growth and such capital may not be available on favorable terms or at all.

We have elected to be taxed for federal income tax purposes as a RIC under Subchapter M of the Code. If we meet certain requirements, including source of income, asset diversification and distribution requirements, and if we continue to qualify as a BDC, we will continue to qualify to be a RIC under the Code and will not have to pay corporate-level income taxes on income we distribute to our stockholders as dividends, allowing us to substantially reduce or eliminate our corporate-level income tax liability. As a BDC, we are generally required to meet a coverage ratio of total assets to total senior securities, which includes all of our borrowings and any preferred stock we may issue in the future, of at least 200% at the time we issue any debt or preferred stock. This requirement limits the amount that we may borrow. Because we will continue to need capital to grow our investment portfolio, this limitation may prevent us from incurring debt or preferred stock and require us to raise additional equity at a time when it may be disadvantageous to do so. We cannot assure you that debt and equity financing will be available to us on favorable terms, or at all, and debt financings may be restricted by the terms of any of our outstanding borrowings. In addition, as a BDC, we are generally not permitted to issue common stock priced below net asset value without stockholder approval. If additional funds are not available to us, we could be forced to curtail or cease new lending and investment activities, and our net asset value could decline.

Our board of directors may change our investment objective, operating policies and strategies without prior notice or stockholder approval.

Our board of directors has the authority to modify or waive certain of our operating policies and strategies without prior notice and without stockholder approval (except as required by the 1940 Act). However, absent stockholder approval, we may not change the nature of our business so as to cease to be, or withdraw our election as, a BDC. We cannot predict the effect any changes to our current operating policies and strategies would have on our business, operating results or value of our stock. Nevertheless, the effects could adversely affect our business and impact our ability to make distributions and cause you to lose all or part of your investment.

Our investment adviser and its affiliates, senior management and employees have certain conflicts of interest.

Our investment adviser, its senior management and employees serve or may serve as investment advisers, officers, directors or principals of entities that operate in the same or a related line of business. For example, THL Credit Advisors serves as investment adviser to one or more private funds and registered closed-end funds. In addition, our officers may serve in similar capacities for one or more registered closed-end funds. Accordingly, these individuals may have obligations to investors in those entities or funds, the fulfillment of which might not be in our best interests or the best interests of our stockholders. In addition, certain of the personnel employed by our investment adviser or focused on our business may change in ways that are detrimental to our business. Any affiliated investment vehicle formed in the future and managed by THL Credit Advisors or its affiliates may invest in asset classes similar to those targeted by us. As a result, THL Credit Advisors may face conflicts in allocating investment opportunities between us and such other entities. Although THL Credit Advisors will endeavor to allocate investment opportunities in a fair and equitable manner, it is possible that we may not be

 

44


Table of Contents

given the opportunity to participate in such investments. In certain circumstances, negotiated co-investments may be made only if we receive an order from the SEC permitting us to do so. We, THL Credit Advisors and certain of its affiliates have submitted an exemptive application to the SEC to permit us to co-invest with other funds managed by THL Credit Advisors or its affiliates in a manner consistent with our investment objective, positions, policies, strategies and restrictions as well as regulatory requirements and other pertinent factors. There can be no assurance that any such exemptive order will be obtained at all.

There are potential conflicts of interest between us and the funds managed by us which could impact our investment returns.

THL Credit Greenway Fund LLC, or Greenway LLC, and THL Credit Greenway Fund II LLC, or Greenway II LLC, are portfolio companies and are managed by us. As contemplated in the Greenway II LLC limited liability agreement, we established a related investment vehicle and entered into an investment management agreement with an account set up by an unaffiliated third party investor to invest alongside Greenway II LLC pursuant to similar economic terms. The account is also managed by us. References to “Greenway II” herein include Greenway II LLC and the accounts of related investment vehicles.

Certain of our officers serve or may serve in an investment management capacity to Greenway and Greenway II. As a result, investment professionals may allocate such time and attention as is deemed appropriate and necessary to carry out operations of Greenway and Greenway II. In this respect, they may experience diversions of their attention from us and potential conflicts of interest between their work for us and their work for Greenway and Greenway II in the event that the interests of Greenway and Greenway II run counter to our interests.

Greenway and Greenway II invests in the same or similar asset classes that we target. These investments may be made at the direction of the same individuals acting in their capacity on behalf of us, Greenway and Greenway II. As a result, there may be conflicts in the allocation of investment opportunities between us, Greenway and Greenway II. We may or may not participate in investments made by funds managed by us or one of our affiliates.

We are dependent on information systems and systems failures could significantly disrupt our business, which may, in turn, negatively affect the market price of our common stock and our ability to pay dividends.

Our business is dependent on our and third parties’ communications and information systems. Any failure or interruption of those systems, including as a result of the termination of an agreement with any third-party service providers, could cause delays or other problems in our activities. Our financial, accounting, data processing, backup or other operating systems and facilities may fail to operate properly or become disabled or damaged as a result of a number of factors including events that are wholly or partially beyond our control and adversely affect our business. There could be:

 

   

sudden electrical or telecommunications outages;

 

   

natural disasters such as earthquakes, tornadoes and hurricanes;

 

   

disease pandemics;

 

   

events arising from local or larger scale political or social matters, including terrorist acts; and

 

   

cyber-attacks.

These events, in turn, could have a material adverse effect on our operating results and negatively affect the market price of our common stock and our ability to pay dividends to our stockholders.

 

45


Table of Contents

The failure in cyber security systems, as well as the occurrence of events unanticipated in our disaster recovery systems and management continuity planning could impair our ability to conduct business effectively.

The occurrence of a disaster such as a cyber attack, a natural catastrophe, an industrial accident, a terrorist attack or war, events unanticipated in our disaster recovery systems, or a support failure from external providers, could have an adverse effect on our ability to conduct business and on our results of operations and financial condition, particularly if those events affect our computer-based data processing, transmission, storage, and retrieval systems or destroy data. If a significant number of our managers were unavailable in the event of a disaster, our ability to effectively conduct our business could be severely compromised.

We depend heavily upon computer systems to perform necessary business functions. Despite our implementation of a variety of security measures, our computer systems could be subject to cyber attacks and unauthorized access, such as physical and electronic break-ins or unauthorized tampering. Like other companies, we may experience threats to our data and systems, including malware and computer virus attacks, unauthorized access, system failures and disruptions. If one or more of these events occurs, it could potentially jeopardize the confidential, proprietary and other information processed and stored in, and transmitted through, our computer systems and networks, or otherwise cause interruptions or malfunctions in our operations, which could result in damage to our reputation, financial losses, litigation, increased costs, regulatory penalties and/or customer dissatisfaction or loss.

Our base management fee may induce our investment adviser to incur leverage.

Our base management fee is calculated on the basis of our total assets, including assets acquired with the proceeds of leverage. This may encourage the Advisor to use leverage to increase the aggregate amount of and the return on our investments, even when it may not be appropriate to do so, and to refrain from delivering when it would otherwise be appropriate to do so. Under certain circumstances, the use of increased leverage may increase the likelihood of default, which would impair the value of our common stock. Given the subjective nature of the investment decisions made by our investment adviser on our behalf, we will not be able to monitor this conflict of interest.

Our incentive fee may induce our investment adviser to make certain investments, including speculative investments.

The incentive fee payable by us to THL Credit Advisors may create an incentive for THL Credit Advisors to make investments on our behalf that are risky or more speculative than would be the case in the absence of such compensation arrangement. The way in which the incentive fee payable to THL Credit Advisors is determined, which is calculated separately in two components as a percentage of the interest and other ordinary income in excess of a quarterly minimum hurdle rate and as a percentage of the realized gain on invested capital, may encourage our THL Credit Advisors to use leverage or take additional risk to increase the return on our investments. Under certain circumstances, the use of leverage may increase the likelihood of default, which would disfavor the holders of our common stock, or of securities convertible into our common stock or warrants representing rights to purchase our common stock or securities convertible into our common stock. In addition, THL Credit Advisors receives the incentive fee based, in part, upon net capital gains realized on our investments. Unlike the portion of the incentive fee based on ordinary income, there is no minimum level of gain applicable to the portion of the incentive fee based on net capital gains. As a result, THL Credit Advisors may have an incentive to invest more in investments that are likely to result in capital gains as compared to income producing securities or to advance or delay realizing a gain in order to enhance its incentive fee. This practice could result in our investing in more speculative securities than would otherwise be the case, which could result in higher investment losses, particularly during economic downturns. A rise in the general level of interest rates can be expected to lead to higher interest rates applicable to certain of our debt investments and may accordingly result in a substantial increase of the amount of incentive fees payable to our investment adviser with respect to our pre-incentive fee net investment income.

 

46


Table of Contents

We may invest, to the extent permitted by law, in the securities and instruments of other investment companies, including private funds, and, to the extent we so invest, we will bear our ratable share of any such investment company’s expenses, including management and performance fees. We will also remain obligated to pay management and incentive fees to THL Credit Advisors with respect to the assets invested in the securities and instruments of other investment companies. With respect to each of these investments, each of our common stockholders will bear his or her share of the management and incentive fee of THL Credit Advisors as well as indirectly bear the management and performance fees and other expenses of any investment companies in which we invest.

We may be obligated to pay our investment adviser incentive compensation payments even if we have incurred unrecovered cumulative losses from more than three years prior to such payments and may pay more than 20% of our net capital gains as incentive compensation payments because we cannot recover payments made in previous years.

Our investment adviser will be entitled to incentive compensation for each fiscal quarter in an amount equal to a percentage of the excess of our investment income for that quarter (before deducting incentive compensation) above a threshold return for that quarter and subject to a total return requirement. The general effect of this total return requirement is to prevent payment of the foregoing incentive compensation except to the extent 20.0% of the cumulative net increase in net assets resulting from operations over the then current and 11 preceding calendar quarters exceeds the cumulative incentive fees accrued and/or paid for the 11 preceding calendar quarters. Consequently, we may pay an incentive fee if we incurred losses more than three years prior to the current calendar quarter even if such losses have not yet been recovered in full. Thus, we may be required to pay our investment adviser incentive compensation for a fiscal quarter even if there is a decline in the value of our portfolio or we incur a net loss for that quarter. If we pay an incentive fee of 20.0% of our realized capital gains (net of all realized capital losses and unrealized capital depreciation on a cumulative basis) and thereafter experience additional realized capital losses or unrealized capital depreciation, we will not be able to recover any portion of the incentive fee previously paid.

RISKS RELATED TO OUR INVESTMENTS

We invest primarily in debt and equity securities of middle market companies and we may not realize gains from our equity investments.

We are a direct lender to middle-market companies and invest in first lien and second lien loans, including through unitranche investments, as well as subordinated debt, which may include an associated equity component such as warrants, preferred stock or similar securities. In certain instances, we will also make direct equity investments and may also selectively invest in the residual interests, or equity, of CLOs. Investments in CLOs can be significantly impacted by change in the market value of the assets, the distributions on the assets, defaults and recoveries on the assets, capital gains and losses on the assets along with prices, interest rates and other risks associated with the assets. Our goal is ultimately to dispose of such equity interests and realize gains upon our disposition of such interests. However, the equity interests we receive may not appreciate in value and, in fact, may decline in value. Accordingly, we may not be able to realize gains from our equity interests, and any gains that we do realize on the disposition of any equity interests may not be sufficient to offset any other losses we experience.

Our investments in prospective private and middle market portfolio companies are risky, and we could lose all or part of our investment.

Investment in private and middle market companies involves a number of significant risks. Generally, little public information exists about these companies, and we are required to rely on the ability of THL Credit Advisors’ investment professionals to obtain adequate information to evaluate the potential returns from investing in these companies. If we are unable to uncover all material information about these companies, we may not make a fully informed investment decision, and we may lose money on our investments. Middle market companies may have limited financial resources and may be unable to meet their obligations under their debt

 

47


Table of Contents

securities that we hold, which may be accompanied by a deterioration in the value of any collateral and a reduction in the likelihood of our realizing any guarantees we may have obtained in connection with our investment. In addition, they typically have shorter operating histories, narrower product lines and smaller market shares than larger businesses, which tend to render them more vulnerable to competitors’ actions and market conditions, as well as general economic downturns. Additionally, middle market companies are more likely to depend on the management talents and efforts of a small group of persons; therefore, the death, disability, resignation or termination of one or more of these persons could have a material adverse impact on our portfolio company and, in turn, on us. Middle market companies also generally have less predictable operating results, may from time to time be parties to litigation, may be engaged in rapidly changing businesses with products subject to a substantial risk of obsolescence and may require substantial additional capital to support their operations, finance expansion or maintain their competitive position. In addition, our executive officers, directors and our investment adviser may, in the ordinary course of business, be named as defendants in litigation arising from our investments in the portfolio companies.

Our investments in lower credit quality obligations are risky and highly speculative, and we could lose all or part of our investment.

Most of our debt investments are likely to be in lower grade obligations. The lower grade investments in which we invest may be rated below investment grade by one or more nationally-recognized statistical rating agencies at the time of investment or may be unrated but determined by the Advisor to be of comparable quality. Debt securities rated below investment grade are commonly referred to as “junk bonds” and are considered speculative with respect to the issuer’s capacity to pay interest and repay principal. The debt in which we invest typically is not rated by any rating agency, but we believe that if such investments were rated, they would be below investment grade (rated lower than “Baa3” by Moody’s Investors Service, lower than “BBB-” by Fitch Ratings or lower than “BBB-” by Standard & Poor’s). We may invest without limit in debt of any rating, as well as debt that has not been rated by any nationally recognized statistical rating organization.

Investment in lower grade investments involves a substantial risk of loss. Lower grade securities or comparable unrated securities are considered predominantly speculative with respect to the issuer’s ability to pay interest and principal and are susceptible to default or decline in market value due to adverse economic and business developments. The market values for lower grade debt tend to be very volatile and are less liquid than investment grade securities. For these reasons, your investment in our company is subject to the following specific risks: increased price sensitivity to a deteriorating economic environment; greater risk of loss due to default or declining credit quality; adverse company specific events are more likely to render the issuer unable to make interest and/or principal payments; and if a negative perception of the lower grade debt market develops, the price and liquidity of lower grade securities may be depressed. This negative perception could last for a significant period of time.

We may not be in a position to exercise control over our portfolio companies or to prevent decisions by management of our portfolio companies that could decrease the value of our investments.

We do not generally intend to take controlling equity positions in our portfolio companies. To the extent that we do not hold a controlling equity interest in a portfolio company, we are subject to the risk that such portfolio company may make business decisions with which we disagree, and the stockholders and management of such portfolio company may take risks or otherwise act in ways that are adverse to our interests. Due to the lack of liquidity for the debt and equity investments that we typically hold in our portfolio companies, we may not be able to dispose of our investments in the event we disagree with the actions of a portfolio company, and may therefore suffer a decrease in the value of our investments.

In addition, we may not be in a position to control any portfolio company by investing in its debt securities. As a result, we are subject to the risk that a portfolio company in which we invest may make business decisions with which we disagree and the management of such company, as representatives of the holders of their common equity, may take risks or otherwise act in ways that do not serve our interests as debt investors.

 

48


Table of Contents

Our portfolio companies may be highly leveraged.

Some of our portfolio companies may be highly leveraged, which may have adverse consequences to these companies and to us as an investor. These companies may be subject to restrictive financial and operating covenants and the leverage may impair these companies’ ability to finance their future operations and capital needs. As a result, these companies’ flexibility to respond to changing business and economic conditions and to take advantage of business opportunities may be limited. Further, a leveraged company’s income and net assets will tend to increase or decrease at a greater rate than if borrowed money were not used.

Our portfolio companies may incur debt that ranks equally with, or senior to, our investments in such companies.

The portfolio companies in which we have invested debt capital usually have, or may be permitted to incur with certain limitations, other debt that ranks equally with, or senior to, the debt securities in which we invest. By their terms, such debt instruments may provide that the holders are entitled to receive payment of interest or principal on or before the dates on which we are entitled to receive payments in respect of the debt securities in which we invest. Also, in the event of insolvency, liquidation, dissolution, reorganization or bankruptcy of a portfolio company, holders of debt instruments ranking senior to our investment in that portfolio company would typically be entitled to receive payment in full before we receive any distribution in respect of our investment. After repaying such senior creditors, such portfolio company may not have any remaining assets to use for repaying its obligation to us. In the case of debt ranking equally with debt securities in which we invest, we would have to share any distributions on an equal and ratable basis with other creditors holding such debt in the event of an insolvency, liquidation, dissolution, reorganization or bankruptcy of the relevant portfolio company.

Additionally, certain loans that we make to portfolio companies may be secured on a second priority basis by the same collateral securing senior secured debt of such companies. The first priority liens on the collateral will secure the portfolio company’s obligations under any outstanding senior debt and may secure certain other future debt that may be permitted to be incurred by the portfolio company under the agreements governing the loans. The holders of obligations secured by the first priority liens on the collateral will generally control the liquidation of and be entitled to receive proceeds from any realization of the collateral to repay their obligations in full before us. In addition, the value of the collateral in the event of liquidation will depend on market and economic conditions, the availability of buyers and other factors. There can be no assurance that the proceeds, if any, from the sale or sales of all of the collateral would be sufficient to satisfy the loan obligations secured by the second priority liens after payment in full of all obligations secured by the first priority liens on the collateral. If such proceeds are not sufficient to repay amounts outstanding under the loan obligations secured by the second priority liens, then we, to the extent not repaid from the proceeds of the sale of the collateral, will only have an unsecured claim against the portfolio company’s remaining assets, if any.

The rights we may have with respect to the collateral securing the mezzanine, or subordinated, loans and second lien loans we make to our portfolio companies with senior debt outstanding may also be limited pursuant to the terms of one or more intercreditor agreements that we enter into with the holders of senior debt. Under such an intercreditor agreement, at any time that obligations that have the benefit of the first priority liens are outstanding, any of the following actions that may be taken in respect of the collateral will be at the direction of the holders of the obligations secured by the first priority liens: the ability to cause the commencement of enforcement proceedings against the collateral; the ability to control the conduct of such proceedings; the approval of amendments to collateral documents; releases of liens on the collateral; and waivers of past defaults under collateral documents. We may not have the ability to control or direct such actions, even if our rights are adversely affected.

If the assets securing the loans that we make decrease in value, then we may lack sufficient collateral to cover losses.

We will at times take a security interest in the available assets of these portfolio companies, including the equity interests of their subsidiaries and, in some cases, the equity interests of our portfolio companies held by

 

49


Table of Contents

their stockholders. There is a risk that the collateral securing these types of loans may decrease in value over time, may be difficult to sell in a timely manner, may be difficult to appraise and may fluctuate in value based upon the success of the business and market conditions, including as a result of the inability of a portfolio company to raise additional capital. In some circumstances, our lien could be subordinated to claims of other creditors. Additionally, deterioration in a portfolio company’s financial condition and prospects, including its inability to raise additional capital, may be accompanied by deterioration in the value of the collateral for these types of loans. Moreover, in the case of most of our investments, we do not have a first lien position on the collateral. Consequently, the fact that a loan may be secured does not guarantee that we will receive principal and interest payments according to the loan’s terms, or that we will be able to collect on the loan should we be forced to enforce our remedies.

Economic downturns or recessions could impair the value of the collateral for our loans to our portfolio companies and consequently increase the possibility of an adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

Many of our portfolio companies are susceptible to economic recessions and may be unable to repay our loans during such periods. Therefore, our non-performing assets are likely to increase and the value of our portfolio is likely to decrease during such periods. Adverse economic conditions may also decrease the value of collateral securing some of our loans and the value of our equity investments.

Economic slowdowns or recessions could lead to financial losses in our portfolio and a decrease in revenues, net income and assets. Unfavorable economic conditions also could increase our funding costs, limit our access to the capital markets or result in a decision by lenders not to extend credit to us.

A portfolio company’s failure to satisfy financial or operating covenants imposed by us or other lenders could lead to defaults and, potentially, termination of the portfolio company’s loans and foreclosure on its secured assets, which could trigger cross-defaults under other agreements and jeopardize the portfolio company’s ability to meet its obligations under the debt securities that we hold. We may incur expenses to the extent necessary to seek recovery upon default or to negotiate new terms with a defaulting portfolio company. In addition, if a portfolio company goes bankrupt, even though we may have structured our investment as mezzanine debt, or senior secured debt, depending on the facts and circumstances, including the extent to which we actually provided significant “managerial assistance,” if any, to that portfolio company, a bankruptcy court might re-characterize our debt holding and subordinate all or a portion of our claim to that of other creditors. These events could harm our financial condition and operating results.

We may suffer a loss if a portfolio company defaults on a loan and the underlying collateral is not sufficient.

In the event of a default by a portfolio company on a secured loan, we will only have recourse to the assets collateralizing the loan. If the underlying collateral value is less than the loan amount, we will suffer a loss. In addition, we often make loans that are unsecured, which are subject to the risk that other lenders may be directly secured by the assets of the portfolio company. In the event of a default, those collateralized lenders would have priority over us with respect to the proceeds of a sale of the underlying assets. In cases described above, we may lack control over the underlying asset collateralizing our loan or the underlying assets of the portfolio company prior to a default, and as a result the value of the collateral may be reduced by acts or omissions by owners or managers of the assets.

In the event of bankruptcy of a portfolio company, we may not have full recourse to its assets in order to satisfy our loan, or our loan may be subject to equitable subordination. In addition, certain of our loans are subordinate to other debt of the portfolio company. If a portfolio company defaults on our loan or on debt senior to our loan, or in the event of a portfolio company bankruptcy, our loan will be satisfied only after the senior debt receives payment. Where debt senior to our loan exists, the presence of intercreditor arrangements may limit our ability to amend our loan documents, assign our loans, accept prepayments, exercise our remedies (through

 

50


Table of Contents

“standstill” periods) and control decisions made in bankruptcy proceedings relating to the portfolio company. Bankruptcy and portfolio company litigation can significantly increase collection losses and the time needed for us to acquire the underlying collateral in the event of a default, during which time the collateral may decline in value, causing us to suffer losses.

If the value of collateral underlying our loan declines or interest rates increase during the term of our loan, a portfolio company may not be able to obtain the necessary funds to repay our loan at maturity through refinancing. Decreasing collateral value and/or increasing interest rates may hinder a portfolio company’s ability to refinance our loan because the underlying collateral cannot satisfy the debt service coverage requirements necessary to obtain new financing. If a borrower is unable to repay our loan at maturity, we could suffer a loss which may adversely impact our financial performance.

Our loans could be subject to equitable subordination by a court which would increase our risk of loss with respect to such loans.

Courts may apply the doctrine of equitable subordination to subordinate the claim or lien of a lender against a borrower to claims or liens of other creditors of the borrower, when the lender or its affiliates is found to have engaged in unfair, inequitable or fraudulent conduct. The courts have also applied the doctrine of equitable subordination when a lender or its affiliates is found to have exerted inappropriate control over a client, including control resulting from the ownership of equity interests in a client. We have made direct equity investments or received warrants in connection with loans representing approximately 5.6% of the aggregate amortized cost basis of our portfolio as of December 31, 2014. Payments on one or more of our loans, particularly a loan to a client in which we also hold an equity interest, may be subject to claims of equitable subordination. If we were deemed to have the ability to control or otherwise exercise influence over the business and affairs of one or more of our portfolio companies resulting in economic hardship to other creditors of that company, this control or influence may constitute grounds for equitable subordination and a court may treat one or more of our loans as if it were unsecured or common equity in the portfolio company. In that case, if the portfolio company were to liquidate, we would be entitled to repayment of our loan on a pro-rata basis with other unsecured debt or, if the effect of subordination was to place us at the level of common equity, then on an equal basis with other holders of the portfolio company’s common equity only after all of its obligations relating to its debt and preferred securities had been satisfied.

Our failure to make follow-on investments in our portfolio companies could impair the value of our portfolio.

Following an initial investment in a portfolio company, we may make additional investments in that portfolio company as “follow-on” investments in order to: (1) increase or maintain in whole or in part our equity ownership percentage; (2) exercise warrants, options or convertible securities that were acquired in the original or subsequent financing; or (3) attempt to preserve or enhance the value of our initial investment. We have the discretion to make any follow-on investments, subject to the availability of capital resources. We may elect not to make follow-on investments or otherwise lack sufficient funds to make those investments. Our failure to make follow-on investments may, in some circumstances, jeopardize the continued viability of a portfolio company and our initial investment, or may result in a missed opportunity for us to increase our participation in a successful operation. Even if we have sufficient capital to make a desired follow-on investment, we may elect not to make such follow-on investment because we may not want to increase our concentration of risk, because we prefer other opportunities, because we are inhibited by compliance with BDC requirements or because we desire to maintain our tax status. In addition, our ability to make follow-on investments may also be limited by THL Credit Advisors’ allocation policy.

Our ability to invest in public companies may be limited in certain circumstances.

To maintain our status as a BDC, we are not permitted to acquire any assets other than “qualifying assets” specified in the 1940 Act unless, at the time the acquisition is made, at least 70% of our total assets are qualifying assets (with certain limited exceptions). Subject to certain exceptions for follow-on investments and distressed

 

51


Table of Contents

companies, an investment in an issuer that has outstanding securities listed on a national securities exchange may be treated as a qualifying asset only if such issuer has a market capitalization that is less than $250 million at the time of such investment and meets the other specified requirements.

Our investments in foreign securities may involve significant risks in addition to the risks inherent in U.S. investments.

Our investment strategy contemplates that a portion of our investments may be in securities of foreign companies in order to provide diversification or to complement our U.S. investments although we are required generally to invest at least 70% of our assets in companies organized and having their principal place of business within the U.S. and its possessions. Investing in foreign companies may expose us to additional risks not typically associated with investing in U.S. companies. These risks include changes in exchange control regulations, political and social instability, expropriation, imposition of foreign taxes, less liquid markets and less available information than is generally the case in the United States, higher transaction costs, less government supervision of exchanges, brokers and issuers, less developed bankruptcy laws, difficulty in enforcing contractual obligations, lack of uniform accounting and auditing standards and greater price volatility. These risks many be more pronounced for portfolio companies located or operating primarily in emerging markets, whose economies, markets and legal systems may be less developed.

Although it is anticipated that most of our investments will be denominated in U.S. dollars, our investments that are denominated in a foreign currency will be subject to the risk that the value of a particular currency may change in relation to the U.S. dollar. Among the factors that may affect currency values are trade balances, the level of short-term interest rates, differences in relative values of similar assets in different currencies, long-term opportunities for investment and capital appreciation and political developments. We may employ hedging techniques to minimize these risks, but we can offer no assurance that we will, in fact, hedge currency risk or, that if we do, such strategies will be effective. As a result, a change in currency exchange rates may adversely affect our profitability.

Hedging transactions may expose us to additional risks.

While we may enter into transactions to seek to reduce currency exchange rate and interest rate risks, unanticipated changes in currency exchange rates or interest rates may result in poorer overall investment performance than if we had not engaged in any such hedging transactions. In addition, the degree of correlation between price movements of the instruments used in a hedging strategy and price movements in the portfolio positions being hedged may vary. Moreover, for a variety of reasons, we may not seek or be able to establish a perfect correlation between such hedging instruments and the portfolio holdings being hedged. Any such imperfect correlation may prevent us from achieving the intended hedge and expose us to risk of loss. In addition, it may not be possible to hedge fully or perfectly against currency fluctuations affecting the value of securities denominated in non-U.S. currencies because the value of those securities is likely to fluctuate as a result of factors not related to currency fluctuations. On May 10, 2012, we entered into a five-year interest rate swap agreement, or swap agreement, with ING Capital Markets, LLC. Under the swap agreement, with a notional value of $50.0 million, we pay a fixed rate of 1.1425% and receive a floating rate based upon the current three-month LIBOR rate. We entered into the swap agreement to manage interest rate risk and not for speculative purposes.

We may incur greater risk with respect to investments we acquire through assignments or participations of interests.

Although we originate a substantial portion of our loans, we may acquire loans through assignments or participations of interests in such loans. The purchaser of an assignment typically succeeds to all the rights and obligations of the assigning institution and becomes a lender under the credit agreement with respect to such debt obligation. However, the purchaser’s rights can be more restricted than those of the assigning institution, and we may not be able to unilaterally enforce all rights and remedies under an assigned debt obligation and with regard

 

52


Table of Contents

to any associated collateral. A participation typically results in a contractual relationship only with the institution participating out the interest and not directly with the borrower. Sellers of participations typically include banks, broker-dealers, other financial institutions and lending institutions. In purchasing participations, we generally will have no right to enforce compliance by the borrower with the terms of the loan agreement against the borrower, and we may not directly benefit from the collateral supporting the debt obligation in which we have purchased the participation. As a result, we will be exposed to the credit risk of both the borrower and the institution selling the participation. In addition, to the extent that the lead institution fails and any borrower collateral is used to reduce the balance of a participated loan, we will be regarded as a creditor of the lead institution and will not benefit from the exercise of any set-off rights by the lead institution or its receiver. Further, in purchasing participations in lending syndicates, we will not be able to conduct the same level of due diligence on a borrower or the quality of the loan with respect to which we are buying a participation as we would conduct if we were investing directly in the loan. This difference may result in us being exposed to greater credit or fraud risk with respect to such loans than we expected when initially purchasing the participation.

Cyclicality within the energy sector may adversely affect some of our portfolio companies.

Industries within the energy sector are cyclical with fluctuations in commodity prices and demand for, and production of commodities driven by a variety of factors. The highly cyclical nature of the industries within the energy sector may lead to volatile changes in commodity prices, which may adversely affect the earnings of energy companies in which we may invest and the performance and valuation of our portfolio.

Changes in healthcare laws and other regulations applicable to some of our portfolio companies’ businesses may constrain their ability to offer their products and services.

Changes in healthcare or other laws and regulations applicable to the businesses of some of our portfolio companies may occur that could increase their compliance and other costs of doing business, require significant systems enhancements, or render their products or services less profitable or obsolete, any of which could have a material adverse effect on their results of operations. There has also been an increased political and regulatory focus on healthcare laws in recent years, and new legislation could have a material effect on the business and operations of some of our portfolio companies.

RISKS IN THE CURRENT ENVIRONMENT

Capital markets may experience periods of disruption and instability and we cannot predict when these conditions will occur. Such market conditions could materially and adversely affect debt and equity capital markets in the United States and abroad, which could have a negative impact on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

The global capital markets have experienced a period of disruption as evidenced by a lack of liquidity in the debt capital markets, write-offs in the financial services sector, the re-pricing of credit risk and the failure of certain major financial institutions. While the capital markets improved during 2013, these conditions could deteriorate in the future. During such market disruptions, we may have difficulty raising debt or equity capital, especially as a result of regulatory constraints.

Market conditions may in the future make it difficult to extend the maturity of or refinance our existing indebtedness and any failure to do so could have a material adverse effect on our business. The illiquidity of our investments may make it difficult for us to sell such investments if required. As a result, we may realize significantly less than the value at which we have recorded our investments. In addition, significant changes in the capital markets, including the disruption and volatility, have had, and may in the future have, a negative effect on the valuations of our investments and on the potential for liquidity events involving our investments. An inability to raise capital, and any required sale of our investments for liquidity purposes, could have a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

53


Table of Contents

Various social and political tensions in the United States and around the world, particularly in the Middle East, Eastern Europe and Russia may continue to contribute to increased market volatility, may have long-term effects on the United States and worldwide financial markets, and may cause further economic uncertainties or deterioration in the United States and worldwide. Several European Union (“EU”) countries, including Greece, Ireland, Italy, Spain, and Portugal, continue to face budget issues, some of which may have negative long-term effects for the economies of those countries and other EU countries. There is also continued concern about national-level support for the euro and the accompanying coordination of fiscal and wage policy among European Economic and Monetary Union member countries. The recent United States and global economic downturn, or a return to the recessionary period in the United States, could adversely impact our investments. We cannot predict the duration of the effects related to these or similar events in the future on the United States economy and securities markets or on our investments. We monitor developments and seek to manage our investments in a manner consistent with achieving our investment objective, but there can be no assurance that we will be successful in doing so.

RISKS RELATED TO OUR OPERATIONS AS A BDC

Our ability to enter into transactions with our affiliates will be restricted.

Because we have elected to be treated as a BDC under the 1940 Act, we are prohibited under the 1940 Act from participating in certain transactions with certain of our affiliates without the prior approval of our independent directors and, in some cases, of the SEC. Any person that owns, directly or indirectly, 5% or more of our outstanding voting securities will be our affiliate for purposes of the 1940 Act and we are generally prohibited from buying or selling any security from or to such affiliate, absent the prior approval of our independent directors. The 1940 Act also prohibits certain “joint” transactions with certain of our affiliates, which could include investments in the same portfolio company (whether at the same or different times), without prior approval of our independent directors and, in some cases, of the SEC. We, THL Credit Advisors and certain of its affiliates have submitted an exemptive application to the SEC to permit us to co-invest with other funds managed by THL Credit Advisors or its affiliates in a manner consistent with our investment objective, positions, policies, strategies and restrictions as well as regulatory requirements and other pertinent factors. There can be no assurance that any such exemptive order will be obtained. We are prohibited from buying or selling any security from or to any person who owns more than 25% of our voting securities or certain of that person’s affiliates, or entering into prohibited joint transactions with such persons, absent the prior approval of the SEC. Similar restrictions limit our ability to transact business with our officers or directors or their affiliates.

Regulations governing our operation as a BDC may limit our ability to, and the way in which we raise additional capital, which could have a material adverse impact on our liquidity, financial condition and results of operations.

Our business may in the future require a substantial amount of capital. We may acquire additional capital from the issuance of senior securities (including debt and preferred stock) or the issuance of additional shares of our common stock. However, we may not be able to raise additional capital in the future on favorable terms or at all. Additionally, we may only issue senior securities up to the maximum amount permitted by the 1940 Act. The 1940 Act permits us to issue senior securities only in amounts such that our asset coverage, as defined in the 1940 Act, equals at least 200% after such issuance or incurrence. If our assets decline in value and we fail to satisfy this test, we may be required to liquidate a portion of our investments and repay a portion of our indebtedness at a time when such sales or repayment may be disadvantageous, which could have a material adverse impact on our liquidity, financial condition and results of operations.

 

   

Senior Securities (including debt and preferred stock). As a result of issuing senior securities, we would also be exposed to typical risks associated with leverage, including an increased risk of loss. If we issue preferred securities, such securities would rank “senior” to common stock in our capital structure, resulting in preferred stockholders having separate voting rights, dividend and liquidation rights, and possibly other rights, preferences or privileges more favorable than those granted to holders of our common stock. Furthermore, the issuance of preferred securities could have the effect of

 

54


Table of Contents
 

delaying, deferring or preventing a transaction or a change of control that might involve a premium price for our common stockholders or otherwise be in your best interest.

 

   

Additional Common Stock. Our board of directors may decide to issue common stock to finance our operations rather than issuing debt or other senior securities. As a BDC, we are generally not able to issue our common stock at a price below net asset value without first obtaining required approvals from our stockholders and our independent directors. At our Annual Meeting of Stockholders on June 3, 2014, our stockholders approved a proposal authorizing us to sell up to 25% of our common stock at a price below the Company’s net asset value per share, subject to approval by our board of directors of the offering. Except in connection with the exercise of warrants or the conversion of convertible securities, in any such case the price at which our securities are to be issued and sold may not be less than a price, that in the determination of our board of directors, closely approximates the market value of such securities at the relevant time. We may also make subscription rights offerings or warrants representing rights to purchase shares of our securities to our stockholders at prices per share less than the net asset value per share, subject to the requirements of the 1940 Act. If we raise additional funds by issuing more common stock or senior securities convertible into, or exchangeable for, our common stock, the percentage ownership of our stockholders at that time would decrease, and such stockholders may experience dilution.

Additionally, if we do raise additional capital in one or more subsequent financings, until we are able to invest the net proceeds of such any financing in suitable investments, we will invest in temporary investments, such as cash, cash equivalents, U.S. government securities and other high-quality debt investments that mature in one year or less, which we expect will earn yields lower than the interest, dividend or other income that we anticipate receiving in respect of investments in debt and equity securities of our target portfolio companies. As a result, our ability to pay dividends in the years of operation during which we have such net proceeds available to invest will be based on our ability to invest our capital in suitable portfolio companies in a timely manner. Further, the management fee payable to our investment adviser, THL Credit Advisors, will not be reduced while our assets are invested in such temporary investments.

Changes in the laws or regulations governing our business, or changes in the interpretations thereof, and any failure by us to comply with these laws or regulations, could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations or financial condition.

Changes in the laws or regulations or the interpretations of the laws and regulations that govern BDCs, RICs or non-depository commercial lenders could significantly affect our operations and our cost of doing business. We are subject to federal, state and local laws and regulations and are subject to judicial and administrative decisions that affect our operations, including our loan originations, maximum interest rates, fees and other charges, disclosures to portfolio companies, the terms of secured transactions, collection and foreclosure procedures and other trade practices. If these laws, regulations or decisions change, or if we expand our business into jurisdictions that have adopted more stringent requirements than those in which we currently conduct business, we may have to incur significant expenses in order to comply, or we might have to restrict our operations. In addition, if we do not comply with applicable laws, regulations and decisions, we may lose licenses needed for the conduct of our business and may be subject to civil fines and criminal penalties.

Legislation may allow us to incur additional leverage.

As a business development company, under the 1940 Act, generally we are not permitted to incur indebtedness unless immediately after such borrowing we have an asset coverage for total borrowings of at least 200% (i.e., the amount of debt may not exceed 50% of the value of our assets). We also have agreed in the covenant in the Indenture not to violate this section of the 1940 Act, whether or not we continue to be subject to such provision, but giving effect, in either case, to any exemptive relief granted to us by the SEC. Legislation introduced in the U.S. House of Representatives during the 113th Congress intended to modify this section of the 1940 Act and increase the amount of debt that business development companies may incur. If the legislation is

 

55


Table of Contents

reintroduced and passed, we would be able to incur additional indebtedness in the future and, therefore, your risk associated with an investment in the Notes would increase.

If we do not invest a sufficient portion of our assets in qualifying assets, we could fail to qualify as a BDC or be precluded from investing according to our current business strategy, which would have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

As a BDC, we may not acquire any assets other than “qualifying assets” unless, at the time of and after giving effect to such acquisition, at least 70% of our total assets are qualifying assets. See “Regulation.” We believe that most of the investments that we may acquire in the future will constitute qualifying assets. However, we may be precluded from investing in what we believe are attractive investments if such investments are not qualifying assets for purposes of the 1940 Act. If we do not invest a sufficient portion of our assets in qualifying assets, we could be found to be in violation of the 1940 Act provisions applicable to BDCs and possibly lose our status as a BDC, which would have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. Similarly, these rules could prevent us from making follow-on investments in existing portfolio companies (which could result in the dilution of our position) or could require us to dispose of investments at inopportune times in order to come into compliance with the 1940 Act. If we need to dispose of such investments quickly, it may be difficult to dispose of such investments on favorable terms. For example, we may have difficulty in finding a buyer and, even if we do find a buyer, we may have to sell the investments at a substantial loss.

There is a risk that we may not make distributions and consequently will become subject to corporate-level income tax.

We cannot assure you that we will achieve investment results that will allow us to make a specified level of cash distributions or periodically increase our dividend rate.

As a BDC, we are required to carry our investments at market value or, if no market value is ascertainable, at fair value as determined in good faith by or under the direction of our board of directors. Decreases in the market values or fair values of our investments will be recorded as unrealized depreciation. Any unrealized depreciation in our investment portfolio could be an indication of a portfolio company’s potential inability to meet its repayment obligations to us. This could result in realized losses in the future and ultimately in reductions of our income available for distribution in future periods.

If we are unable to qualify for tax treatment as a RIC, we will be subject to corporate-level income tax, which would have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition.

We intend to continue to qualify as a RIC under the Code. As a RIC we do not have to pay federal income taxes on our income (including realized gains) that is distributed to our stockholders, provided that we satisfy certain distribution and other requirements. Accordingly, we are not permitted under accounting rules to establish reserves for taxes on our unrealized capital gains. If we fail to qualify for RIC status in any year, to the extent that we had unrealized gains, we would have to establish reserves for taxes, which would reduce our net asset value and the amount potentially available for distribution. In addition, if we, as a RIC, were to decide to make a deemed distribution of net realized capital gains and retain the net realized capital gains, we would have to establish appropriate reserves for taxes that we would have to pay on behalf of stockholders. It is possible that establishing reserves for taxes could have a material adverse effect on the value of our common stock.

To maintain our qualification as a RIC under the Code, which is required in order for us to distribute our income without being taxed at the corporate level, we must maintain our status as a BDC and meet certain source-of-income, asset diversification and annual distribution requirements and including:

 

   

The annual distribution requirement for a RIC is satisfied if we distribute to our stockholders at least 90% of our ordinary income and realized net short-term capital gains in excess of realized net long-term capital losses, if any, on an annual basis. Because we may use debt financing, we are subject to an

 

56


Table of Contents
 

asset coverage ratio requirement under the 1940 Act and we may be subject to certain financial covenants under our debt arrangements that could, under certain circumstances, restrict us from making

  distributions necessary to satisfy the distribution requirement. If we are unable to obtain cash from other sources, we could fail to qualify for RIC tax treatment and, thus, become subject to corporate-level income tax.

 

   

The income source requirement will be satisfied if we obtain at least 90% of our income for each year from dividends, interest, gains from the sale of stock or securities or similar sources.

 

   

The asset diversification requirement will be satisfied if we meet certain asset diversification requirements at the end of each quarter of our taxable year. To satisfy these requirements, at least 50% of the value of our assets must consist of cash, cash equivalents, U.S. government securities, securities of other RICs, and other acceptable securities; and no more than 25% of the value of our assets can be invested in the securities, other than U.S. government securities or securities of other RICs, of one issuer, of two or more issuers that are controlled, as determined under applicable Internal Revenue Code rules, by us and that are engaged in the same or similar or related trades or businesses or of certain “qualified publicly traded partnerships.” Failure to meet these requirements may result in our having to dispose of certain investments quickly in order to prevent the loss of RIC status. Because most of our investments will be in private companies, and, therefore, will be relatively illiquid, any such dispositions could be made at disadvantageous prices and could result in substantial losses.

Satisfying these requirements may require us to take actions we would not otherwise take, such as selling investments at unattractive prices to satisfy diversification, distribution or source of income requirements. In addition, while we are authorized to borrow funds in order to make distributions, under the 1940 Act we are not permitted to make distributions to stockholders while we have debt obligations or other senior securities outstanding unless certain “asset coverage” tests are met. If we fail to qualify as a RIC for any reason and become or remain subject to corporate-level income tax, the resulting corporate taxes could substantially reduce our net assets, the amount of income available for distribution and the amount of our distributions. Such a failure would have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial conditions, and thus, our stockholders.

RISKS RELATED TO AN INVESTMENT IN OUR SECURITIES

Our common stock price may be volatile and may fluctuate substantially.

As with any stock, the price of our common stock will fluctuate with market conditions and other factors. Our common stock is intended for long-term investors and should not be treated as a trading vehicle. Shares of closed-end management investment companies, which are structured similarly to us, frequently trade at a discount from their net asset value. Our shares may trade at a price that is less than the offering price. This risk may be greater for investors who sell their shares in a relatively short period of time after completion of the offering.

The market price and liquidity of the market for our common shares may be significantly affected by numerous factors, some of which are beyond our control and may not be directly related to our operating performance. These factors include:

 

   

significant volatility in the market price and trading volume of securities of BDCs or other companies in the sector in which we operate, which are not necessarily related to the operating performance of these companies;

 

   

changes in regulatory policies or tax guidelines, particularly with respect to RICs or BDCs;

 

   

loss of RIC status;

 

   

changes in earnings or variations in operating results;

 

   

changes in the value of our portfolio of investments;

 

57


Table of Contents
   

any shortfall in revenue or net income or any increase in losses from levels expected by investors or securities analysts;

 

   

departure of key personnel from our investment adviser;

 

   

operating performance of companies comparable to us;

 

   

general economic trends and other external factors; and

 

   

loss of a major funding source.

Certain provisions of the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware and our certificate of incorporation could deter takeover attempts and have an adverse effect on the price of our common stock.

The General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware and our certificate of incorporation contain provisions that may discourage, delay or make more difficult a change in control of us or the removal of our directors. Among other provisions, our directors may be removed for cause only by the affirmative vote of 75% of the holders of our outstanding capital stock. Our board of directors also is authorized to issue preferred stock in one or more series. In addition, our certificate of incorporation requires the favorable vote of a majority of our board of directors followed by the favorable vote of the holders of at least 75% of our outstanding shares of common stock, to approve, adopt or authorize certain transactions, including mergers and the sale, lease or exchange of all or any substantial part of our assets with 10% or greater holders of our outstanding common stock and their affiliates or associates, unless the transaction has been approved by at least 80% of our board of directors, in which case approval by “a majority of the outstanding voting securities” (as defined in the 1940 Act) will be required. These measures may delay, defer or prevent a transaction or a change in control that might otherwise be in the best interests of our stockholders and could have the effect of depriving stockholders of an opportunity to sell their shares at a premium over prevailing market prices. See “Description of Our Capital Stock—Anti-takeover provisions.”

Our common stock may trade below its net asset value per share, which limits our ability to raise additional equity capital.

If our common stock is trading below its net asset value per share, we will generally not be able to issue additional shares of our common stock at its market price without first obtaining the approval for such issuance from our stockholders and our independent directors. Shares of BDCs, including shares of our common stock, have traded at discounts to their net asset values. As of December 31, 2014, our net asset value per share was $13.08. The last reported sale price of a share of our common stock on the NASDAQ Global Select Market on March 9, 2015 was $12.22. At our Annual Meeting of Stockholders on June 3, 2014, our stockholders approved a proposal authorizing us to sell up to 25% of our common stock at a price below our then-current net asset value per share, subject to approval by our board of directors for the offering. The authorization expires on June 3, 2015. Our stockholders also approved a proposal to authorize us to offer and issue debt with warrants or debt convertible into shares of our common stock at an exercise or conversion price that, at the time such warrants or convertible debt are issued, will not be less than the market value per share but may be below our then-current net asset value per share. If our common stock trades below net asset value, the higher the cost of equity capital may result in it being unattractive to raise new equity, which may limit our ability to grow. The risk of trading below net asset value is separate and distinct from the risk that our net asset value per share may decline. We cannot predict whether shares of our common stock will trade above, at or below our net asset value.

Our Notes are unsecured and therefore are effectively subordinated to any secured indebtedness we have currently incurred or may incur in the future.

The Notes are not secured by any of our assets or any of the assets of our subsidiaries. As a result, the Notes are effectively subordinated to any secured indebtedness we or our subsidiaries have currently incurred and may incur in the future (or any indebtedness that is initially unsecured to which we subsequently grant security) to the extent of the value of the assets securing such indebtedness. In any liquidation, dissolution, bankruptcy or other

 

58


Table of Contents

similar proceeding, the holders of any of our existing or future secured indebtedness and the secured indebtedness of our subsidiaries may assert rights against the assets pledged to secure that indebtedness in order to receive full payment of their indebtedness before the assets may be used to pay other creditors, including the holders of the Notes. As of December 31, 2014, we had $188.4 million outstanding under the Revolving Facility and $106.5 million outstanding under the Term Loan Facility. The indebtedness under the Revolving Facility and the Term Loan Facility is effectively senior to the Notes to the extent of the value of the assets securing such indebtedness.

The net asset value per share of our common stock may be diluted if we sell shares of our common stock in one or more offerings at prices below the then current net asset value per share of our common stock or securities to subscribe for or convertible into shares of our common stock.

At our Annual Meeting of Stockholders on June 3, 2014, our stockholders approved a proposal authorizing us to sell up to 25% of our common stock at a price below the Company’s net asset value per share, subject to approval by our board of directors of the offering. Although any such sale must be approved by our board of directors, there is no limit on the amount of dilution that may occur as a result of such sale. If we were to issue shares at a price below net asset value, such sales would result in an immediate dilution to existing common stockholders, which would include a reduction in the net asset value per share as a result of the issuance. This dilution would also include a proportionately greater decrease in a stockholder’s interest in our earnings and assets and voting interest in us than the increase in our assets resulting from such issuance.

In addition, at our 2014 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, our stockholders authorized us to offer and issue debt with warrants or debt convertible into shares of our common stock at an exercise or conversion price that, at the time such warrants or convertible debt are issued, will not be less than the market value per share but may be below our then current net asset value.

Any decision to sell shares of our common stock below its then current net asset value per share or securities to subscribe for or convert into shares of our common stock would be subject to the determination by our board of directors that such issuance is in our and our stockholders’ best interests.

If we were to sell shares of our common stock below its then current net asset value per share, such sales would result in an immediate dilution to the net asset value per share of our common stock. This dilution would occur as a result of the sale of shares at a price below the then current net asset value per share of our common stock and a proportionately greater decrease in the stockholders’ interest in our earnings and assets and their voting interest in us than the increase in our assets resulting from such issuance. Because the number of shares of common stock that could be so issued and the timing of any issuance is not currently known, the actual dilutive effect cannot be predicted.

In addition, if we issue warrants or securities to subscribe for or convert into shares of our common stock, subject to certain limitations, the exercise or conversion price per share could be less than net asset value per share at the time of exercise or conversion (including through the operation of anti-dilution protections). Because we would incur expenses in connection with any issuance of such securities, such issuance could result in a dilution of the net asset value per share at the time of exercise or conversion. This dilution would include reduction in net asset value per share as a result of the proportionately greater decrease in the stockholders’ interest in our earnings and assets and their voting interest than the increase in our assets resulting from such issuance.

We incur significant costs as a result of being a publicly traded company.

As a publicly traded company, we incur legal, accounting and other expenses, including costs associated with the periodic reporting requirements applicable to a company whose securities are registered under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or the Exchange Act, as well as additional corporate governance requirements, including requirements under the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, and other rules implemented by the SEC.

 

59


Table of Contents

The trading market or market value of our publicly issued debt securities may fluctuate.

Our publicly issued debt securities may or may not have an established trading market. We cannot assure you that a trading market for our publicly issued debt securities will ever develop or be maintained if developed. In addition to our creditworthiness, many factors may materially adversely affect the trading market for, and market value of, our publicly issued debt securities. These factors include, but are not limited to, the following:

 

   

the time remaining to the maturity of these debt securities;

 

   

the outstanding principal amount of debt securities with terms identical to these debt securities;

 

   

the ratings assigned by national statistical ratings agencies;

 

   

the general economic environment;

   

the supply of debt securities trading in the secondary market, if any;

 

   

the redemption or repayment features, if any, of these debt securities;

 

   

the level, direction and volatility of market interest rates generally; and

 

   

market rates of interest higher or lower than rates borne by the debt securities.

You should also be aware that there may be a limited number of buyers when you decide to sell your debt securities. This too may materially adversely affect the market value of the debt securities or the trading market for the debt securities.

Terms relating to redemption may materially adversely affect your return on any debt securities that we may issue.

If your debt securities are redeemable at our option, we may choose to redeem your debt securities at times when prevailing interest rates are lower than the interest rate paid on your debt securities. In addition, if your debt securities are subject to mandatory redemption, we may be required to redeem your debt securities also at times when prevailing interest rates are lower than the interest rate paid on your debt securities. In this circumstance, you may not be able to reinvest the redemption proceeds in a comparable security at an effective interest rate as high as your debt securities being redeemed.

 

Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments

None.

 

Item 2. Properties

We do not own any real estate or other physical properties materially important to our operation. Our headquarters are currently located at 100 Federal Street, 31st Floor, Boston, MA 02110. THL Credit Advisors furnishes us office space and we reimburse it for such costs on an allocated basis.

 

Item 3. Legal proceedings

As of December 31, 2014, we are not a defendant in any material pending legal proceeding, and no such material proceedings are known to be contemplated. However, from time to time, we may be party to certain legal proceedings incidental to the normal course of our business including the enforcement of our rights under the contracts with our portfolio companies. Third parties may also seek to impose liability on us in connection with the activities of our portfolio companies.

 

Item 4. Mine Safety Disclosures

Not applicable.

 

60


Table of Contents

PART II

 

Item 5. Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

Price Range of Common Stock

Our common stock is traded on the NASDAQ Global Select Market under the ticker symbol “TCRD.” The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, the range of high and low sales prices for our common stock, as reported on The NASDAQ Global Select Market:

 

     High      Low  

Fiscal year ended December 31, 2014

     

First quarter

   $ 16.61       $ 13.78   

Second quarter

   $ 14.27       $ 12.80   

Third quarter

   $ 14.30       $ 12.90   

Fourth quarter

   $ 13.42       $ 11.22   

Fiscal year ended December 31, 2013

     

First quarter

   $ 16.08       $ 14.49   

Second quarter

   $ 15.77       $ 14.00   

Third quarter

   $ 16.17       $ 14.75   

Fourth quarter

   $ 17.00       $ 15.27   

The last reported price for our common stock on March 9, 2015 was $12.22 per share. As of March 9, 2015, we had 2 stockholders of record, which did not include stockholders for whom shares are held in nominee or “street” name.

Stock Performance Graph

This graph compares the return on our common stock with that of the Standard & Poor’s 500 Stock Index and the Russell 2000 Financial Services Index, for the period from April 21, 2010 (initial public offering) through December 31, 2014. The graph assumes that, on April 21, 2010, a person invested $100 in each of our common stock, the S&P 500 Index, and the Russell 2000 Financial Services Index. The graph measures total stockholder return, which takes into account both changes in stock price and dividends. It assumes that dividends paid are invested in like securities.

 

LOGO

 

61


Table of Contents

The graph and other information furnished under this Part II Item 5 of this Form 10-K shall not be deemed to be “soliciting material” or to be “filed” with the SEC or subject to Regulation 14A or 14C, or to the liabilities of Section 18 of the 1934 Act. The stock price performance included in the above graph is not necessarily indicative of future stock price performance.

Sales of unregistered securities

We issued a total of 0 shares, 0 shares and 2 shares shares of common stock under our dividend reinvestment plan during the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The issuance was not subject to the registration requirements of the Securities Act of 1933. The aggregate price for the shares of common stock issued under the dividend reinvestment plan was $0, $0, $0 for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

Issuer purchases of equity securities

None.

Dividends

We have elected to be taxed as a regulated investment company under Subchapter M of the Code. In order to maintain our status as a regulated investment company, we are required to distribute at least 90% of our investment company taxable income. To avoid a 4% excise tax on undistributed earnings, we are required to distribute each calendar year the sum of (i) 98% of our ordinary income for such calendar year (ii) 98.2% of our net capital gains for the one-year period ending October 31 of that calendar year (iii) any income recognized, but not distributed, in preceding years and on which we paid no federal income tax. We intend to make distributions to stockholders on a quarterly basis of substantially all of our net investment income. Although we intend to make distributions of net realized capital gains, if any, at least annually, out of assets legally available for such distributions, we may in the future decide to retain such capital gains for investment. In addition, the extent and timing of special dividends, if any, will be determined by our board of directors and will largely be driven by portfolio specific events and tax considerations at the time.

In addition, we may be limited in our ability to make distributions due to the BDC asset coverage test for borrowings applicable to us as a BDC under the 1940 Act.

 

62


Table of Contents

The following table summarizes our dividends declared and paid or to be paid on all shares, including dividends reinvested, if any:

 

Date Declared

 

Record Date

 

Payment Date

 

Amount Per Share

August 5, 2010

  September 2, 2010   September 30, 2010   $0.05

November 4, 2010

  November 30, 2010   December 28, 2010   $0.10

December 14, 2010

  December 31, 2010   January 28, 2011   $0.15

March 10, 2011

  March 25, 2011   March 31, 2011   $0.23

May 5, 2011

  June 15, 2011   June 30, 2011   $0.25

July 28, 2011

  September 15, 2011   September 30, 2011   $0.26

October 27, 2011

  December 15, 2011   December 30, 2011   $0.28

March 6, 2012

  March 20, 2012   March 30, 2012   $0.29

March 6, 2012

  March 20, 2012   March 30, 2012   $0.05

May 2, 2012

  June 15, 2012   June 29, 2012   $0.30

July 26, 2012

  September 14, 2012   September 28, 2012   $0.32

November 2, 2012

  December 14, 2012   December 28, 2012   $0.33

December 20, 2012

  December 31, 2012   January 28, 2013   $0.05

February 27, 2013

  March 15, 2013   March 29, 2013   $0.33

May 2, 2013

  June 14, 2013   June 28, 2013   $0.34

August 2, 2013

  September 16, 2013   September 30, 2013   $0.34

August 2, 2013

  September 16, 2013   September 30, 2013   $0.08

October 30, 2013

  December 16, 2013   December 31, 2013   $0.34

March 4, 2014

  March 17, 2014   March 31, 2014   $0.34

May 7, 2014

  June 16, 2014   June 30, 2014   $0.34

August 7, 2014

  September 15, 2014   September 30, 2014   $0.34

November 4, 2014

  December 15, 2014   December 31, 2014   $0.34

March 6, 2015

  March 20, 2015   March 31, 2015   $0.34

We may not be able to achieve operating results that will allow us to make distributions at a specific level or to increase the amount of these distributions from time to time. If we do not distribute a certain percentage of our income annually, we will suffer adverse tax consequences, including possible loss of our status as a regulated investment company. We cannot assure stockholders that they will receive any distributions at a particular level. We maintain an “opt in” dividend reinvestment plan for our common stockholders. As a result, unless stockholders specifically elect to have their dividends automatically reinvested in additional shares of common stock, stockholders will receive all such dividends in cash. Under the terms of our dividend reinvestment plan, dividends will primarily be paid in newly issued shares of common stock. However, we reserve the right to purchase shares in the open market in connection with the implementation of the plan. This feature of the plan means that, under certain circumstances, we may issue shares of our common stock at a price below net asset value per share, which could cause our stockholders to experience dilution.

Distributions in excess of our current and accumulated profits and earnings would be treated first as a return of capital to the extent of the stockholder’s tax basis, and any remaining distributions would be treated as a capital gain. The determination of the tax attributes of our distributions will be made annually as of the end of our fiscal year based upon our taxable income for the full year and distributions paid for the full year. Therefore, a determination made on a quarterly basis may not be representative of the actual tax attributes of our distributions for a full year. Each year, a statement on Form 1099-DIV identifying the source of the distribution will be sent to our U.S. stockholders of record. Our board of directors presently intends to declare and pay quarterly dividends. Our ability to pay dividends could be affected by future business performance, liquidity, capital needs, alternative investment opportunities and loan covenants.

The tax character of distributions declared and paid in 2014 represented $44.2 million from ordinary income, $1.9 million from capital gains and $0 from tax return of capital. The tax character of distributions

 

63


Table of Contents

declared and paid in 2013 represented $43.0 million from ordinary income, $0.3 million from capital gains and $0 from tax return of capital. Generally accepted accounting principles require adjustments to certain components of net assets to reflect permanent differences between financial and tax reporting. These adjustments have no affect on net asset value per share. Permanent differences between financial and tax reporting at December 31, 2014 and 2013 were $1.3 million and $0.2 million, respectively.

 

64


Table of Contents
Item 6. Selected Financial Data

The following selected financial data should be read together with our consolidated financial statements and the related notes and the discussion under “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” which is included elsewhere in this annual report on Form 10-K. Financial information is presented for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, 2012, 2011 and 2010 in thousands, except for per share data. The Consolidated Statement of Operations, Per share, and the Consolidated Statement of Assets and Liabilities data for the years ending 2014, 2013, 2012, 2011 and 2010 has been derived from our consolidated financial statements that were audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, our independent registered public accounting firm. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” below for more information.

 

    For the years ended     At and for the period from
May 26, 2009  (inception)
through December 31, 2009
 
    2014     2013     2012     2011     2010    

Consolidated Statement of Operations data:

           

Total investment income

  $ 91,928      $ 74,650      $ 53,125      $ 37,409      $ 12,325      $ —     

Incentive fees

    11,184        10,682        7,017        4,790        —          —     

Base management fees

    11,142        7,521        4,943        4,012        2,697        —     

All other expenses

    20,372        14,547        10,392        7,550        3,598        172   

Income tax provision and excise tax

    1,040        511        581        22        —          —     

Net investment income (loss)

    48,190        41,389        30,192        21,035        6,030        (172

Interest rate derivative periodic interest payments, net

    (458     (433     (180     —          —          —     

Net realized (loss) gain on investments

    (12,855     2,604        353        979        —          —     

Provision for taxes on realized gain on investments

    (249     —          —          —          —          —     

Net change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation) on investments

    2,243        309        (1,241     2,121        1,760        —     

Net change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation) on interest rate derivative

    71        769        (1,053     —          —          —     

Provision for taxes on unrealized gain on investments

    (151     (1,960     (454     —          —          —     

Net increase in net assets resulting from operations

    36,791        42,678        27,617        24,135        7,790        (172

Per share data:

           

Net asset value per common share at year end

  $ 13.08      $ 13.36      $ 13.20      $ 13.24      $ 13.06      $ (10.61

Market price at year end

    11.76        16.49        14.79        12.21        13.01        n/a   

Net investment income

    1.42        1.37        1.38        1.04        0.31        (25.61

Net realized (loss) gain on investments

    (0.38     0.09        0.01        0.05        —          —     

Provision for taxes on realized gain on investments

    (0.01     —          —          —          —          —     

Net change in unrealized appreciation on investments

    0.06        0.01        (0.06     0.11        0.08        —     

Net change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation) on interest rate derivative

    —          0.01        (0.06     —          —          —     

 

65


Table of Contents
    For the years ended     At and for the period from
May 26, 2009  (inception)
through December 31, 2009
 
    2014     2013     2012     2011     2010    

Provision for taxes on unrealized gain on investments

    —          (0.07     (0.02     —          —          —     

Interest rate derivative periodic interest payments, net

    (0.01     (0.01     —          —          —          —     

Net increase in net assets resulting from operations

    1.08        1.41        1.26        1.20        0.39        (25.61

Dividends declared

    1.36        1.43        1.34        1.02        0.30        —     

Consolidated Statement of Assets and Liabilities data at period end:

           

Total investments at fair value

  $ 784,220      $ 648,867      $ 394,349      $ 266,993      $ 153,529      $ —     

Cash and cash equivalents

    2,656        7,829        4,819        5,573        110,141        101   

Other assets

    25,609        16,195        7,090        4,583        719        370   

Total assets

    812,485        672,891        406,258        277,149        264,389        471   

Loans payable

    294,851        204,300        50,000        5,000        —          —     

Notes payable

    50,000        —          —          —          —          —     

Other liabilities

    24,013        15,649        8,774        4,532        4,373        541   

Total liabilities

    368,864        219,949        58,774        9,532        4,373        541   

Total net assets

    443,621        452,942        347,484        267,617        260,016        (70

Other data:

           

Weighted average annual yield on debt investments

    11.1     11.4     13.7     13.8     15.8     —     

Weighted average annual yield on debt and income-producing equity securities

    11.1     11.5     13.9     14.0     16.6     —     

Number of portfolio investments at year end

    60        54        34        24        13        —     

 

Quarter Ended

  Investment
Income
    Net Investment
Income
    Net Change in
Unrealized
Appreciation
(Depreciation)
on Investments
    Net Realized Gain
(Loss) on
Investments, net of
taxes
    Net Realized/
Unrealized
Gain

(Loss) on
Interest Rate
Derivative
    (Provision)
benefit for taxes
on unrealized
gain on
investments
    Net Increase
In Net
Assets From
Operations
 
    Total     Per
Share
    Total     Per
Share
    Total     Per
Share
    Total     Per
Share
    Total     Per
Share
    Total     Per
Share
    Total      Per
Share
 

December 31, 2014

  $ 24,143      $ 0.71      $ 12,380      $ 0.37      $ 5,198      $ 0.15      $ (11,804   ($ 0.36   $ (213   ($ 0.01   $ (844   ($ 0.02   $ 4,717       $ 0.13   

September 30, 2014

    23,145        0.68        12,223        0.36        505        0.01        (777     (0.02     151        0.01        (292     (0.01     11,810         0.35   

June 30, 2014

    23,745        0.70        12,887        0.38        (2,851     (0.08     (501     (0.02     (266     (0.01     14        —          9,283         0.28   

March 31, 2014

    20,895        0.62        10,700        0.32        (609     (0.03     (22     —          (59     —          971        0.03        10,981         0.32   

Quarter Ended

  Investment
Income
    Net Investment
Income
    Net Change in
Unrealized
Appreciation
(Depreciation)
on Investments
    Net Realized Gain
(Loss) on
Investments, net of
taxes
    Net Realized/
Unrealized Gain
(Loss) on
Interest Rate
Derivative
    (Provision)
benefit for taxes
on unrealized
gain on
investments
    Net Increase
In Net
Assets From
Operations
 
    Total     Per
Share
    Total     Per
Share
    Total     Per
Share
    Total     Per
Share
    Total     Per
Share
    Total     Per
Share
    Total      Per
Share
 

December 31, 2013

  $ 18,491      $ 0.55      $ 9,109      $ 0.27      $ 2,431      $ 0.07      $ 212      $ 0.01      $ (83   $ 0.00      $ (977   ($ 0.03   $ 10,692       $ 0.32   

September 30, 2013

    19,064        0.56        11,602        0.34        (3,141     (0.10     707        0.02        (361     (0.01     (1,050     (0.03     7,757         0.23   

June 30, 2013

    22,672        0.84        13,273        0.49        (681     (0.02     1,685        0.06        742        0.03        596        0.02        15,615         0.58   

March 31, 2013

    14,423        0.55        7,405        0.28        1,700        0.06        —          0.00        38        —          (529     (0.02     8,614         0.33   

 

66


Table of Contents
Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

The information contained in this section should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and notes thereto appearing elsewhere in this report.

CAUTIONARY STATEMENT REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This report, and other statements that we may make, may contain forward-looking statements with respect to future financial or business performance, strategies or expectations. Forward-looking statements are typically identified by words or phrases such as “trend,” “opportunity,” “pipeline,” “believe,” “comfortable,” “expect,” “anticipate,” “current,” “intention,” “estimate,” “position,” “assume,” “potential,” “outlook,” “continue,” “remain,” “maintain,” “sustain,” “seek,” “achieve” and similar expressions, or future or conditional verbs such as “will,” “would,” “should,” “could,” “may” or similar expressions.

Forward-looking statements are subject to numerous assumptions, risks and uncertainties, which change over time. Forward-looking statements speak only as of the date they are made, and we assume no duty to and do not undertake to update forward-looking statements. Actual results could differ materially from those anticipated in forward-looking statements and future results could differ materially from historical performance.

In addition to factors previously identified elsewhere in this filing, the following factors, among others, could cause actual results to differ materially from forward-looking statements or historical performance:

 

   

the introduction, withdrawal, success and timing of business initiatives and strategies;

 

   

changes in political, economic or industry conditions, the interest rate environment or financial and capital markets, which could result in changes in the value of our assets;

 

   

the relative and absolute investment performance and operations of our investment adviser;

 

   

the impact of increased competition;

 

   

the impact of future acquisitions and divestitures;

 

   

the unfavorable resolution of legal proceedings;

 

   

our business prospects and the prospects of our portfolio companies;

 

   

the impact, extent and timing of technological changes and the adequacy of intellectual property protection;

 

   

the impact of legislative and regulatory actions and reforms and regulatory, supervisory or enforcement actions of government agencies relating to us or THL Credit Advisors LLC, the Advisor;

 

   

the ability of the Advisor to identify suitable investments for us and to monitor and administer our investments;

 

   

our contractual arrangements and relationships with third parties;

 

   

any future financings by us;

 

   

the ability of the Advisor to attract and retain highly talented professionals;

 

   

fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates; and

 

   

the impact of changes to tax legislation and, generally, our tax position.

Overview

THL Credit, Inc., or the Company, was organized as a Delaware corporation on May 26, 2009 and initially funded on July 23, 2009. We commenced principal operations on April 21, 2010. Our investment objective is to generate both current income and capital appreciation, primarily through investments in privately negotiated investments in debt and equity securities of middle market companies.

 

67


Table of Contents

As of December 31, 2014, we, together with our credit-focused affiliates, collectively had $4,833 million of assets under management. This amount included $812 million of our assets, $221 million of assets of the managed funds and separate account managed by us, and $3,800 million of assets of the collateralized loan obligations (CLOs), separate accounts and various fund formats managed by the investment professionals of THL Credit Senior Loan Strategies LLC, the consolidated subsidiary of the Advisor.

We are a direct lender to middle market companies and invest in first lien and second lien secured loans, including through unitranche investments, as well as subordinated debt, which may include an associated equity component such as warrants, preferred stock or other similar securities. In certain instances, we will also make direct equity investments and may also selectively invest in the residual interests, or equity, of collateralized loan obligations. We may also provide advisory services to managed funds.

We are an externally managed, non-diversified, closed-end investment company that has elected to be regulated as a business development company, or BDC, under the Investment Company Act of 1940 Act, as amended, or the 1940 Act. As a BDC, we are required to comply with certain regulatory requirements. For instance, we generally have to invest at least 70% of our total assets in “qualifying assets,” including securities of private or thinly traded public U.S . companies, cash, cash equivalents, U.S. Government securities and high-quality debt investments that mature in one year or less.

As a BDC, we must not acquire any assets other than “qualifying assets” specified in the 1940 Act unless, at the time the acquisition is made, at least 70% of our total assets are qualifying assets (with certain limited exceptions). Qualifying assets include investments in “eligible portfolio companies.” Under the relevant U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission, or SEC, rules the term “eligible portfolio company” includes all private companies, companies whose securities are not listed on a national securities exchange, and certain public companies that have listed their securities on a national securities exchange and have a market capitalization of less than $250 million, in each case organized in the United States.

We are also registered as an investment adviser under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, as amended, or the Advisers Act.

Since April 2010, after we completed our initial public offering and commenced principal operations, we have been responsible for making, on behalf of ourselves, managed funds and separately managed account, over approximately an aggregate of $1,542 million in commitments into 79 separate portfolio companies through a combination of both initial and follow-on investments. Since April 2010, we, along with our managed funds and separately managed account, have received $783.8 million from paydowns related to these investments. The Company alone has received $544.8 million from paydowns and sales of investments.

We have elected to be treated for tax purposes as a regulated investment company, or RIC, under Subchapter M of the Code. To qualify as a RIC, we must, among other things, meet certain source of income and asset diversification requirements. Pursuant to these elections, we generally will not have to pay corporate-level income taxes on any income we distribute to our stockholders.

Portfolio Composition and Investment Activity

Portfolio Composition

As of December 31, 2014, we had $784.2 million of portfolio investments (at fair value), which represents a $135.3 million, or 20.9% increase from the $648.9 million (at fair value) as of December 31, 2013. We also increased our portfolio to 60 investments, including THL Credit Greenway Fund LLC, or Greenway, and THL Credit Greenway Fund II LLC, or Greenway II, as of December 31, 2014, from 54 portfolio investments, including Greenway and Greenway II, as of December 31, 2013.

At December 31, 2014, our average portfolio company investment, exclusive of Greenway, Greenway II and portfolio investments where we only have an equity investment, at amortized cost and fair value was

 

68


Table of Contents

approximately $14.3 million and $14.3 million, respectively and our largest portfolio company investment by both amortized cost and fair value was approximately $39.9 million and $39.7 million, respectively. At December 31, 2013, our average portfolio company investment at both amortized cost and fair value was approximately $14.0 million and $13.9 million, respectively, and our largest portfolio company investment by both amortized cost and fair value was approximately $26.6 million.

At December 31, 2014, based upon fair value, 72.2% of our debt investments bore interest based on floating rates (subject to interest rate floors), such as LIBOR, and 27.8% bore interest at fixed rates. At December 31, 2013, 59.1% of our debt investments bore interest based on floating rates (subject to interest rate floors), such as LIBOR, and 40.9% bore interest at fixed rates.

The following table shows the weighted average yield by investment category at their current cost.

 

     As of  

Description:

   December 31, 2014     December 31, 2013  

First lien secured debt(1)

     11.3     11.0

Second lien debt(1)

     11.0     11.3

Subordinated debt(2)

     13.4     12.1

Investments in funds(3)

     —          12.6

Investments in payment rights(4)

     16.8     17.0

CLO residual interests(4)

     13.4     14.0

Income-producing equity securities

     10.6     —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Debt and income-producing investments(5)

     11.7     11.7

Debt investments

     11.6     11.4

 

(1) 

OEM Group, Inc. transferred from a second lien debt investment to a first lien secured debt investment in 2014 as the nature of the investment changed during the year.

(2) 

Includes the impact of all loans on non-accrual status.

(3)

As of December 31, 2013, investment in funds includes only our investment in LCP Capital Fund LLC, which is the only investment in funds where we receive regular payments.

(4)

Yields from investments in payment rights and CLO residual interests represents an effective yield expected from anticipated cash flows.

(5) 

Excludes yield on the Logan JV as the fund commenced operations on December 3, 2014.

As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, portfolio investments, in which we have debt investments, had an average EBITDA of approximately $27 million and $30 million, respectively, based on the latest available financial information provided by the portfolio companies for each of these periods. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, our weighted average attachment point in the capital structure of our portfolio companies is approximately 4.1 times and 4.2 times EBITDA, respectively, for each of these based on our latest available financial information for each of these periods.

As of December 31, 2014, excluding nominal investments made in Greenway and Greenway II, 81.0% of our portfolio investments are in sponsored investments and 19.0% of our portfolio investments are in unsponsored investments. Our portfolio investments as of December 31, 2014 have used our capital for change of control transactions (25.9%), acquisitions/growth capital (25.9%), refinancings (13.8%), recapitalizations (17.2%) and other (17.2%). As December 31, 2014, we have closed portfolio investments with 46 different sponsors since inception.

As of December 31, 2013, excluding nominal investments made in Greenway and Greenway II, 78.8% of our portfolio investments are in sponsored investments and 21.2% of our portfolio investments are in unsponsored investments. Our portfolio investments as of December 31, 2013 have used our capital for change of

 

69


Table of Contents

control transactions (34.6%), acquisitions/growth capital (13.5%), refinancings (13.5%), recapitalizations (21.2%) and other (17.3%). As December 31, 2014, we have closed portfolio investments with 34 different sponsors since inception.

Consistent with our sourcing strategy, approximately 89% and 77% of the Company’s new investments for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 were directly originated from our relationships with private equity firms, financial advisors, banks and other lending partners, respectively.

The following table summarizes the amortized cost and fair value of investments as of December 31, 2014 (in millions).

 

Description

   Amortized
Cost
     Percentage of
Total
    Fair  Value(1)      Percentage of
Total
 

First lien secured debt

   $ 396.6         50.9   $ 393.8         50.3

Second lien debt

     168.9         21.7     168.5         21.5

Subordinated debt

     103.9         13.3     100.7         12.8

Equity investments

     43.5         5.6     52.7         6.7

CLO residual interests

     34.2         4.4     34.9         4.5

Investment in Logan JV

     16.8         2.2     16.7         2.1

Investment in payment rights

     11.9         1.5     13.5         1.7

Investments in funds

     3.2         0.4     3.4         0.4
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total investments

   $ 779.0         100.0   $ 784.2         100.0
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

All investments are categorized as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy.

The following table summarizes the amortized cost and fair value of investments as of December 31, 2013 (in millions).

 

Description

   Amortized Cost      Percentage of
Total
    Fair  Value(1)      Percentage of
Total
 

First lien secured debt

   $ 261.7         40.5   $ 263.1         40.6

Subordinated debt

     162.6         25.2     156.0         24.0

Second lien debt

     157.2         24.3     157.9         24.3

CLO residual interests

     37.3         5.8     37.6         5.8

Investment in payment rights

     12.2         1.9     13.8         2.1

Investments in funds

     9.4         1.4     9.5         1.5

Equity investments

     5.5         0.9     11.0         1.7
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total investments

   $ 645.9         100.0   $ 648.9         100.0
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

All investments are categorized as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy.

 

70


Table of Contents

The following is a summary of the industry classification in which the Company invests as of December 31, 2014 (in millions).

 

Industry

   Amortized Cost      Fair Value      % of Net Assets  

Consumer products

   $ 120.7       $ 120.4         27.15

IT services

     108.7         106.5         24.02

Healthcare

     77.5         83.2         18.75

Financial services

     71.4         68.9         15.55

Manufacturing

     70.8         68.4         15.41

Retail & grocery

     53.0         55.8         12.58

Industrials

     54.6         54.1         12.18

Energy / utilities

     50.3         48.9         11.04

Food & beverage

     38.6         39.3         8.85

Structured products

     34.2         34.9         7.87

Business services

     32.2         32.2         7.27

Media, entertainment and leisure

     25.1         29.7         6.69

Restaurants

     20.8         20.8         4.68

Transportation

     14.3         14.3         3.21

Aerospace & defense

     6.8         6.8         1.53
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Investments

   $ 779.0       $ 784.2         176.78
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following is a summary of the industry classification in which the Company invests as of December 31, 2013 (in millions).

 

Industry

   Amortized
Cost
     Fair Value      % of Net Assets  

IT services

   $ 100.5       $ 101.0         22.31

Industrials

     79.4         79.7         17.61

Financial services

     53.9         53.1         11.72

Food & beverage

     52.8         52.3         11.55

Healthcare

     48.8         50.5         11.14

Retail & grocery

     53.4         50.2         11.07

Business services

     50.9         50.0         11.05

Manufacturing

     48.8         49.0         10.81

Consumer products

     38.1         38.4         8.47

Structured products

     37.3         37.6         8.31

Energy / utilities

     32.4         32.8         7.25

Media, entertainment and leisure

     24.6         29.1         6.42

Restaurants

     20.8         20.8         4.60

Aerospace & defense

     4.2         4.4         0.96
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Investments

   $ 645.9       $ 648.9         143.27
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

As required by the 1940 Act, we classify our investments by level of control. “Control investments” are defined in the 1940 Act as investments in those companies that we are deemed to “control”, which, in general, includes a company in which we own 25% or more of the voting securities of such company or have greater than 50% representation on its board. “Affiliate investments” are investments in those companies that are “affiliated companies” of ours, as defined in the 1940 Act, which are not control investments. We are deemed to be an “affiliate” of a company in which we have invested if we own 5% or more, but less than 25%, of the voting securities of such company. “Non-control/non-affiliate investments” are investments that are neither control investments nor affiliate investments.

 

71


Table of Contents

The following table summarizes our realized gains (losses) and changes in our unrealized appreciation and depreciation on control and affiliate investments for the years ended December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013 (in millions):

 

    Year Ended December 31, 2014  

Type of Investment/Portfolio company(1)

  Fair Value at
December 31,
2014
    Investment
Income(2)
    Change in
Unrealized
Appreciation/
(Depreciation)
    Reversal of
Change in
Unrealized
Appreciation/
(Depreciation)
    Realized
Gains/
(Losses)
 

Control Investments

         

C&K Market, Inc.(3)

         

1,967,367 shares of common stock

  $ 6.0      $ 0.2      $ 3.8      $ —        $ —     

1,967,367 shares of preferred stock

    9.8        —          (1.1     —          —     

Dimont & Associates, Inc.(4)

         

Subordinated term loan 11.0% PIK due 4/16/2018

    4.6        0.1        0.1        —          —     

50,004 shares of common stock

    2.0        —          (4.6     —          —     

Thibaut, Inc

         

Senior secured term loan 12.0% cash due 6/19/19

    6.5        0.4        0.1        —          —     

4,747 shares of series A preferred stock

    4.9        0.1        0.2        —          —     

20,639 shares of common stock

    0.8        —          0.8        —          —     

THL Credit Logan JV LLC(5)

         

80% economic interest

    16.7        —          (0.1     —          —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Control Investments

  $ 51.3      $ 0.8      $ (0.8   $ —        $ —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Affiliate Investments

         

THL Credit Greenway Fund LLC(6)

         

Investment in fund

    —          0.9        —          —          —     

THL Credit Greenway Fund II LLC(6)

         

Investment in fund

    —          2.1        —          —          —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Affiliate Investments

  $ —        $ 3.0      $ —        $ —        $ —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Control and Affiliate Investments

  $ 51.3      $ 3.8      $ (0.8   $ —        $ —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

     Year Ended December 31, 2013  

Type of Investment/Portfolio company(1)

   Fair Value at
December 31,
2013
     Investment
Income(2)
     Change in
Unrealized
Appreciation/
(Depreciation)
     Reversal of
Change in
Unrealized
Appreciation/
(Depreciation)
     Realized
Gains/
(Losses)
 

Affiliate Investments

              

THL Credit Greenway Fund LLC(6)

              

Investment in fund

     —           1.7         —           —           —     

THL Credit Greenway Fund II LLC(6)

              

Investment in fund

     —           1.3         —           —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Affiliate Investments

   $ —         $ 3.0       $ —         $ —         $ —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

The principal amount and ownership detail as shown in the Consolidated Schedule of Investments as of December 31, 2014. Common stock and preferred stock, in some cases, are generally non-income producing.

(2) 

Represents the total amount of interest and fees credited to income for the portion of the year an investment was included in the Control and Affiliate categories

(3) 

C&K Market, Inc., or C&K, filed for bankruptcy in November 2013. On August 12, 2014, the date C&K emerged from bankruptcy, the cost basis of the senior subordinated note, certain interest due and warrants totaling $14.3 million was converted to common and preferred equity.

 

72


Table of Contents
(4) 

On October 20, 2014, THL Credit restructured its investment in Wingspan Portfolio Holdings, Inc., or Wingspan. As part of the restructuring, THL Credit exchanged the cost basis of its subordinated term loan totaling $18.4 million for a controlled equity position of an affiliated entity, Dimont Acquisition Inc., or Dimont. In connection with the restructuring and conversion to equity, we recognized a loss in the amount of $11.9 million and invested $4.6 million in the subordinated term loan of Dimont.

(5) 

Together with Perspecta Trident LLC, or Perspecta, an affiliate of Perspecta Trust LLC, the Company invests in THL Credit Logan JV LLC, of Logan JV. Logan JV is capitalized through equity contributions from its members and investment decisions must be unanimously approved by the Logan JV investment committee consisting of one representative from each of the Company and Perspecta.

(6) 

Income includes certain fees relating to investment management services provided by the Company, including a base management fee, a performance fee and a portion of the closing fees on each investment transaction.

 

73


Table of Contents

Investment Activity

The following is a summary of our investment activity, presented on a cost basis, for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 (in millions).

 

     Years ended December 31,  
         2014             2013      

New portfolio investments

   $ 239.2      $ 373.9   

Existing portfolio investments:

    

Follow-on investments

     88.7        28.6   

Delayed draw and revolver investments

     19.6        3.0   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total existing portfolio investments

     108.3        31.6   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total portfolio investment activity

   $ 347.5      $ 405.5   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Number of new portfolio investments

     17        24   

Number of existing portfolio investments

     13        13   

First lien secured debt

   $ 178.6      $ 203.5   

Second lien debt

     103.4        119.6   

Subordinated debt

     18.0        49.6   

Investments in funds

     2.3        1.1   

Investment in Logan JV

     16.8        —     

Equity investments

     19.9        2.2   

CLO residual interestss

     8.5        29.5   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total portfolio investments

   $ 347.5      $ 405.5   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average yield of new debt investments

     11.1     11.4

Weighted average yield, including all new income-producing investments

     11.1     11.5

The decrease in weighted average yield of new investments is related primarily to an increase in first and second lien investments. As of December 31, 2014, the first and second lien debt securities, based on fair value, have increased 33.6% since December 31, 2013.

For the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, we received proceeds from prepayments and sales of our investments, including any prepayment premiums, totaling $204.7 million and $170.2 million, respectively.

The following are proceeds received from notable prepayments and sales of our investments (in millions):

For the year ended December 31, 2014

 

   

Sale of a second lien debt investment in Blue Coat Systems, Inc., resulting in proceeds of $15.3 million and included a realized gain of $0.6 million;

 

   

Repayment of a first lien secured debt investment in Cydcor LLC at par, resulting in proceeds of $13.2 million;

 

   

Sale of a first lien secured debt investment in Hostway Corporation, resulting in proceeds of $9.9 million and included a nominal realized gain;

 

   

Repayment of an investment in LCP Capital Fund LLC, resulting in proceeds of $8.4 million;

 

   

Repayment of a first lien secured debt investment in NCM Group Holdings, LLC, resulting in proceeds of $28.1 million, which included a prepayment premium of $1.3 million;

 

   

Repayment of a subordinated debt investment in SeaStar Solutions, resulting in proceeds of $16.8 million, which included a prepayment premium of $0.3 million;

 

74


Table of Contents
   

Partial sale of $4.9 million, which included a nominal realized gain, and a $10.0 million repayment, which included a prepayment premium of $0.2 million, of a second lien debt investment in Surgery Center Holdings, Inc;

 

   

Repayment of a second lien debt investment in Tectum Holdings Inc. at par, resulting in proceeds of $12.0 million;

 

   

Repayment of a subordinated debt investment in Trinity Services Group Inc., resulting in proceeds of $23.5 million, which included a prepayment premium of $0.5 million;

 

   

Repayment of a second lien debt investment in TriMark USA, LLC, resulting in proceeds of $20.2 million, which included a prepayment premium of $0.2 million;

 

   

Repayment of a subordinated term loan in Express Courier International, Inc. at par, resulting in proceeds of $7.8 million;

 

   

Partial sale of a second lien debt investment in Expert Global Solutions, Inc., which resulted in proceeds of $5.1 million and included a realized loss of $0.3 million;

 

   

Sale of a CLO residual interest in Octagon Income Note XIV, Ltd, which resulted in proceeds of $7.7 million and included a realized gain of $0.2 million;

 

   

Partial sale of a second lien debt investment in BBB US Industries Holdings, Inc., which resulted in proceeds of $9.5 million and included a realized gain of $0.1 million.

For the year ended December 31, 2013

 

   

Repayment of a first lien secured debt investment in Firebirds International, LLC, resulting in proceeds of $8.3 million, which included a $0.1 million prepayment premium;

 

   

Repayment of a second lien debt investment in YP Intermediate Holdings Corp. at par, resulting in proceeds of $3.4 million;

 

   

Repayment of a second lien debt investment in AIM Media Texas Operating, LLC resulting in proceeds of $10.2 million, which included a $0.3 million prepayment premium;

 

   

Sale of a participation in second lien debt investment in Allen Edmonds Corporation, resulting in proceeds of $9.8 million;

 

   

Sale of debt investments in Gold, Inc., Embarcadero Technologies, Inc., Holland Intermediate Acquisition Corp., Ingenio Acquisition LLC, Connecture, Inc., Tri Starr Management Services, Inc. and Wingspan Portfolio Holdings, Inc. to Greenway II, at fair value, resulting in proceeds of $19.5 million;

 

   

Sale of a subordinated debt investment in Gold, Inc., resulting in proceeds of $14.2 million

 

   

Sale of a subordinated debt investment in Wingspan Portfolio Holdings, Inc., resulting in proceeds of $4.9 million;

 

   

Sale of a first lien secured debt investment in Holland Intermediate Acquisition Corp., resulting in proceeds of $4.9 million;

 

   

Repayment of an initial first lien secured debt investment in Cydcor LLC at par, resulting in proceeds of $14.3 million, which were subsequently reinvested in a $14.3 million first lien secured debt investment;

 

   

Repayment of a subordinated debt investment in Food Processing Holdings, LLC at par, resulting in proceeds of $14.2 million, which were subsequently reinvested in $21.8 million first lien secured debt investment;

 

   

Repayment of a subordinated debt investment in IMDS Corporation at par, resulting in $12.7 million in proceeds and $1.8 million in escrowed funds. Escrowed funds were ultimately not collected and we recognized a realized loss for the year ended December 31, 2014;

 

75


Table of Contents
   

Sale of a second lien term loan in Oasis Legal Finance Holdings Company LLC, resulting in proceeds of $9.8 million;

 

   

Repayment of a second lien debt investment in Pinnacle Operating Corporation, resulting in proceeds of $10.3 million, which included a $0.3 million prepayment premium; and

 

   

Repayment of a subordinated debt investment in Surgery Center Holdings, Inc., resulting in proceeds of $19.3 million, which included a $0.6 million prepayment premium. Proceeds of $14.6 million were subsequently reinvested in a second lien debt investment.

Our level of investment activity can vary substantially from period to period depending on many factors, including the amount of debt and equity capital available to middle market companies, the level of merger and acquisition activity, the general economic environment and the competitive environment for the types of investments we make. The frequency of volume of any prepayments may fluctuate significantly from period to period. The level of prepayment and sales activity increased between the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 as the result of portfolio company refinancings, reflecting the tightening interest rate environment.

Investment Risk

The value of our investments will generally fluctuate with, among other things, changes in prevailing interest rates, federal tax rates, counterparty risk, general economic conditions, the condition of certain financial markets, developments or trends in any particular industry and the financial condition of the issuer. During periods of limited liquidity and higher price volatility, our ability to dispose of investments at a price and time that we deem advantageous may be impaired.

Lower-quality debt securities involve greater risk of default or price changes due to changes in the credit quality of the issuer. The value of lower-quality debt securities often fluctuates in response to company, political, or economic developments and can decline significantly over short periods of time or during periods of general or regional economic difficulty. Lower-quality debt securities can be thinly traded or have restrictions on resale, making them difficult to sell at an acceptable price. The default rate for lower-quality debt securities is likely to be higher during economic recessions or periods of high interest rates.

THL Credit Logan JV LLC

On December 3, 2014, we entered into an agreement with Perspecta Trident LLC, an affiliate of Perspecta Trust LLC, or Perspecta, to create THL Credit Logan JV LLC, or Logan JV, a joint venture, which will invest primarily in senior secured first lien term loans. All Logan JV investment decisions must be unanimously approved by the Logan JV investment committee consisting of one representative from each of us and Perspecta.

Logan JV is capitalized with equity contributions which are generally called from its members as transactions are completed. As of December 31, 2014, Logan JV had equity commitments totaling $150.0 million, of which we committed $120.0 million and Perspecta committed $30.0 million. Equity contributions are called from each member pro-rata, based on their equity commitments. As of December 31, 2014, Logan JV had received $8.0 million in aggregate capital of which we funded $6.4 million. As of December 31, 2014 Logan JV had called but not yet received an additional $13.0 million in aggregate capital of which our pro-rata share is $10.4 million and which is record as a payable for investments purchased in the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities. As of December 31, 2014, remaining equity commitments to Logan JV totaled $129.0 million, of which our share is $103.2 million and Perspecta’s share is $25.8 million, respectively.

We have determined that Logan JV is an investment company under ASC 946 and as such we will not consolidate our non-controlling interest in Logan JV.

On December 17, 2014, Logan JV entered into a senior credit facility, or the Logan JV Credit Facility, with Deutsche Bank AG which allows Logan JV to borrow up to $50.0 million subject to leverage and borrowing base

 

76


Table of Contents

restrictions. The Logan JV Credit Facility can be increased to $200.0 million subject to certain conditions. The revolving loan period ends on December 17, 2016 and the final maturity date is December 17, 2019. As of December 31, 2014, Logan JV had no outstanding debt under the credit facility. The Logan JV Credit Facility bears interest at three month LIBOR (with no LIBOR floor) plus 2.50%.

As of December 31, 2014, Logan JV had total investments at fair value of $30.7 million. As of December 31, 2014, Logan JV’s portfolio was comprised of senior secured first lien loans and a second lien loan to 22 different borrowers. As of December 31, 2014, none of these loans was on non-accrual status. Additionally, as of December 31, 2014, Logan JV had commitments to fund a delayed draw loan to one portfolio company totaling $0.2 million. The portfolio companies in Logan JV are in industries similar to those in which we may invest directly.

Below is a summary of Logan JV’s portfolio, followed by a listing of the individual loans in Logan JV’s portfolio as of December 31, 2014:

 

     As of December 31,
2014
 
     (Dollars in thousands)  

First lien secured debt(1)

   $ 30,237   

Second lien debt(1)

     1,000   
  

 

 

 

Total debt investments

   $ 31,237   
  

 

 

 

Weighted average yield on senior secured loans(2)

     6.70

Weighted average yield on second lien loans(2)

     10.0

Number of borrowers in Logan JV

     22   

Largest loan to a single borrower(1)

   $ 2,500   

Total of five largest loans to borrowers(1)

   $ 8,994   

 

(1) 

At current principal amount.

(2) 

Weighted average yield at their current cost.

 

77


Table of Contents

Logan JV Loan Portfolio as of December 31, 2014

(dollar amounts in thousands)

 

Portfolio Company

  Industry   Interest Rate(1)   Initial
Acquisition
Date
    Maturity
Date
    Principal     Amortized
Cost
    Fair  Value(2)  

Senior Secured First Lien Term

Loans

             

Albertson’s Holdings LLC

  Retail   5.5% (LIBOR
+4.5%)
    12/05/14        08/25/2021      $ 2,000      $ 2,004      $ 2,003   

American Pacific Corporation

  Chemicals, Plastics
& Rubber
  7% (LIBOR
+6%)
    12/10/14        02/27/2019        997        997        996   

AP NMT Acquisition B.V.

  Media: Broadcasting
& Subscription
  6.75% (LIBOR
+5.75%)
    12/18/14        08/13/2021        1,496        1,474        1,474   

Avaya Inc.

  Telecommunications   6.5% (LIBOR
+5.5%)
    12/18/14        03/31/2018        1,496        1,481        1,476   

BioScrip, Inc.

  Healthcare &
Pharmaceuticals
  6.5% (LIBOR
+5.25%)
    12/22/14        07/31/2020        1,500        1,504        1,496   

Birch Communications, Inc.

  Telecommunications   7.75% (LIBOR
+6.75%)
    12/05/14        07/17/2020        972        950        957   

Cengage Learning Acquisitions, Inc.

  Media: Advertising,
Printing & Publishing
  7% (LIBOR
+6%)
    12/15/14        03/31/2020        2,494        2,470        2,473   

Compuware Corp

  Services: Business   6.25% (LIBOR
+5.25%)
    12/11/14        12/15/2021        1,500        1,426        1,427   

CWGS Group, LLC

  Automotive   5.75% (LIBOR
+4.75%)
    12/22/14        02/20/2020        1,490        1,494        1,494   

Delta 2 Lux Sarl

  Telecommunications   4.75% (LIBOR
+3.75%)
    12/18/14        07/30/2021        1,500        1,466        1,468   

FR Utility Services LLC

  Construction &
Building
  6.75% (LIBOR
+5.75%)
    12/18/14        10/18/2019        1,496        1,493        1,491   

GTCR Valor Companies, Inc.

  Services: Business   6% (LIBOR
+5%)
    12/05/14        05/30/2021        995        975        972   

IMG LLC/William Morris
Endeavor Entertainment, LLC

  Media: Diversified &
Production
  5.25% (LIBOR
+4.25%)
    12/31/14        05/06/2021        1,496        1,463        1,451   

Mood Media Corporation

  Media: Broadcasting
& Subscription
  7% (LIBOR
+6%)
    12/05/14        05/01/2019        997        983        979   

Novitex Acquisition, LLC

  Consumer goods:
Non-Durable
  7.5% (LIBOR
+6.25%)
    12/05/14        07/07/2020        998        980        958   

Parq Holdings L.P.(3)

  Hotel, Gaming &
Leisure
  8.5% (LIBOR
+7.5%)
    12/05/14        12/17/2020        —          (3     —     

Parq Holdings L.P.

  Hotel, Gaming &
Leisure
  8.5% (LIBOR
+7.5%)
    12/05/14        12/17/2020        830        814        818   

Radio One, Inc.

  Media: Broadcasting
& Subscription
  7.5% (LIBOR
+6%)
    12/22/14        03/31/2016        1,496        1,492        1,491   

RentPath, Inc.

  Media: Diversified &
Production
  6.25% (LIBOR
+5.25%)
    12/11/14        12/17/2021        1,500        1,470        1,476   

Sirva Worldwide, Inc.

  Transportation:
Cargo
  7.5% (LIBOR
+6.25%)
    12/18/14        03/27/2019        1,496        1,489        1,492   

TOMS Shoes LLC

  Retail   6.5% (LIBOR
+5.5%)
    12/18/14        10/31/2020        1,500        1,388        1,388   

Varsity Brands

  Consumer goods:
Durable
  6% (LIBOR
+5%)
    12/10/14        12/11/2021        1,000        990        1,001   

Verdesian Life Sciences LLC

  Chemicals, Plastics
& Rubber
  6% (LIBOR
+5%)
    12/09/14        07/01/2020        987        986        982   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Senior Secured First Lien Term Loans

            $ 29,786      $ 29,763   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

Second Lien Term Loans

             

RentPath, Inc.

  Media: Diversified &
Production
  10% (LIBOR
+9%)
    12/11/14        12/17/22      $ 1,000      $ 911      $ 915   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Second Lien Term Loans

            $ 911      $ 915   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 
            $ 30,697      $ 30,678   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

78


Table of Contents

 

(1) 

Variable interest rates indexed to 30-day, 60-day, 90-day or 180-day LIBOR rates, at the borrower’s option. LIBOR rates are subject to interest rate floors.

(2) 

Represents fair value in accordance with ASC Topic 820. The determination of such fair value is not included in our board of director’s valuation process described elsewhere herein.

(3) 

Represents a delayed draw commitment of $0.2 million, which was unfunded as of December 31, 2014.

Below is certain summarized financial information for Logan JV as of December 31, 2014 and for the period from December 3, 2014 (commencement of operations) to December 31, 2014:

Selected Balance Sheet Information

 

     As of December 31,
2014
 
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Investments at fair value (cost of $30,697)

   $ 30,678   

Capital contributions receivable

     13,000   

Cash

     3,898   

Other assets

     898   
  

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 48,474   
  

 

 

 

Payable for investments purchased

   $ 26,732   

Other liabilities

     813   
  

 

 

 

Total liabilities

   $ 27,545   
  

 

 

 

Net assets

   $ 20,929   
  

 

 

 

Total liabilities and net assets

   $ 48,474   
  

 

 

 

Selected Statement of Operations Information

 

     For the period from December 3,
2014 (commencement of
operations) through
December 31, 2014
 
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Total revenues

   $ 27   

Total expenses

     79   

Net change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation) on investments

     (19
  

 

 

 

Net decrease in net assets

   $ (71
  

 

 

 

Managed Funds

The Advisor and its affiliates may also manage other funds in the future that may have investment mandates that are similar, in whole and in part, with ours. For example, the Advisor may serve as investment adviser to one or more private funds or registered closed-end funds, and presently serves as an investment adviser to CLOs, THL Credit Wind River 2013-2 CLO, Ltd., THL Credit Wind River 2014-1 CLO, Ltd., THL Credit Wind River 2014-2 CLO, Ltd., THL Credit Wind River 2014-3 CLO, Ltd., and a subadviser to a closed-end fund, THL Credit Senior Loan Fund (NYSE: TSLF). In addition, our officers may serve in similar capacities for one or more private funds or registered closed-end funds. The Advisor and its affiliates may determine that an investment is appropriate for us and for one or more of those other funds. In such event, depending on the availability of such investment and other appropriate factors, the Advisor or its affiliates may determine that we should invest side-

 

79


Table of Contents

by-side with one or more other funds. Any such investments will be made only to the extent permitted by applicable law and interpretive positions of the SEC and its staff, and consistent with the Advisor’s allocation procedures.

Greenway

On January 14, 2011, THL Credit Greenway Fund LLC, or Greenway, was formed as a Delaware limited liability company. Greenway is a portfolio company of the Company. Greenway is a closed-end investment fund which provides for no liquidity or redemption options and is not readily marketable. Greenway operates under a limited liability agreement dated January 19, 2011, or the Agreement. Greenway will continue in existence until January 14, 2021, subject to earlier termination pursuant to certain terms of the Agreement. The term may also be extended for up to three additional one-year periods pursuant to certain terms of the Agreement. Greenway had a two year investment period.

Greenway has $150 million of capital committed by affiliates of a single institutional investor, and is managed by the Company. The Company’s capital commitment to Greenway is $0.02 million. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, all of the capital had been called by Greenway. Our nominal investment in Greenway is reflected in the December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013 Consolidated Schedules of Investments. As of December 31, 2014, distributions representing 94.6% of the committed capital of the investor have been made from Greenway. Distributions from Greenway, including return of capital and earnings, to its members from inception through December 31, 2014 totaled $141.9 million.

The Company acts as the investment adviser to Greenway and is entitled to receive certain fees relating to its investment management services provided, including a base management fee, a performance fee and a portion of the closing fees on each investment transaction. As a result, Greenway is classified as an affiliate of the Company. For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, the Company earned $0.9 million, $1.6 million and $2.6 million in fees related to Greenway, respectively, which are included in other income from non-controlled, affiliated investment in the Consolidated Statements of Operations. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $0.3 million and $0.2 million of fees related to Greenway, respectively, were included in due from affiliate on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.

Greenway invested in securities similar to those of the Company pursuant to investment and allocation guidelines which address, among other things, the size of the borrowers, the types of transactions and the concentration and investment ratio amongst Greenway and the Company. However, the Company has the discretion to invest in other securities.

Greenway II

On January 31, 2013, THL Credit Greenway Fund II, LLC, or Greenway II LLC, was formed as a Delaware limited liability company and is a portfolio company of the Company. Greenway II LLC is a closed-end investment fund which provides for no liquidity or redemption options and is not readily marketable. Greenway II LLC operates under a limited liability agreement dated February 11, 2013, as amended, or the Greenway II LLC Agreement. Greenway II LLC will continue in existence for eight years from the final closing date, subject to earlier termination pursuant to certain terms of the Greenway II LLC Agreement. The term may also be extended for up to three additional one-year periods pursuant to certain terms of the Greenway II LLC Agreement. Greenway II LLC has a two year investment period.

As contemplated in the Greenway II LLC Agreement, we have established a related investment vehicle and entered into an investment management agreement with an account set up by an unaffiliated third party investor to invest alongside Greenway II LLC pursuant to similar economic terms. The account is also managed by the Company. References to “Greenway II” herein include Greenway II LLC and the account of the related investment vehicle. Greenway II has $186.5 million of commitments primarily from institutional investors. As of

 

80


Table of Contents

December 31, 2014, $159.5 million of commitments have been called. The Company’s capital commitment to Greenway II is $0.01 million. Our nominal investment in Greenway II LLC is reflected in the December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013 Consolidated Schedules of Investments. Greenway II LLC is managed by the Company. As of December 31, 2014, distributions representing 12.4% of the committed capital of the Greenway II investors have been made from Greenway II. Distributions from Greenway II to its members and investors, including return of capital and earnings, from inception through December 31, 2014 totaled $23.3 million.

The Company acts as the investment adviser to Greenway II and is entitled to receive certain fees relating to its investment management services provided, including a base management fee, a performance fee and a portion of the closing fees on each investment transaction. As a result, Greenway II is classified as an affiliate of the Company. For the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, we earned $2.1 million and $1.3 million, respectively, in fees related to Greenway II, which are included in other income from non-controlled, affiliated investment in the Consolidated Statements of Operations. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, $0.7 million and $0.8 million of fees related to Greenway II were included in due from affiliate on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities. During the year ended December 31, 2013, the Company sold a portion of its investments in seven portfolio companies at fair value, for total proceeds of $19.5 million, to Greenway II. Fair value was determined in accordance with the Company’s valuation policies.

Other deferred costs consist of placement agent expenses incurred in connection with the offer and sale of partnership interests in Greenway II. These costs are capitalized when commitments close and are recognized as an expense over the period when the Company expects to collect management fees from Greenway II. For the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, we recognized $0.2 million and $0.1 million, respectively, in expenses related to placement agent expenses, which are included in other general and administrative expenses in the Consolidated Statements of Operations. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, $0.6 million and $0.8 million, respectively, were included in other deferred costs on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.

Greenway II invests in securities similar to those of the Company pursuant to investment and allocation guidelines which address, among other things, the size of the borrowers, the types of transactions and the concentration and investment ratio amongst Greenway II and the Company. However, the Company has the discretion to invest in other securities.

Investment in Funds

LCP Capital Fund LLC

We had invested in a membership interest of LCP Capital Fund LLC, or LCP, a private investment company that was organized to participate in investment opportunities that arose when a special purpose entity, or SPE, or sponsor thereof, needed to raise capital to achieve ratings, regulatory, accounting, tax, or other objectives. LCP was a closed vehicle which provided for no liquidity or redemption options and is not readily marketable. LCP was managed by an unaffiliated third party. We had originally contributed $12.0 million of capital in the form of membership interests in LCP, which was invested in an underlying SPE referred to as Series 2005-01.

We expected that Series 2005-01 would terminate on February 15, 2015; however, on February 3, 2014, LCP was liquidated and we received proceeds of $8.4 million, which was the remaining value of the Company’s interest.

Our contributed capital in LCP was maintained in a collateral account held by a third-party custodian, who was neither affiliated with us nor with LCP, and acted as collateral on certain credit default swaps for the Series 2005-01 for which LCP received fixed premium payments throughout the year, adjusted for expenses incurred by LCP. The SPE purchased assets on a non-recourse basis and LCP agreed to reimburse the SPE up to a specified amount for potential losses. LCP held the contributed cash invested for an SPE transaction in a segregated account that secured the payment obligation of LCP.

 

81


Table of Contents

CLO Residual Interests

As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, we had investments in the CLO residual interests, or subordinated notes, which can also be structured as income notes. These subordinated notes are subordinate to the secured notes issued in connection with each CLO. The secured notes in each structure are collateralized by portfolios consisting primarily of broadly syndicated senior secured bank loans. The following table shows a summary of our investments in CLO residual interests (in millions):

 

                    As of December 31, 2014     As of December 31, 2013  

Issuer

 

Security
Description

  Ownership
Interest
    Total
CLO
Amount
at initial
par
    THL Credit
Residual
Amount at
Amortized Cost
    THL Credit
Residual Amount at
Fair Value
    THL Credit
Residual Amount at
Amortized Cost
    THL Credit
Residual
Amount at
Fair Value
 

Adirondack Park CLO Ltd.

  Subordinated Notes, Residual Interest     18.7   $ 517.0      $ 8.2      $ 8.2      $ 9.2      $ 9.1   

Dryden CLO, Ltd.

  Subordinated Notes, Residual Interest     23.1     516.4        8.0        8.2        9.1        9.3   

Flagship VII, Ltd.

  Subordinated Notes, Residual Interest     12.6     441.8        4.1        4.3        4.4        4.4   

Flagship VIII, Ltd.

  Subordinated Notes, Residual Interest     25.1     470.9        8.5        8.5        —          —     

Sheridan Square CLO, Ltd

  Income Notes, Residual Interest     10.4     724.5        5.4        5.7        6.1        6.2   

Octagon Income Note XIV, Ltd.

  Income Notes, Residual Interest     17.7     625.9        —          —          8.5        8.6   
       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
      Total CLO residual interestss      $ 34.2      $ 34.9      $ 37.3      $ 37.6   
       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The subordinated notes and income notes do not have a stated rate of interest, but are entitled to receive distributions on quarterly payment dates subject to the priority of payments to secured note holders in the structures if and to the extent funds are available for such purpose. The payments on the subordinated notes and income notes are subordinated not only to the interest and principal claims of all secured notes issued, but to certain administrative expenses, taxes, and the base and subordinated fees paid to the collateral manager. Payments to the subordinated notes and income notes may vary significantly quarter to quarter for a variety of reasons and may be subject to 100% loss. Investments in subordinated notes and income notes, due to the structure of the CLO, can be significantly impacted by change in the market value of the assets, the distributions on the assets, defaults and recoveries on the assets, capital gains and losses on the assets along with prices, interest rates and other risks associated with the assets.

For the years ended December 2014, 2013 and 2012, we recognized interest income totaling $4.7 million, $3.5 million, and $0.1, respectively, related to CLO residual interests.

Investment in Tax Receivable Agreement Payment Rights

In June 2012, we invested in a TRA that entitles us to certain payment rights, or TRA Payment Rights, from Duff & Phelps Corporation, or Duff & Phelps. The TRA transfers the economic value of certain tax deductions, or tax benefits, taken by Duff & Phelps to us and entitles us to a stream of payments to be received. The TRA payment right is, in effect, a subordinated claim on the issuing company which can be valued based on the credit risk of the issuer, which includes projected future earnings, the liquidity of the underlying payment right, risk of tax law changes, the effective tax rate and any other factors which might impact the value of the payment right.

 

 

82


Table of Contents

Through the TRA, we are entitled to receive an annual tax benefit payment based upon 85% of the savings from certain deductions along with interest. The payments that we are entitled to receive result from cash savings, if any, in U.S. federal, state or local income tax that Duff & Phelps realizes (i) from the tax savings derived from the goodwill and other intangibles created in connection with the Duff & Phelps initial public offering and (ii) from other income tax deductions. These tax benefit payments will continue until the relevant deductions are fully utilized, which is projected to be 16 years. Pursuant to the TRA, we maintain the right to enforce Duff & Phelps payment obligations as a transferee of the TRA contract. If Duff & Phelps chooses to pre-pay and terminate the TRA, we will be entitled to the present value of the expected future TRA payments. If Duff & Phelps breaches any material obligation then all obligations are accelerated and calculated as if an early termination occurred. Failure to make a payment is a breach of a material obligation if the failure occurs for more than three months.

The projected annual tax benefit payment is accrued on a quarterly basis and paid annually. The payment is allocated between a reduction in the cost basis of the investment and interest income based upon an amortization schedule. Based upon the characteristics of the investment, we have chosen to categorize the investment in the TRA payment rights as an investment in payment rights.

The amortized cost basis and fair value of the TRA as of December 31, 2014 was $11.9 million and $13.5 million, respectively. The amortized cost basis and fair value of the TRA as of December 31, 2013 was $12.2 million and $13.8 million, respectively. For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, the Company recognized interest income totaling $2.1 million, $2.0 million, and $1.2 million, respectively, related to the TRA.

Asset Quality

We employ the use of board observation and information rights, regular dialogue with company management and sponsors, and detailed internally generated monitoring reports to actively monitor performance. Additionally, THL Credit has developed a monitoring template that promotes compliance with these standards and that is used as a tool to assess investment performance relative to plan.

As part of the monitoring process, the Advisor assesses the risk profile of each of our investments and assigns each portfolio investment a score of a 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5

The revised investment performance scores, or IPS, are as follows:

1 – The portfolio investment is performing above our underwriting expectations.

2 – The portfolio investment is performing as expected at the time of underwriting. All new investments are initially scored a 2.

3 – The portfolio investment is operating below our underwriting expectations, and requires closer monitoring. The company may be out of compliance with financial covenants, however, principal or interest payments are generally not past due.

4 – The portfolio investment is performing materially below our underwriting expectations and returns on our investment are likely to be impaired. Principal or interest payments may be past due, however, full recovery of principal and interest payments are expected.

5 – The portfolio investment is performing substantially below expectations and the risk of the investment has increased substantially. The company is in payment default and the principal and interest payments are not expected to be repaid in full.

 

83


Table of Contents

For any investment receiving a score of a 3 or lower THL Credit Advisors will increase their level of focus and prepare regular updates for the investment committee summarizing current operating results, material impending events and recommended actions.

The Advisor monitors and, when appropriate, changes the investment scores assigned to each investment in our portfolio. In connection with our investment valuation process, the Advisor and board of directors review these investment scores on a quarterly basis. Our average investment score was 2.07 and 2.13 at December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively. The following is a distribution of the investment scores of our portfolio companies at December 31, 2014 and 2013 (in millions):

 

     December 31, 2014     December 31, 2013  

Investment Score

   Fair
Value
     % of Total
Portfolio
    Fair
Value
     % of Total
Portfolio
 

1(a)

   $ 72.1         9.2   $ 58.9         9.1

2(b)

     569.5         72.7     484.5         74.7

3(c)

     136.0         17.3     72.9         11.2

4(d)

     6.6         0.8     32.6         5.0

5

     —           —          —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 784.2         100.0   $ 648.9         100.0
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) 

As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, Investment Score “1” included no loans to companies in which we also hold equity securities.

(b) 

As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, Investment Score “2” included $126.0 million and $62.4 million, respectively, of loans to companies in which we also hold equity securities.

(c) 

As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, Investment Score “3” included $24.7 million and $14.5 million, respectively, of loans to companies in which we also hold equity securities.

(d) 

As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, Investment Score “4” included $4.6 million and $10.2 million, respectively, of loans to companies in which we also hold equity securities.

Loans are placed on non-accrual status when principal or interest payments are past due 30 days or more and/or when it is no longer probable that principal or interest will be collected. However, we may make exceptions to this policy if the loan has sufficient collateral value and is in the process of collection. As of December 31, 2014, we had no loans on non-accrual. As of December 31, 2013, we had two loans on non-accrual with an amortized cost basis of $21.0 million and fair value of $16.8 million. We record the reversal of any previously accrued income against the same income category reflected in the Consolidated Statement of Operations.

Results of Operations

Comparison of the Years Ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012

Investment Income

We generate revenues primarily in the form of interest on the debt and other income-producing securities we hold. Other income-producing securities include investments in funds, investment in payment rights and residual interests, or equity, of collateralized loan obligations, or CLOs. Our investments in fixed income instruments generally have an expected maturity of five to seven years, and typically bear interest at a fixed or floating rate. Interest on our debt securities is generally payable quarterly. Payments of principal of our debt investments may be amortized over the stated term of the investment, deferred for several years or due entirely at maturity. In some cases, our debt instruments and preferred stock investments may defer payments of dividends or pay interest in-kind, or PIK. Any outstanding principal amount of our debt securities and any accrued but unpaid interest will generally become due at the maturity date. The level of interest income we receive is directly related to the balance of interest-bearing investments multiplied by the weighted average yield of our investments. In

 

84


Table of Contents

addition to interest income, we may receive dividends and other distributions related to our equity investments. We may also generate revenue in the form of fees from the management of Greenway and Greenway II, prepayment premiums, commitment, loan origination, structuring or due diligence fees, exit fees, portfolio company administration fees, fees for providing significant managerial assistance and consulting fees.

The following shows the breakdown of investment income for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 (in millions):

 

     Years ended December 31,  
     2014      2013      2012  

Interest income on debt securities

        

Cash interest

   $ 67.4       $ 51.7       $ 36.7   

PIK interest

     2.3         3.2         4.1   

Prepayment premiums

     2.5         1.3         2.6   

Net accretion of discounts and other fees

     4.4         4.1         3.6   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total interest on debt securities

     76.6         60.3         47.0   

Dividend income

     3.1         4.1         0.4   

Interest income on other income-producing securities

     7.2         6.5         2.8   

Fees related to Greenway and Greenway II

     3.0         3.0         2.6   

Other income

     2.0         0.8         0.3   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 91.9       $ 74.7       $ 53.1   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The increases in investment income from the respective periods were primarily due to the growth in the overall investment portfolio and related interest income as well as other income.

The following shows a rollforward of PIK income activity for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 (in millions):

 

     Years ended December 31,  
     2014      2013      2012  

Accumulated PIK balance, beginning of year

   $ 6.1       $ 5.8       $ 3.5   

PIK income capitalized/receivable

     2.3         3.2         4.1   

PIK received in cash from repayments

     (1.4      (2.9      (1.8
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Accumulated PIK balance, end of year

   $ 7.0       $ 6.1       $ 5.8   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

In certain investment transactions, we may provide advisory services. For services that are separately identifiable and external evidence exists to substantiate fair value, income is recognized as earned. We earned no income from advisory services related to portfolio companies for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012.

Expenses

Our primary operating expenses include the payment of base management fees, an incentive fee, borrowing expenses related to our credit facilities, and expenses reimbursable under the investment management agreement and the allocable portion of overhead under the administration and investment management agreements (“administrator expenses”). The base management fee compensates the Advisor for work in identifying, evaluating, negotiating, closing and monitoring our investments. Our investment management agreement and administration agreement provides that we will reimburse the Advisor for costs and expenses incurred by the Advisor for facilities, office equipment and utilities allocable to the performance by the Advisor of its duties under the agreements, as well as any costs and expenses incurred by the Advisor relating to any administrative or operating services provided by the Advisor to us. We bear all other costs and expenses of our operations and transactions.

 

85


Table of Contents

The following shows the breakdown of expenses for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 (in millions):

 

     Years ended December 31,  
     2014      2013      2012  

Expenses

        

Incentive fees(a)

   $ 11.2       $ 10.7       $ 7.0   

Base management fees

     11.1         7.5         4.9   

Administrator expenses

     3.8         3.6         3.2   

Credit facility interest and fees(b)

     11.1         7.1         4.1   

Other expenses

     5.5         3.9         3.1   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total expenses before taxes

     42.7         32.8         22.3   

Income tax provision and excise tax(c)

     1.0         0.5         0.6   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total expenses after taxes

   $ 43.7       $ 33.3       $ 22.9   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) 

For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, incentive fees include the effect of the GAAP Incentive Fee (reversal) expense of ($0.7) million, $0.3 million and $(0.5) million, respectively. The GAAP Incentive Fee accrual considers the cumulative aggregate realized gains and losses and unrealized appreciation or depreciation of investments or other financial instruments. There can be no assurance that such amounts of unrealized appreciation or depreciation will be realized in the future. Accordingly, such GAAP Incentive Fee, as calculated and accrued, would not necessarily be payable under the Investment Management Agreement, and may never be paid based upon the computation of incentive fees in subsequent quarters.

(b) 

Interest, fees and amortization of deferred financing costs related to our Revolving Facility, Term Loan Facility, and Notes.

(c) 

Amounts include the income taxes related to earnings by our consolidated wholly-owned tax blocker corporations established to hold equity or equity-like portfolio company investments organized as pass-through entities and excise taxes related to our undistributed earnings.

The increase in operating expenses for the respective periods was due primarily to the increase in base management fees related to the growth of the portfolio and credit facility expenses, which was a result of an increase in the credit facility commitments and borrowings outstanding. The increase to other expenses was due to an increase in professional fees and other operating costs related to the growth and maturity of the portfolio. Professional fees for the year ended December 31, 2014 included $0.7 million related to recently restructured investments.

We expect certain of our operating expenses, including administrator expenses, professional fees and other general and administrative expenses to decline as a percentage of our total assets during periods of growth and increase as a percentage of our total assets during periods of asset declines.

Net Investment Income

Net investment income was $48.2 million, or $1.42 per common share based on a weighted average of 33,905,202 common shares outstanding for the year ended December 31, 2014, as compared to $41.4 million, or $1.37 per common share based on a weighted average of 30,286,955 common shares outstanding for the year ended December 31, 2013 and, as compared to $30.2 million, or $1.38 per common share based on a weighted average of 21,852,197 common shares outstanding for the year ended December 31, 2012.

The increase in net investment income for the respective periods is primarily attributable to the growth in the overall investment portfolio and related interest income.

 

86


Table of Contents

Net Realized Gains and Losses on Investments, net of income tax provision

We measure realized gains or losses by the difference between the net proceeds from the repayment or sale and the amortized cost basis of the investment, using the specific identification method, without regard to unrealized appreciation or depreciation previously recognized.

The following shows the breakdown of realized gains and losses for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 (in millions):

 

     For the years ended December 31,  
         2014              2013              2012      

Escrow receivable settlement(a)

   $ (1.0    $ —         $ —     

BBB Industries, Inc.

     0.1         —           —     

Blue Coat Systems, Inc.

     0.6         —           —     

Expert Global Solutions, Inc.

     (0.3      —           —     

C&K Market, Inc.(b)

     (1.0      —           —     

Jefferson Management Holdings, LLC

     (0.5      —           —     

Octagon Income Note XIV, Ltd.

     0.2         —           —     

Surgery Center Holdings, Inc.

     0.7         0.7         —     

YP Equity Investors, LLC(c)

     —           2.0         —     

Wingspan Portfolio Holdings, Inc.(d)

     (11.9      —           —     

Other

     0.2         (0.1      0.4   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net realized (losses)/gains

   $ (12.9    $ 2.6       $ 0.4   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) 

Escrow receivable settlement in connection with arbitration proceedings. Escrow related to the sale of IMDS Corporation in a prior period. In addition to the realized loss, we reversed $0.3 million of previously accelerated amortization income against interest income recognized for the year ended December 31, 2014.

(b) 

On August 12, 2014, the date C&K emerged from bankruptcy, the cost basis of the senior subordinated note, certain interest due and warrants totaling $14.3 million were converted to common and preferred equity. In connection with the extinguishment and conversion to equity, the Company recognized a realized loss in the amount of $1.0 million, which was offset by a corresponding change in unrealized appreciation.

(c) 

For the year ended December 31, 2014, an offsetting tax provision of $0.2 million was recorded in the Consolidated Statements of Operations. For the years ending December 31, 2013 and 2012 there was no tax provision. These amounts reflect a revision to previously recognized estimated realized gains and dividend income as a result of adjusted tax estimates from the portfolio company.

(d) 

On October 20, 2014, the cost basis of the subordinated note totaling $18.4 million was converted to common equity as part of a restructuring of the business. In connection with the extinguishment and conversion to equity of an affiliate, Dimont & Associates, Inc., the Company recognized a realized loss in the amount of $11.9 million, which was offset by a corresponding change in unrealized appreciation.

The change in realized (losses) and gains for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 is primarily attributable to realized losses recognized on C&K Market Inc. and Wingspan Portfolio Holdings, Inc. as a result of converting subordinated debt and warrants into controlling equity ownership interests as part of a restructuring of each business as well as the loss on the IMDS Corporation escrow.

The change in realized (losses) and gains for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012 is primarily attributable to distributions from equity investments in Surgery Center Holdings, Inc. and YP Equity Investors, LLC.

Net Change in Unrealized Appreciation of Investments

Net change in unrealized appreciation primarily reflects the change in portfolio investment values during the reporting period, including the reversal of previously recorded appreciation or depreciation when gains or losses are realized.

 

87


Table of Contents

The following shows the breakdown in the changes in unrealized appreciation of investments for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 (in millions):

 

     Years ended December 31,  
     2014      2013      2012  

Gross unrealized appreciation on investments

   $ 13.3       $ 9.1       $ 4.5   

Gross unrealized depreciation on investments

     (17.0      (8.8      (2.8

Reversal of prior period net unrealized depreciation (appreciation) upon a realization

     5.9         —           (2.9
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 2.2       $ 0.3       $ (1.2
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The net change in unrealized appreciation on our investments was driven primarily by changes in the capital market conditions, financial performance of certain portfolio companies, and the reversal of unrealized depreciation (appreciation) of investments repaid or converted into equity in connection with a restructuring and related debt extinguishment.

Provision for Taxes on Unrealized Gains on Investments

Certain consolidated subsidiaries of ours are subject to U.S. federal and state income taxes. These taxable entities are not consolidated with the Company for income tax purposes and may generate income tax liabilities or assets from temporary differences in the recognition of items for financial reporting and income tax purposes at the subsidiaries. For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, the Company recognized a provision for tax on unrealized gains on investments of $0.2 million, $2.0 million and $0.5 million for consolidated subsidiaries, respectively. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $2.6 million and $2.4 million, respectively, were included in deferred tax liability on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities relating to deferred tax on unrealized gain on investments. The change in provision for tax on unrealized gains on investments relates primarily to changes to the unrealized appreciation of the investments held in these taxable consolidated subsidiaries as well as the change in the 2013 estimates received from certain portfolio companies.

Realized and Unrealized Appreciation (Depreciation) of Interest Rate Derivative

The interest rate derivative was entered into on May 10, 2012. Unrealized depreciation reflects the value of the interest rate derivative agreement at the end of the reporting period. For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, the net change of unrealized appreciation (depreciation) on interest rate derivative totaled $0.1 million, $0.8 million and ($1.1) million, respectively, which is listed under net change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation) on interest rate derivatives in the Consolidated Statement of Operations. The changes were due to capital market changes impacting swap rates.

We measure realized gains or losses on the interest rate derivative based upon the difference between the proceeds received or the amount paid on the interest rate derivative. For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, we realized a loss of $0.5 million, $0.4 million and $0.2 million, respectively, as interest rate derivative periodic interest payments, net on the Consolidated Statement of Operations.

Net Increase in Net Assets Resulting from Operations

Net increase in net assets resulting from operations totaled $36.8 million, or $1.08 per common share based on a weighted average of 33,905,202 common shares for the year ended December 31, 2014, as compared to $42.7 million, or $1.41 per common share based on a weighted average of 30,286,955 common shares for the year ended December 31, 2013, as compared to $27.6 million, or $1.26 per common share based on a weighted average of 21,852,197 common shares outstanding for the year ended December 31, 2012.

 

88


Table of Contents

The decrease in net assets resulting from operations between the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 is due primarily to the growth in net investment income offset by net realized and unrealized losses in the portfolio. The increase in net assets from operations between the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012 is due to the continued growth in net investment income, which is a result of growing our portfolio, dividends and realized gains from certain equity investments, the provision for taxes on unrealized gains on investments as well as changes in the unrealized value of our interest rate derivative.

Financial condition, liquidity and capital resources

Cash Flows from Operating and Financing Activities

Our liquidity and capital resources are derived from our credit facilities, equity raises and cash flows from operations, including investment sales and repayments, and investment income earned. Our primary use of funds from operations includes investments in portfolio companies, payment of dividends to the holders of our common stock and payments of fees and other operating expenses we incur. We have used, and expect to continue to use, our borrowings and the proceeds from the turnover in our portfolio and from public and private offerings of securities to finance our investment objectives, to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act.

We may raise additional equity or debt capital through both registered offerings off our shelf registration statement and private offerings of securities, by securitizing a portion of our investments or borrowings from credit facilities. To the extent we determine to raise additional equity through an offering of our common stock at a price below net asset value, existing investors will experience dilution. During our 2014 Annual Stockholder Meeting held on June 3, 2014, our stockholders authorized us, with the approval of our Board of Directors, to sell up to 25% of our outstanding common stock at a price below our then current net asset value per share and to offer and issue debt with warrants or debt convertible into shares of our common stock at an exercise or conversion price that will not be less than the fair market value per share but may be below the then current net asset value per share. There can be no assurance that these capital resources will be available.

In November 2014, the Company closed a public debt offering selling $50.0 million of Notes due 2021, or the Notes, including the exercise of the over allotment option, through a group of underwriters, less an underwriting discount, and received net proceeds of $48.5 million.

On April 30, 2014, we closed an additional $85.0 million of commitments to our Facilities, which brings the aggregate size to $410.0 million of commitments. We borrowed $321.3 million under our Revolving Facility and $13.5 million under our Term Loan Facility for the year ended December 31, 2014 and repaid $244.2 million on our Revolving Facility from proceeds received from the Term Loan Facility, the Notes, investment, prepayments and sales and investment income. We borrowed $410.7 million under our Revolving Facility and $43.0 million under our Term Loan Facility for the year ended December 31, 2013 and repaid $299.4 million on our Revolving Facility from proceeds received from an equity offering, Term Loan Facility and investment income.

Our operating activities used cash of $95.9 million, $210.5 million, and $95.4 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, primarily in connection with the purchase and sales of portfolio investments. For the year ended December 31, 2014, our financing activities provided cash of $90.6 million from our net borrowings as well as $50.0 million from the Notes and used $46.1 million for distributions to stockholders and $3.7 million for the payment of financing and offering costs. For the year ended December 31, 2013, our financing activities provided cash of $265.3 million from our common stock offering and net borrowings and used cash of $44.7 million for distributions to stockholders and $7.0 million for the payment of financing and offering costs. For the year ended December 31, 2012, our financing activities provided cash of $130.9 million from our common stock offering and net borrowings and used cash of $29.4 million for distributions to stockholders and $6.8 million for the payment of financing and offering costs.

As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, we had cash of $2.7 million and $7.8 million, respectively. We had no cash equivalents as of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013.

 

89


Table of Contents

We believe cash balances, our Revolving Facility capacity and any proceeds generated from the sale or pay down of investments provides us with the liquidity necessary to acquit our pipeline in the near future.

Credit Facility

On April 30, 2014, we entered into an amendment, or the Revolving Amendment, to our existing revolving credit agreement, or Revolving Facility, and entered into an amendment, or the Term Loan Amendment, to our Term Loan Facility. The Revolving Facility and Term Loan Facility are collectively referred to as the Facilities.

The Revolving Loan Amendment revised the Facility dated May 10, 2012 to, among other things, increase the amount available for borrowing under the Revolving Facility from $232.0 million to $303.5 million and extend the maturity date from May 2017 to April 2018 (with a one year term out period beginning in April 2017). The one year term out period is the one year anniversary between the revolver termination date, or the end of the availability period, and the maturity date. During this time, we are required to make mandatory prepayments on its loans from the proceeds we receive from the sale of assets, extraordinary receipts, returns of capital or the issuances of equity or debt. The Revolving Amendment also changes the interest rate of the Revolving Facility to LIBOR plus 2.5% (with no LIBOR floor). The non-use fee is 1.0% annually if we use 35% or less of the Revolving Facility and 0.50% annually if we use more than 35% (with LIBOR floor) of the Revolving Facility. We elect the LIBOR rate on the loans outstanding on our Revolving Facility, which can have a maturity date that is one, two, three or nine months. The LIBOR rate on the borrowings outstanding on our Revolving Facility currently has a one month maturity.

The Term Loan Amendment revised the Term Loan Facility dated May 10, 2012 to, among other things, increase the amount borrowed from $93.0 million to $106.5 million and extend the maturity date from May 2018 to April 2019. The Term Loan Amendment also changes the interest rate of the Term Loan Facility to LIBOR plus 3.25% (with no LIBOR Floor) and has substantially similar terms to our existing Revolving Facility (as amended by the Revolving Amendment). The Company elects the LIBOR rate on our Term Loan, which can have a maturity date that is one, two, three or nine months. The LIBOR rate on its Term Loan currently has a one month maturity.

Each of the Facilities includes an accordion feature permitting us to expand the Facilities, if certain conditions are satisfied; provided, however, that the aggregate amount of the Facilities, collectively, is capped at $600.0 million.

The Facilities generally require payment of interest on a quarterly basis for ABR loans (commonly based on the Prime Rate or the Federal Funds Rate), and at the end of the applicable interest period for Eurocurrency loans bearing interest at LIBOR, the interest rate benchmark used to determine the variable rates paid on the Facilities. LIBOR maturities can range between one and nine months at the election of the Company. All outstanding principal is due upon each maturity date. The Facilities also require a mandatory prepayment of interest and principal upon certain customary triggering events (including, without limitation, the disposition of assets or the issuance of certain securities).

Borrowings under the Facilities are subject to, among other things, a minimum borrowing/collateral base. The Facilities have certain collateral requirements and/or financial covenants, including covenants related to: (a) limitations on the incurrence of additional indebtedness and liens, (b) limitations on certain investments, (c) limitations on certain restricted payments, (d) limitations on the creation or existence of agreements that prohibit liens on certain properties of ours and our subsidiaries, and (e) compliance with certain financial maintenance standards including (i) minimum stockholders’ equity, (ii) a ratio of total assets (less total liabilities not represented by senior securities) to the aggregate amount of senior securities representing indebtedness, of us and our subsidiaries, of not less than 2.10:1.0, (iii) minimum liquidity, (iv) minimum net worth, and (v) a consolidated interest coverage ratio. In addition to the financial maintenance standards, described in the preceding sentence, borrowings under the Facilities (and the incurrence of certain other permitted debt) are subject to compliance with a borrowing base that applies different advance rates to different types of assets in our portfolio.

 

90


Table of Contents

The Facilities’ documents also include default provisions such as the failure to make timely payments under the Facilities, the occurrence of a change in control, and the failure by us to materially perform under the operative agreements governing the Facilities, which, if not complied with, could, at the option of the lenders under the Facilities, accelerate repayment under the Facilities, thereby materially and adversely affecting our liquidity, financial condition and results of operations. Each loan originated under the Revolving Facility is subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions. We cannot be assured that we will be able to borrow funds under the Revolving Facility at any particular time or at all. We are currently in compliance with all financial covenants under the Facilities.

For the year ended December 31, 2014, we borrowed $334.8 million and repaid $244.2 million under the Facilities. For the year ended December 31, 2013, we borrowed $453.7 million and repaid $299.4 million under the Facilities. For the year ended December 31, 2012, we borrowed $189.9 million and repaid $144.9 million under the Facilities.

The following shows a summary of our Revolving Facility and Term Loan Facility as of December 31, 2014 and 2013 (in millions):

 

As of December 31, 2014         

in millions

        

Facility

   Commitments      Borrowings
Outstanding
     Weighted
Average
Interest Rate
 

Revolving Facility

   $ 303.5       $ 188.4         2.69

Term Loan Facility

     106.5         106.5         3.44
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

Total

   $ 410.0       $ 294.9         2.96
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

As of December 31, 2013

 

in millions

        

Facility

   Commitments      Borrowings
Outstanding
     Weighted
Average
Interest Rate
 

Revolving Facility

   $ 232.0       $ 111.3         3.19

Term Loan Facility

     93.0         93.0         4.17
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

Total

   $ 325.0       $ 204.3         3.63
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the carrying amount of the Company’s outstanding Facilities approximated fair value. The fair values of the Company’s Facilities are determined in accordance with ASC 820, which defines fair value in terms of the price that would be paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date under current market conditions. The fair value of the Company’s Facilities are estimated based upon market interest rates and entities with similar credit risk. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the Facilities would be deemed to be Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.

Interest expense and related fees, excluding amortization of deferred financing costs, of $9.8 million, $5.6 million and $3.1 million were incurred in connection with the Facilities during the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

In accordance with the 1940 Act, with certain exceptions, the Company is only allowed to borrow amounts such that its asset coverage, as defined in the 1940 Act, is at least 200% after such borrowing. The asset coverage as of December 31, 2014 is in excess of 200%.

Notes

On November 18, 2014, we closed a public offering of $50.0 million in aggregate principal amount of 6.75% notes, or the Notes. The Notes mature on November 15, 2021, and may be redeemed in whole or in part at

 

91


Table of Contents

any time or from time to time at our option on or after November 15, 2017. The Notes bear interest at a rate of 6.75% per year payable quarterly on March 30, June 30, September 30 and December 30, of each year, beginning December 30, 2014 and trade on the New York Stock Exchange under the trading symbol “TCRX.”

The Notes are our direct unsecured obligations and rank: (i) pari passu with our other outstanding and future senior unsecured indebtedness; (ii) senior to any of our future indebtedness that expressly provides it is subordinated to the Notes; (iii) effectively subordinated to all our existing and future secured indebtedness (including indebtedness that is initially unsecured to which we subsequently grant security), to the extent of the value of the assets securing such indebtedness, including without limitation, borrowings under our Revolving Facility and Term Loan Facility; (iv) structurally subordinated to all existing and future indebtedness and other obligations of any of our subsidiaries.

The Base Indenture, as supplemented by the First Supplemental Indenture, contains certain covenants including covenants requiring us to comply with (regardless of whether it is subject to) the Section 18 (a)(1)(A) as modified by Section 61(a)(1) of the 1940 Act or any successor provisions, whether or not we continue to be subject to such provisions of the 1940 Act, but giving effect, in either case, to any exemptive relief granted to us by the SEC. Currently these provisions generally prohibit us from making additional borrowings, including through the issuance of additional debt or the sale of additional debt securities, unless our asset coverage, as defined in the 1940 Act, equals at least 200% after such borrowings. These covenants are subject to important limitations and exceptions that are described in the Indenture, as supplemented by the First Supplemental Indenture. The Indenture provides for customary events of default and further provides that the Trustee or the holders of 25% in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Notes in a series may declare such Notes immediately due and payable upon the occurrence of any event of default after expiration of any applicable grace period.

As of December 31, 2014, the carrying amount and fair value of our Notes was $50.0 million and $51.6 million, respectively. The fair value of our Notes are determined in accordance with ASC 820, which defines fair value in terms of the price that would be paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date under current market conditions. The fair value of the Notes is based on the closing price of the security, which is a Level 2 input under ASC 820 due to the trading volume. In connection with the issuance of the Notes, we incurred $2.1 million of fees and expenses. These amounts were capitalized and are being amortized using the effective interest method over the term of the Notes. For the year ended December 31, 2014, we amortized approximately $0.04 million of deferred financing costs, which is included under amortization of deferred financing costs on the Consolidated Statements of Operations. As of December 31, 2014, we had approximately $2.1 million of remaining deferred financing costs on the Notes, which is included under Deferred Financing Costs on our Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.

For the year ending December 31, 2014, we incurred interest expense on the Notes of approximately $0.4 million. This interest expense was paid on December 30, 2014.

As of December 31, 2014, we were in compliance with the terms of the indenture and the supplemental indenture governing the Notes. See Note 7 to our consolidated financial statements for more detail on the Notes.

Interest Rate Derivative

On May 10, 2012, we entered into a five-year interest rate swap agreement, or swap agreement, with ING Capital Markets, LLC. Under the swap agreement, with a notional value of $50 million, we pay a fixed rate of 1.1425% and receive a floating rate based upon the current three-month LIBOR rate. We entered into the swap agreement to manage interest rate risk and not for speculative purposes.

We record the change in valuation of the swap agreement in unrealized appreciation (depreciation) as of each measurement period. When the quarterly swap amounts are paid or received under the swap agreement, the amounts are recorded as a realized gain (loss) as interest rate derivative periodic interest payments, net on the Consolidated Statement of Operations.

 

92


Table of Contents

For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, we recognized $0.5 million, $0.4 million and $0.2 million, respectively, of realized loss from the swap agreement, which is reflected as interest rate derivative periodic interest payments, net in the Consolidated Statements of Operations.

For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, we recognized $0.1 million, $0.8 million and $(1.1) million of net change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation) from the swap agreement, respectively, which is listed under net change in unrealized depreciation on interest rate derivative in the Consolidated Statements of Operations. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, our fair value of the swap agreement is $(0.2) million and $(0.3) million, respectively, which is listed as an interest rate derivative liability on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.

Contractual Obligations and Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

From time to time, we, or the Advisor, may become party to legal proceedings in the ordinary course of business, including proceedings related to the enforcement of our rights under contracts with our portfolio companies. Neither we, nor the Advisor, are currently subject to any material legal proceedings.

Unfunded commitments to provide funds to portfolio companies are not reflected in our Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities. Our unfunded commitments may be significant from time to time. These commitments will be subject to the same underwriting and ongoing portfolio maintenance as are the on-balance sheet financial instruments that we hold. Since these commitments may expire without being drawn upon, the total commitment amount does not necessarily represent future cash requirements. We intend to use cash flow from normal and early principal repayments and proceeds from borrowings and offerings to fund these commitments. Funding to Logan JV will only be made pursuant to unanimous approval from its board of directors, which is composed of a representative from each of us and Perspecta.

As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, we have the following unfunded commitments to portfolio companies (in millions):

 

     As of  
     December 31, 2014      December 31, 2013  

Unfunded delayed draw facilities

   $ 29.8       $ 9.5   

Unfunded revolving commitments

     4.5         9.2   

Unfunded commitments to investments in funds

     1.9         4.0   

Unfunded commitments to Logan JV

     113.6         —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total unfunded commitments

   $ 149.8       $ 22.7   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Dividends

We have elected to be taxed as a regulated investment company under Subchapter M of the Code. In order to maintain our status as a regulated investment company, we are required to distribute at least 90% of our investment company taxable income. To avoid a 4% excise tax on undistributed earnings, we are required to distribute each calendar year the sum of (i) 98% of our ordinary income for such calendar year (ii) 98.2% of our net capital gains for the one-year period ending October 31 of that calendar year (iii) any income recognized, but not distributed, in preceding years and on which we paid no federal income tax. We intend to make distributions to stockholders on a quarterly basis of substantially all of our net investment income. Although we intend to make distributions of net realized capital gains, if any, at least annually, out of assets legally available for such distributions, we may in the future decide to retain such capital gains for investment. In addition, the extent and timing of special dividends, if any, will be determined by our board of directors and will largely be driven by portfolio specific events and tax considerations at the time.

 

93


Table of Contents

In addition, we may be limited in our ability to make distributions due to the BDC asset coverage test for borrowings applicable to us as a BDC under the 1940 Act.

The following table summarizes our dividends declared and paid or to be paid on all shares including dividends reinvested, if any: :

 

Date Declared

   Record Date    Payment Date    Amount Per Share

August 5, 2010

   September 2, 2010    September 30, 2010    $0.05

November 4, 2010

   November 30, 2010    December 28, 2010    $0.10

December 14, 2010

   December 31, 2010    January 28, 2011    $0.15

March 10, 2011

   March 25, 2011    March 31, 2011    $0.23

May 5, 2011

   June 15, 2011    June 30, 2011    $0.25

July 28, 2011

   September 15, 2011    September 30, 2011    $0.26

October 27, 2011

   December 15, 2011    December 30, 2011    $0.28

March 6, 2012

   March 20, 2012    March 30, 2012    $0.29

March 6, 2012

   March 20, 2012    March 30, 2012    $0.05

May 2, 2012

   June 15, 2012    June 29, 2012    $0.30

July 26, 2012

   September 14, 2012    September 28, 2012    $0.32

November 2, 2012

   December 14, 2012    December 28, 2012    $0.33

December 20, 2012

   December 31, 2012    January 28, 2013    $0.05

February 27, 2013

   March 15, 2013    March 29, 2013    $0.33

May 2, 2013

   June 14, 2013    June 28, 2013    $0.34

August 2, 2013

   September 16, 2013    September 30, 2013    $0.34

August 2, 2013

   September 16, 2013    September 30, 2013    $0.08

October 30, 2013

   December 16, 2013    December 31, 2013    $0.34

March 4, 2014

   March 17, 2014    March 31, 2014    $0.34

May 7, 2014

   June 16, 2014    June 30, 2014    $0.34

August 7, 2014

   September 15, 2014    September 30, 2014    $0.34

November 4, 2014

   December 15, 2014    December 31, 2014    $0.34

March 6, 2015

   March 20, 2015    March 31, 2015    $0.34

We may not be able to achieve operating results that will allow us to make distributions at a specific level or to increase the amount of these distributions from time to time. If we do not distribute a certain percentage of our income annually, we will suffer adverse tax consequences, including possible loss of our status as a regulated investment company. We cannot assure stockholders that they will receive any distributions at a particular level. We maintain an “opt in” dividend reinvestment plan for our common stockholders. As a result, unless stockholders specifically elect to have their dividends automatically reinvested in additional shares of common stock, stockholders will receive all such dividends in cash. Under the terms of our dividend reinvestment plan, dividends will primarily be paid in newly issued shares of common stock. However, we reserve the right to purchase shares in the open market in connection with the implementation of the plan. This feature of the plan means that, under certain circumstances, we may issue shares of our common stock at a price below net asset value per share, which could cause our stockholders to experience dilution.

Distributions in excess of our current and accumulated profits and earnings would be treated first as a return of capital to the extent of the stockholder’s tax basis, and any remaining distributions would be treated as a capital gain. The determination of the tax attributes of our distributions will be made annually as of the end of our fiscal year based upon our taxable income for the full year and distributions paid for the full year. Therefore, a determination made on a quarterly basis may not be representative of the actual tax attributes of our distributions for a full year. Each year, a statement on Form 1099-DIV identifying the source of the distribution will be sent to our U.S. stockholders of record. Our board of directors presently intends to declare and pay quarterly dividends. Our ability to pay dividends could be affected by future business performance, liquidity, capital needs, alternative investment opportunities and loan covenants.

 

94


Table of Contents

The tax character of distributions declared and paid in 2014 represented $44.2 million from ordinary income, $1.9 million from capital gains and $0 from tax return of capital. The tax character of distributions declared and paid in 2013 represented $43.0 million from ordinary income, $0.3 million from capital gains and $0 from tax return of capital. Generally accepted accounting principles require adjustments to certain components of net assets to reflect permanent differences between financial and tax reporting. These adjustments have no affect on net asset value per share. Permanent differences between financial and tax reporting at December 31, 2014 and 2013 were $1.3 million and $0.2 million, respectively.

Contractual obligations

We have entered into a contract with the Advisor to provide investment advisory services. Payments for investment advisory services under the investment management agreement in future periods will be equal to (a) an annual base management fee of 1.5% of our gross assets and (b) an incentive fee based on our performance. In addition, under our administration agreement, the Advisor will be reimbursed for administrative services incurred on our behalf. See description below under Related Party Transactions.

The following table shows our contractual obligations as of December 31, 2014 (in millions):

 

     Payments due by period  

Contractual Obligations(1)

   Total      Less than
1 year
     1 –3 years      3 – 5 years      After 5
years
 

Term Loan Facility

   $ 106.5         —          —        $ 106.5         —     

Note Payable

   $ 50.0         —          —          —        $ 50.0   

 

(1) 

Excludes commitments to extend credit to our portfolio companies.

We entered into an interest rate derivative to manage interest rate risk. We record the change in valuation of the swap agreement in unrealized appreciation (depreciation) as of each measurement period. When the quarterly interest rate swap amounts are paid or received under the swap agreement, the amounts are recorded as a realized gain (loss). Further discussion of the interest rate derivative is included in Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies” and Note 8 “Interest Rate Derivative” in the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements”.

Related Party Transactions

Investment Management Agreement

On March 6, 2015, our investment management agreement with the Advisor was re-approved by our Board of Directors. Under the investment management agreement, the Advisor, subject to the overall supervision of our board of directors, manages the day-to-day operations of, and provides investment advisory services to us.

The Advisor receives a fee for investment advisory and management services consisting of a base management fee and a two-part incentive fee.

The base management fee is calculated at an annual rate of 1.5% of our gross assets payable quarterly in arrears on a calendar quarter basis. For purposes of calculating the base management fee, “gross assets” is determined as the value of our assets without deduction for any liabilities. The base management fee is calculated based on the value of our gross assets at the end of the most recently completed calendar quarter, and appropriately adjusted for any share issuances or repurchases during the current calendar quarter.

For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, we incurred base management fees payable to the Advisor of $11.1 million, $7.5 million and $4.9 million, respectively. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $2.8 million and $2.2 million, respectively, was payable to the Advisor.

 

95


Table of Contents

The incentive fee has two components, ordinary income and capital gains, as follows:

The ordinary income component is calculated, and payable, quarterly in arrears based on our preincentive fee net investment income for the immediately preceding calendar quarter, subject to a cumulative total return requirement and to deferral of non-cash amounts. The preincentive fee net investment income, which is expressed as a rate of return on the value of our net assets attributable to our common stock, for the immediately preceding calendar quarter, will have a 2.0% (which is 8.0% annualized) hurdle rate (also referred to as “minimum income level”). Preincentive fee net investment income means interest income, dividend income and any other income (including any other fees, such as commitment, origination, structuring, diligence, managerial assistance and consulting fees or other fees that we receive from portfolio companies) accrued during the calendar quarter, minus our operating expenses for the quarter (including the base management fee, expenses payable under our administration agreement (discussed below), and any interest expense and any dividends paid on any issued and outstanding preferred stock, but excluding the incentive fee and any offering expenses and other expenses not charged to operations but excluding certain reversals to the extent such reversals have the effect of reducing previously accrued incentive fees based on the deferral of non-cash interest. Preincentive fee net investment income includes, in the case of investments with a deferred interest feature (such as original issue discount, debt instruments with PIK interest and zero coupon securities), accrued income that we have not yet received in cash. The Advisor receives no incentive fee for any calendar quarter in which our preincentive fee net investment income does not exceed the minimum income level. Subject to the cumulative total return requirement described below, the Advisor receives 100% of our preincentive fee net investment income for any calendar quarter with respect to that portion of the preincentive net investment income for such quarter, if any, that exceeds the minimum income level but is less than 2.5% (which is 10.0% annualized) of net assets (also referred to as the “catch-up” provision) and 20.0% of our preincentive fee net investment income for such calendar quarter, if any, greater than 2.5% (10.0% annualized) of net assets. The foregoing incentive fee is subject to a total return requirement, which provides that no incentive fee in respect of our preincentive fee net investment income is payable except to the extent 20.0% of the cumulative net increase in net assets resulting from operations over the then current and 11 preceding calendar quarters exceeds the cumulative incentive fees accrued and/or paid for the 11 preceding quarters. In other words, any ordinary income incentive fee that is payable in a calendar quarter is limited to the lesser of (i) 20% of the amount by which our preincentive fee net investment income for such calendar quarter exceeds the 2.0% hurdle, subject to the “catch-up” provision, and (ii) (x) 20% of the cumulative net increase in net assets resulting from operations for the then current and 11 preceding quarters minus (y) the cumulative incentive fees accrued and/or paid for the 11 preceding calendar quarters. For the foregoing purpose, the “cumulative net increase in net assets resulting from operations” is the amount, if positive, of the sum of our preincentive fee net investment income, base management fees, realized gains and losses and unrealized appreciation and depreciation for the then current and 11 preceding calendar quarters. In addition, the portion of such incentive fee that is attributable to deferred interest (sometimes referred to as payment-in-kind interest, or PIK, or original issue discount, or OID) will be paid to THL Credit Advisors, together with interest thereon from the date of deferral to the date of payment, only if and to the extent we actually receive such interest in cash, and any accrual thereof will be reversed if and to the extent such interest is reversed in connection with any write-off or similar treatment of the investment giving rise to any deferred interest accrual. There is no accumulation of amounts on the hurdle rate from quarter to quarter and accordingly there is no clawback of amounts previously paid if subsequent quarters are below the quarterly hurdle rate and there is no delay of payment if prior quarters are below the quarterly hurdle rate.

For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, we incurred $11.9 million, $10.4 million and $7.4 million, respectively, of incentive fees related to ordinary income. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $3.1 million and $2.1 million, respectively, of such incentive fees are currently payable to the Advisor. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, $1.1 million and $1.3 million, respectively of incentive fees incurred by us were generated from deferred interest (i.e. PIK, certain discount accretion and deferred interest) and are not payable until such amounts are received in cash.

 

96


Table of Contents

The second component of the incentive fee (capital gains incentive fee) is determined and payable in arrears as of the end of each calendar year (or upon termination of the investment management agreement, as of the termination date). This component is equal to 20.0% of our cumulative aggregate realized capital gains from inception through the end of that calendar year, computed net of the cumulative aggregate realized capital losses and cumulative aggregate unrealized capital depreciation through the end of such year. The aggregate amount of any previously paid capital gains incentive fees is subtracted from such capital gains incentive fee calculated. There was no capital gains incentive fee payable to our Advisor under the investment management agreement as of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013.

GAAP requires that the incentive fee accrual considers the cumulative aggregate realized gains and losses and unrealized capital appreciation or depreciation of investments or other financial instruments, such as an interest rate derivative, in the calculation, as an incentive fee would be payable if such realized gains and losses or unrealized capital appreciation or depreciation were realized, even though such realized gains and losses and unrealized capital appreciation or depreciation is not permitted to be considered in calculating the fee actually payable under the investment management agreement (“GAAP Incentive Fee”). There can be no assurance that such unrealized appreciation or depreciation will be realized in the future. Accordingly, such fee, as calculated and accrued, would not necessarily be payable under the investment management agreement, and may never be paid based upon the computation of incentive fees in subsequent periods. For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, we incurred (reversed) ($0.7) million, $0.3 million and $(0.5) million, respectively, of incentive fees related to the GAAP incentive fee.

Administration Agreement

We have also entered into an administration agreement with the Advisor under which the Advisor will provide administrative services to us. Under the administration agreement, the Advisor performs, or oversees the performance of administrative services necessary for our operation, which include, among other things, being responsible for the financial records which we are required to maintain and preparing reports to our stockholders and reports filed with the SEC. In addition, the Advisor assists in determining and publishing our net asset value, oversees the preparation and filing of our tax returns and the printing and dissemination of reports to our stockholders, and generally oversees the payment of our expenses and the performance of administrative and professional services rendered to us by others. We will reimburse the Advisor for our allocable portion of the costs and expenses incurred by the Advisor for overhead in performance by the Advisor of its duties under the administration agreement and the investment management agreement, including facilities, office equipment and our allocable portion of cost of compensation and related expenses of our chief financial officer and chief compliance officer and their respective staffs, as well as any costs and expenses incurred by the Advisor relating to any administrative or operating services provided to us by the Advisor. Our board of directors reviews the allocation methodologies with respect to such expenses. Such costs are reflected as Administrator expenses in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations. Under the administration agreement, the Advisor provides, on our behalf, managerial assistance to those portfolio companies to which the Company is required to provide such assistance. To the extent that our Advisor outsources any of its functions, the Company pays the fees associated with such functions on a direct basis without profit to the Advisor.

For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, we incurred administrator expenses of $3.8 million, $3.6 million and $3.2 million, respectively. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $0.0 million and $0.2 million, respectively, was payable to the Advisor.

License Agreement

We and the Advisor have entered into a license agreement with THL Partners under which THL Partners has granted to us and the Advisor a non-exclusive, personal, revocable worldwide non-transferable license to use the trade name and service mark THL, which is a proprietary mark of THL Partners, for specified purposes in connection with our respective businesses. This license agreement is royalty-free, which means we are not charged a fee for our use of the trade name and service mark THL. The license agreement is terminable either in

 

97


Table of Contents

its entirety or with respect to us or the Advisor by THL Partners at any time in its sole discretion upon 60 days prior written notice, and is also terminable with respect to either us or the Advisor by THL Partners in the case of certain events of non-compliance. After the expiration of its first one year term, the entire license agreement is terminable by either us or the Advisor at our or its sole discretion upon 60 days prior written notice. Upon termination of the license agreement, we and the Advisor must cease to use the name and mark THL, including any use in our respective legal names, filings, listings and other uses that may require us to withdraw or replace our names and marks. Other than with respect to the limited rights contained in the license agreement, we and the Advisor have no right to use, or other rights in respect of, the THL name and mark. We are an entity operated independently from THL Partners, and third parties who deal with us have no recourse against THL Partners.

Due to and from Affiliates

The Advisor paid certain other general and administrative expenses on our behalf. There were no amounts due to affiliate as of December 31, 2014. As of December 31, 2013, $0.01 million of expenses were included in due to affiliate on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, we overpaid $0.1 million and $0 of Administrator expense to the Advisor, respectively, which was included in due from affiliate on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.

We act as the investment adviser to Greenway and Greenway II and are entitled to receive certain fees. As a result, each of Greenway and Greenway II is classified as an affiliate. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, $1.0 million and $1.0 million of fees related to Greenway and Greenway II, respectively, were included in due from affiliate on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, $0.0 million and $0.5 million was included in due to affiliate on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities related to the portion of the escrow receivable, due to THL Corporate Finance, Inc., as the administrative agent, to Greenway.

We paid certain professional fees related to organizing Logan JV, on behalf of Logan JV. As of December 31, 2014, $0.04 million of expenses were included in due to affiliate on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.

Critical accounting policies

Our discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations are based upon our consolidated financial statements, which have been prepared in accordance with GAAP. The preparation of these consolidated financial statements requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses. Changes in the economic environment, financial markets and any other parameters used in determining such estimates could cause actual results to differ. In addition to the discussion below, the Company’s significant accounting policies are further described in the notes to the consolidated financial statements.

Valuation of Portfolio Investments

As a BDC, we generally invest in illiquid securities including debt and equity investments of middle market companies. Investments for which market quotations are readily available are valued using market quotations, which are generally obtained from an independent pricing service or one or more broker-dealers or market makers. Debt and equity securities for which market quotations are not readily available or are not considered to be the best estimate of fair value are valued at fair value as determined in good faith by our board of directors. Because we expect that there will not be a readily available market value for many of the investments in our portfolio, it is expected that many of our portfolio investments’ values will be determined in good faith by our board of directors in accordance with a documented valuation policy that has been reviewed and approved by our board of directors in accordance with GAAP. Due to the inherent uncertainty of determining the fair value of investments that do not have a readily available market value, the fair value of our investments may differ significantly from the values that would have been used had a readily available market value existed for such investments, and the differences could be material.

 

98


Table of Contents

With respect to investments for which market quotations are not readily available, our board of directors undertakes a multi-step valuation process each quarter, as described below:

 

   

our quarterly valuation process begins with each portfolio company or investment being initially valued by the investment professionals responsible for the portfolio investment;

 

   

preliminary valuation conclusions are then documented and discussed with senior management of the Advisor;

 

   

to the extent determined by the audit committee of our board of directors, independent valuation firms used by us to conduct independent appraisals and review the Advisor’s preliminary valuations in light of their own independent assessment;

 

   

the audit committee of our board of directors reviews the preliminary valuations of the Advisor and independent valuation firms and, if necessary, responds and supplements the valuation recommendation of the independent valuation firms to reflect any comments; and

 

   

our board of directors discusses valuations and determines the fair value of each investment in our portfolio in good faith based on the input of the Advisor, the respective independent valuation firms and the audit committee.

The types of factors that we may take into account in fair value pricing our investments include, as relevant, the nature and realizable value of any collateral, the portfolio company’s ability to make payments and its earnings and discounted cash flows, the markets in which the portfolio company does business, comparison to publicly traded securities and other relevant factors. We utilize an income approach to value our debt investments and a combination of income and market approaches to value our equity investments. With respect to unquoted securities, the Advisor and our board of directors, in consultation with our independent third party valuation firms, values each investment considering, among other measures, discounted cash flow models, comparisons of financial ratios of peer companies that are public and other factors, which valuation is then approved by our board of directors. For debt investments, we determine the fair value primarily using an income, or yield, approach that analyzes the discounted cash flows of interest and principal for the debt security, as set forth in the associated loan agreements, as well as the financial position and credit risk of each portfolio investments. Our estimate of the expected repayment date is generally the legal maturity date of the instrument. The yield analysis considers changes in leverage levels, credit quality, portfolio company performance and other factors.

We value our interest rate derivative agreement using an income approach that analyzes the discounted cash flows associated with the interest rate derivative agreement. Significant inputs to the discounted cash flows methodology include the forward interest rate yield curves in effect as of the end of the measurement period and an evaluation of the counterparty’s credit risk.

We value our residual interest investments in collateralized loan obligations using an income approach that analyzes the discounted cash flows of our residual interest. The discounted cash flows model utilizes prepayment, re-investment and loss assumptions based on historical experience and projected performance, economic factors, the characteristics of the underlying cash flow, and comparable yields for similar collateralized loan obligation fund subordinated notes or equity, when available. Specifically, we use Intex cash flow models, or an appropriate substitute to form the basis for the valuation of our residual interest. The models use a set of assumptions including projected default rates, recovery rates, reinvestment rate and prepayment rates in order to arrive at estimated cash flows. The assumptions are based on available market data and projections provided by third parties as well as management estimates.

We value our investment in payment rights using an income approach that analyzes the discounted projected future cash flow streams assuming an appropriate discount rate, which will among other things consider other transactions in the market, the current credit environment, performance of the underlying portfolio company and the length of the remaining payment stream.

 

99


Table of Contents

The market approach uses prices and other relevant information generated by market transactions involving identical or comparable assets or liabilities (including a business). The income approach uses valuation techniques to convert future cash flows or earnings to a single present amount (discounted). The measurement is based on the value indicated by current market expectations about those future amounts. In following these approaches, the types of factors that we may take into account in fair value pricing our investments include, as relevant: available current market data, including relevant and applicable market trading and transaction comparables, applicable market yields and multiples, the current investment performance rating, security covenants, call protection provisions, information rights, the nature and realizable value of any collateral, the portfolio company’s ability to make payments, its earnings and discounted cash flows, the markets in which the portfolio company does business, comparisons of financial ratios of peer companies that are public, transaction comparables, our principal market as the reporting entity and enterprise values, among other factors.

In accordance with the authoritative guidance on fair value measurements and disclosures under GAAP, we disclose the fair value of our investments in a hierarchy that prioritizes the inputs to valuation techniques used to measure fair value. The hierarchy gives the highest priority to unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities (Level 1 measurements) and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs (Level 3 measurements). The guidance establishes three levels of the fair value hierarchy as follows:

Level 1 – Unadjusted quoted prices in active markets that are accessible at the measurement date for identical, unrestricted assets or liabilities;

Level 2 – Quoted prices in markets that are not considered to be active or financial instruments for which significant inputs are observable, either directly or indirectly;

Level 3 – Prices or valuations that require inputs that are both significant to the fair value measurement and unobservable.

The level of an asset or liability within the fair value hierarchy is based on the lowest level of any input that is significant to the fair value measurement. However, the determination of what constitutes “observable” requires significant judgment by management.

We consider whether the volume and level of activity for the asset or liability have significantly decreased and identifies transactions that are not orderly in determining fair value. Accordingly, if we determine that either the volume and/or level of activity for an asset or liability has significantly decreased (from normal conditions for that asset or liability) or price quotations or observable inputs are not associated with orderly transactions, increased analysis and management judgment will be required to estimate fair value. Valuation techniques such as an income approach might be appropriate to supplement or replace a market approach in those circumstances.

We have adopted the authoritative guidance under GAAP for estimating the fair value of investments in investment companies that have calculated net asset value per share in accordance with the specialized accounting guidance for Investment Companies. Accordingly, in circumstances in which net asset value per share of an investment is determinative of fair value, we estimate the fair value of an investment in an investment company using the net asset value per share of the investment (or its equivalent) without further adjustment if the net asset value per share of the investment is determined in accordance with the specialized accounting guidance for investment companies as of the reporting entity’s measurement date.

Revenue Recognition

We record interest income, adjusted for amortization of premium and accretion of discount, on an accrual basis to the extent that we expect to collect such amounts. Dividend income is recognized on the ex-dividend date. Original issue discount, principally representing the estimated fair value of detachable equity or warrants obtained in conjunction with the acquisition of debt securities, and market discount or premium are capitalized

 

100


Table of Contents

and accreted or amortized into interest income over the life of the respective security using the effective yield method. The amortized cost of investments represents the original cost adjusted for the accretion/amortization of discounts and premiums and upfront loan origination fees.

Loans are placed on non-accrual status when principal or interest payments are past due 30 days or more and/or when it is no longer probable that principal or interest will be collected. However, we may make exceptions to this policy if the loan has sufficient collateral value and is in the process of collection. We record the reversal of any previously accrued income against the same income category reflected in the Consolidated Statement of Operations. As of December 31, 2014, we had no loans on non-accrual status. As of December 31, 2013, we had two loans on non-accrual with an amortized cost basis of $21.0 million and fair value of $16.8 million.

We have investments in our portfolio which contain a contractual paid-in-kind, or PIK, interest provision. PIK interest is computed at the contractual rate specified in each investment agreement, is added to the principal balance of the investment, and is recorded as income. We will cease accruing PIK interest if there is insufficient value to support the accrual or if we do not expect amounts to be collectible and will generally only begin to recognize PIK income again when all principal and interest have been paid or upon a restructuring of the investment where the interest is deemed collectable. To maintain our status as a RIC, PIK interest income, which is considered investment company taxable income, must be paid out to stockholders in the form of dividends even though we have not yet collected the cash. Amounts necessary to pay these dividends may come from available cash.

We capitalize and amortize upfront loan origination fees received in connection with the closing of investments. The unearned income from such fees is accreted into interest income over the contractual life of the loan based on the effective interest method. Upon prepayment of a loan or debt security, any prepayment premiums, unamortized upfront loan origination fees, and unamortized discounts are recorded as interest income.

Interest income from our investment in TRA and CLO residual interest investments are recorded based upon an estimation of an effective yield to expected maturity using anticipated cash flows with any remaining amount recorded to the cost basis of the investment. We monitor the anticipated cash flows from our TRA and CLO residual interest investments and will adjust our effective yield periodically as needed.

Other income includes commitment fees, fees related to the management of Greenway and Greenway II, fees related to the management of certain controlled equity investments, structuring fees, amendment fees and unused commitment fees associated with investments in portfolio companies. These fees are recognized as income when earned by us in accordance with the terms of the applicable management or credit agreement.

Net Realized Gains or Losses and Net Change in Unrealized Appreciation or Depreciation

We measure realized gains or losses by the difference between the net proceeds from the repayment or sale and the amortized cost basis of the investment, using the specific identification method, without regard to unrealized appreciation or depreciation previously recognized. We measure realized gains or losses on the interest rate derivative based upon the difference between the proceeds received or the amounts paid on the interest rate derivative. Net change in unrealized appreciation or depreciation reflects the change in portfolio investment values or value of the interest rate derivative during the reporting period, including any reversal of previously recorded unrealized appreciation or depreciation, when gains or losses are realized.

Federal Income Taxes, including excise tax

We operate so as to maintain our status as a RIC under Subchapter M of the Code and intend to continue to do so. Accordingly, we are not subject to federal income tax on the portion of our taxable income and gains distributed to stockholders. In order to qualify for favorable tax treatment as a RIC, we are required to distribute annually to our stockholders at least 90% of our investment company taxable income, as defined by the Code. To

 

101


Table of Contents

avoid a 4% federal excise tax, we must distribute each calendar year the sum of (i) 98% of our ordinary income for each such calendar year (ii) 98.2% of our net capital gains for the one-year period ending October 31 of that calendar year, and (iii) any income recognized, but not distributed, in preceding years and on which we paid no federal income tax. We may choose not to distribute all of our taxable income for the calendar year and pay a non-deductible 4% excise tax on this income. If we choose to do so, all other things being equal, this would increase expenses and reduce the amount available to be distributed to stockholders. To the extent that the Company determines that its estimated current year annual taxable income will be in excess of estimated current year dividend distributions from such taxable income, the Company accrues excise taxes on estimated excess taxable income as taxable income is earned using an annual effective excise tax rate. We will accrue excise tax on undistributed taxable income as required. Please refer to “Dividends” above for a summary of the distributions. For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, we incurred excise tax expense of $0.3 million, $0.2 million, and $0.1 million, respectively.

Certain consolidated subsidiaries are subject to U.S. federal and state income taxes. These taxable entities are not consolidated for income tax purposes and may generate income tax liabilities or assets from permanent and temporary differences in the recognition of items for financial reporting and income tax purposes at the subsidiaries.

The following shows the breakdown of current and deferred income tax provisions for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 (in millions):

 

     For the years ended December 31,  
         2014              2013              2012      

Current income tax provision:

        

Current income tax provision

   $ 0.7       $ 0.3       $ 0.5   

Current provision for taxes on realized gain on investments

     0.2         —           —     

Deferred income tax provision:

        

Provision for taxes on unrealized gain on investments

     0.2         2.0         0.5   

These current and deferred income taxes are determined from taxable income estimates provided by portfolio companies where we hold equity or equity-like investments organized as pass-through entities in its tax blocker corporations. These tax estimates may be subject to further change once tax information is finalized for the year. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $0.2 million and $0.4 million, respectively, of income tax receivable was included in prepaid expenses and other assets and $0.0 and $0.1 million, respectively, was included as income taxes payable on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $2.6 million and $2.4 million, respectively, were included in deferred tax liability on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities primarily relating to deferred taxes on unrealized gains on investments held in tax blocker corporations. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $0.3 million and $0.0 million, respectively of deferred tax assets were included in prepaid expenses and other assets on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities relating to net operating loss carryforwards that are expected to be used in future periods.

Because federal income tax regulations differ from GAAP, distributions in accordance with tax regulations may differ from net investment income and realized gains recognized for financial reporting purposes. Differences may be permanent or temporary. Permanent differences are reclassified among capital accounts in the consolidated financial statements to reflect their tax character. Temporary differences arise when certain items of income, expense, gain or loss are recognized at some time in the future. Differences in classification may also result from the treatment of short-term gains as ordinary income for tax purposes.

We follow the provisions under the authoritative guidance on accounting for and disclosure of uncertainty in tax positions. The provisions require us to determine whether a tax position is more likely than not to be sustained upon examination, including resolution of any related appeals or litigation processes, based on the

 

102


Table of Contents

technical merits of the position. For tax positions not meeting the more likely than not threshold, the tax amount recognized in the consolidated financial statements is reduced by the largest benefit that has a greater than fifty percent likelihood of being realized upon ultimate settlement with the relevant taxing authority. There are no unrecognized tax benefits or obligations in the accompanying consolidated financial statements. Although we file federal and state tax returns, our major tax jurisdiction is federal. Our inception-to-date federal tax years remain subject to examination by taxing authorities.

Recent Developments

From January 1, 2015 through March 10, 2015, we made follow-on investments totaling $15.3 million in the industrials, transportation and financial services industries. Of the follow-on investments, 47.9% were floating rate first lien secured debt investments and 52.1% were an investment in funds. The follow-on debt investments had a weighted average yield based upon cost at the time of the investment of 10.4%.

From January 1, 2015 through March 10, 2015, THL Credit sold $10.0 million of a first lien secured term loan in Charming Charlie, LLC and $3.0 million of a second lien term loan in BBB Industries and recognized a nominal gain.

On February 12, 2015, we received proceeds of $16.9 million from the prepayment of a subordinated term loan in The Studer Group, LLC at par.

On February 24, 2015, we received proceeds of $16.2 million from the prepayment of a subordinated term loan in Country Pure Foods, LLC at par.

On March 6, 2015, our investment management agreement was re-approved by the Company’s board of directors.

On March 6, 2015, our board of directors declared a dividend of $0.34 per share payable on March 31, 2015 to stockholders of record at the close of business on March 20, 2015.

On March 6, 2015, our board of directors authorized a $25.0 million stock repurchase program. The timing and amount of any stock repurchases will depend on the terms and conditions of the repurchase program and no assurances can be given that any common stock, or any particular amount, will be purchased. We will provide our stockholders with notice of our intention to repurchase shares of our common stock in accordance with 1940 Act requirements. Unless extended by our board of directors, the stock repurchase program will terminate on March 6, 2016 and may be modified or terminated at any time for any reason without prior notice.

On March 6, 2015, upon the recommendation of the Governance Committee, our Board of Directors approved the appointment of Sam W. Tillinghast and Christopher J. Flynn as directors of the Company, with immediate effect. See Item 9B, Other Information for additional detail.

As of March 10, 2015, Logan JV has $49.9 million of investments in 37 companies with a weighted average yield, based upon cost at the time of the investment, of 7.0%.

 

103


Table of Contents
Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

We are subject to financial market risks, including changes in interest rates. As of December 31, 2014, 27.8%, of the debt investments in our portfolio bore interest at fixed rates based upon fair value. All of the debt investments in our portfolio have interest rate floors, which have effectively converted the debt investments to fixed rate loans in the current interest rate environment. In the future, we expect other debt investments in our portfolio will have floating rates. Our borrowings as well as the amount we receive under the interest rate derivative agreement are based upon floating rates.

Based on our December 31, 2014 Consolidated Statement of Assets and Liabilities, the following table shows the annual impact on net income of changes in interest rates, which assumes no changes in our investments and borrowings (in millions):

 

Change in Basis Points

   Interest
Income
     Interest
Expense
     Net
Income  (1)
 

Up 300 basis points

   $ 10.1       $ 7.3       $ 2.8   

Up 200 basis points

   $ 5.3       $ 4.9       $ 0.4   

Up 100 basis points

   $ 0.7       $ 2.4       $ (1.7

Down 300 basis points

   $ —         $ —         $ —     

Down 200 basis points

   $ —         $ —         $ —     

Down 100 basis points

   $ —         $ —         $ —     

 

1) 

Excludes the impact of incentive fees based on pre-incentive fee net investment income. See “Note 3. Related Party Transaction” footnote to our consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2014 for more information on the incentive fee.

Based upon the current three month LIBOR rate, a hypothetical decrease in LIBOR would not affect our net income, due to the aforementioned floors in place on our debt investments. Based upon the current one month LIBOR rates, a hypothetical decrease in LIBOR would not affect interest expense, due to the current rates being lower than 100 basis points. We currently hedge against interest rate fluctuations by using an interest rate swap whereby we pay a fixed rate of 1.1425% and receive three-month LIBOR on a notional amount of $50 million. In the future, we may use other standard hedging instruments such as futures, options and forward contacts subject to the requirements of the 1940 Act. While hedging activities may insulate us against adverse changes in interest rates, they may also limit our ability to participate in the benefits of lower interest rates with respect to our portfolio of investments.

Although we believe that this measure is indicative of our sensitivity to interest rate changes, it does not adjust for potential changes in credit quality, size and composition of the assets on the balance sheet and other business developments that could affect net increase in net assets resulting from operations, or net income.

 

104


Table of Contents
Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

Index to Financial Statements

 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     106   

Consolidated Statements of Assets & Liabilities as of December 31, 2014 and 2013

     107   

Consolidated Statements of Operations for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012

     108   

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Net Assets for the years ended December  31, 2014, 2013 and 2012

     109   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012

     110   

Consolidated Schedule of Investments as of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013

     111   

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

     123   

 

105


Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To The Board of Directors and Stockholders of

THL Credit, Inc.:

In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated statements of assets and liabilities, including the consolidated schedules of investments, and the related consolidated statements of operations, of changes in net assets, and of cash flows present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of THL Credit, Inc. and its subsidiaries (together the “Company”) at December 31, 2014 and 2013, and the results of their operations, their changes in net assets, and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2014 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. In addition, in our opinion, the financial statement schedule appearing under Item 15(2) presents fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein when read in conjunction with the related consolidated financial statements. Also in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Company’s management is responsible for these financial statements and financial statement schedule, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting appearing under Item 9A. Our responsibility is to express opinions on these financial statements, on the financial statement schedule, and on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our integrated audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audits of the financial statements included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits, which included confirmation of securities at December 31, 2014 by correspondence with the issuer, the custodian, transfer agent or broker, and the application of alternative auditing procedures where replies had not been received, provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP

Boston, Massachusetts

March 10, 2015

 

106


Table of Contents

THL Credit, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities

(in thousands, except per share data)

 

     December 31, 2014     December 31, 2013  

Assets:

    

Investments at fair value:

    

Non-controlled, non-affiliated investments (cost of $726,811 and $645,911, respectively)

   $ 732,862      $ 648,860   

Controlled investments (cost of $52,208 and $0, respectively)

     51,349        —     

Non-controlled, affiliated investments (cost of $9 and $7, respectively)

     9        7   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total investments at fair value (cost of $779,028 and $645,918, respectively)

   $ 784,220      $ 648,867   

Cash

     2,656        7,829   

Receivable for investments sold

     9,538        —     

Deferred financing costs

     7,021        4,604   

Interest receivable

     6,221        7,225   

Due from affiliate

     1,216        1,025   

Prepaid expenses and other assets

     684        441   

Other deferred assets

     600        825   

Receivable for paydown of investments

     329        275   

Escrow receivable

     —          1,800   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 812,485      $ 672,891   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities:

    

Loans payable

   $ 294,851      $ 204,300   

Notes payable

     50,000        —     

Payable for investment purchased

     10,400        4,400   

Accrued incentive fees

     4,175        3,421   

Base management fees payable

     2,810        2,243   

Deferred tax liability

     2,565        2,414   

Accrued expenses

     1,856        1,617   

Other deferred liabilities

     1,418        —     

Accrued credit facility fees and interest

     576        567   

Interest rate derivative

     213        284   

Due to affiliate

     —          474   

Accrued administrator expenses

     —          158   

Income taxes payable

     —          71   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     368,864        219,949   

Commitments and contingencies (Note 9)

    

Net Assets:

    

Preferred stock, par value $.001 per share, 100,000 preferred shares authorized, no preferred shares issued and outstanding

     —          —     

Common stock, par value $.001 per share, 100,000 common shares authorized, 33,905 shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively

     34        34   

Paid-in capital in excess of par

     448,726        450,043   

Net unrealized appreciation on investments, net of provision for taxes of $2,565 and $2,414, respectively

     2,627        535   

Net unrealized depreciation on interest rate derivative

     (213     (284

Accumulated undistributed net realized (losses) gains

     (13,360     2,023   

Accumulated undistributed net investment income

     5,807        591   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net assets

     443,621        452,942   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and net assets

   $ 812,485      $ 672,891   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net asset value per share

   $ 13.08      $ 13.36   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements.

 

107


Table of Contents

THL Credit, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Operations

(in thousands, except per share data)

 

     For the years ended December 31,  
     2014     2013     2012  

Investment Income:

      

From non-controlled, non-affiliated investments:

      

Interest income

   $ 83,155      $ 66,787      $ 49,808   

Dividend income

     3,125        4,074        456   

Other income

     1,891        790        269   

From non-controlled, affiliated investments:

      

Other income

     2,997        2,999        2,592   

From controlled investments:

      

Interest income

     610        —          —     

Other income

     150        —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total investment income

     91,928        74,650        53,125   

Expenses:

      

Incentive fees

     11,184        10,682        7,017   

Base management fees

     11,142        7,521        4,943   

Credit facility interest and fees

     9,781        5,623        3,138   

Administrator expenses

     3,780        3,608        3,225   

Other general and administrative expenses

     2,738        1,977        1,344   

Professional fees

     2,096        1,288        1,200   

Amortization of deferred financing costs

     1,351        1,470        968   

Directors’ fees

     626        581        517   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

     42,698        32,750        22,352   

Income tax provision and excise tax

     1,040        511        581   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net investment income

     48,190        41,389        30,192   

Realized Gain (Loss) and Change in Unrealized Appreciation on Investments:

      

Net realized (loss) gain on non-controlled, non-affiliated investments

     (12,855     2,604        353   

Net change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation) on investments:

      

Non-controlled, non-affiliated investments

     3,102        309        (1,240

Controlled, non-affiliated investments

     (859     —          —     

Non-controlled, affiliated investments

     —          —          (1
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net change in unrealized appreciation on investments

     2,243        309        (1,241
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net realized and unrealized (loss) gain from investments

     (10,612     2,913        (888

Provision for taxes on realized gain on investments

     (249     —          —     

Provision for taxes on unrealized gain on investments

     (151     (1,960     (454

Interest rate derivative periodic interest payments, net

     (458     (433     (180

Net change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation) on interest rate derivative

     71        769        (1,053
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase in net assets resulting from operations

   $ 36,791      $ 42,678      $ 27,617   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net investment income per common share:

      

Basic and diluted

   $ 1.42      $ 1.37      $ 1.38   

Net increase in net assets resulting from operations per common share:

      

Basic and diluted

   $ 1.08      $ 1.41      $ 1.26   

Weighted average shares of common stock outstanding:

      

Basic and diluted

     33,905        30,287        21,852   

See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements.

 

108


Table of Contents

THL Credit, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Net Assets

(in thousands, except per share data)

 

     For the years ended December 31,  
     2014     2013     2012  

Increase in net assets from operations:

      

Net investment income

   $ 48,190      $ 41,389      $ 30,192   

Interest rate derivative periodic interest payments, net

     (458     (433     (180

Net realized (loss) gain on investments

     (12,855     2,604        353   

Income tax provision, realized gain

     (249     —          —     

Net change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation) on investments

     2,243        309        (1,241

Provision for taxes on unrealized gain on investments

     (151     (1,960     (454

Net change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation) on interest rate derivative

     71        769        (1,053
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase in net assets resulting from operations

     36,791        42,678        27,617   

Distributions to stockholders

      

Distributions to stockholders from net investment income

     (44,191     (42,999     (28,493

Distributions to stockholders from net realized gain

     (1,921     (400     (918
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total distributions to stockholders

     (46,112     (43,399     (29,411

Capital share transactions:

      

Issuance of common stock

     —          110,966        85,879   

Less offering costs

     —          (4,787     (4,218
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase in net assets from capital share transactions

     —          106,179        81,661   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total (decrease) increase in net assets

     (9,321     105,458        79,867   

Net assets at beginning of year

     452,942        347,484        267,617   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net assets at end of year

   $ 443,621      $ 452,942      $ 347,484   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Common shares outstanding at end of year

     33,905        33,905        26,315   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Capital share activity:

      

Shares sold

     —          7,590        6,095   

 

See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements

 

109


Table of Contents

THL Credit, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(in thousands)

 

     For the years ended December 31,  
     2014     2013     2012  

Cash flows from operating activities

      

Net increase in net assets resulting from operations

   $ 36,791      $ 42,678      $ 27,617   

Adjustments to reconcile net increase in net assets resulting from operations to net cash used for operating activities:

      

Net change in unrealized (depreciation) appreciation on investments

     (2,243     (309     1,241   

Net change in unrealized depreciation (appreciation) on interest rate derivative

     (71     (769     1,053   

Net realized loss on investments

     12,874        —          —     

Increase in investments due to PIK

     (2,309     (3,250     (4,027

Amortization of deferred financing costs

     1,351        1,470        968   

Accretion of discounts on investments and other fees

     (4,795     (4,397     (3,615

Changes in operating assets and liabilities:

      

Purchases of investments, net of payable for investment purchased

     (352,970     (411,135     (298,493

Proceeds from sale and paydown of investments, net of receivable for investments sold

     210,500        168,824        177,671   

Decrease (increase) in interest receivable

     1,004        (4,631     (1,154

Decrease (increase) in escrow receivable

     1,800        (1,800     —     

Decrease (increase) in other deferred expenses

     225        (825     —     

Increase (decrease) in due from affiliate

     (191     (605     91   

Increase (decrease) in prepaid expenses and other assets

     (243     (307     108   

Increase in accrued expenses

     168        878        216   

Increase in accrued credit facility fees and interest

     9        452        110   

(Decrease) increase in income taxes payable

     (71     71        —     

Increase in deferred tax liability

     151        1,960        454   

Increase in base management fees payable

     567        729        501   

Decrease in accrued administrator expenses

     (158     (146     (34

Increase in other deferred liabilities

     1,418        —          —     

Increase in accrued incentive fees payable

     754        142        589   

(Decrease) increase in due to affiliate

     (474     474        (21

Increase in dividend payable

     —          —          1,316   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in operating activities

     (95,913     (210,496     (95,409

Cash flows from financing activities

      

Borrowings under credit facility

     334,800        453,700        189,900   

Repayments under credit facility

     (244,249     (299,400     (144,900

Issuance of notes

     50,000        —          —     

Issuance of shares of common stock

     —          110,966        85,879   

Distributions paid to stockholders

     (46,112     (44,715     (29,411

Financing and offering costs paid

     (3,699     (7,045     (6,813
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by financing activities

     90,740        213,506        94,655   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net (decrease) increase in cash

     (5,173     3,010        (754

Cash, beginning of year

     7,829        4,819        5,573   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash, end of year

   $ 2,656      $ 7,829      $ 4,819   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Supplemental Disclosure of Cash Flow Information:

      

Cash interest paid

   $ 7,937      $ 3,770      $ 1,499   

Income taxes paid

   $ 1,076      $ 646      $ 457   

PIK income earned

   $ 2,316      $ 3,179      $ 4,124   

Non-cash Operating Activities:

For the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company converted the cost basis of a subordinated note, certain interest due and warrants of C&K Markets, Inc. totaling $14,272 to common and preferred equity. In connection with the extinguishment and conversion to equity, the Company recognized a realized loss of $1,000.

For the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company converted the cost basis of a subordinated note of Wingspan Portfolio Holdings, Inc. as part of a restructuring of the business totaling $18,447 to the common equity of an affiliate, Dimont & Associates, Inc. In connection with the extinguishment and conversion to equity, the Company recognized a realized loss of $11,878.

See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements

 

110


Table of Contents

THL Credit, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Schedule of Investments

December 31, 2014

(dollar amounts in thousands)

 

Type of Investment/
Portfolio company(1)(2)

  Industry   Interest Rate(3)   Initial
Acquisition
Date
  Maturity/
Dissolution
Date
  Principal(4)
No.  of Shares /

    No. of Units    
    Amortized
Cost
    Fair Value  

Non-controlled/non-affiliated investments—170.46% of net asset value

             

First lien secured debt

             

20-20 Technologies Inc.(5)

  IT services   10.8%(6)   9/12/2012   3/31/2019   $ 31,600      $ 31,275      $ 31,600   

Airborne Tactical Advantage Company, LLC

  Aerospace &
defense
  11.0%   9/7/2011   3/7/2016     4,000        3,939        3,980   

Airborne Tactical Advantage Company, LLC

  Aerospace &
defense
  11.0%   6/24/2014   3/7/2016     2,600        2,563        2,587   

Allied Wireline Services, LLC

  Energy /
Utilities
  9.5% (LIBOR

+ 8.0%)

  2/28/2014   2/28/2019     9,928        9,524        9,630   

BeneSys Inc.

  Business
services
  10.8% (LIBOR

+ 9.8%)

  3/31/2014   3/31/2019     8,611        8,457        8,525   

BeneSys Inc.(7)(8)

  Business
services
  10.8% (LIBOR
+ 9.8%)
  8/1/2014   3/31/2019     —          (10     —     

Charming Charlie, LLC.

  Retail &
grocery
  9.0% (LIBOR
+ 8.0%)
  12/18/2013   12/31/2019     26,798        26,446        26,459   

Copperweld Bimetallics LLC

  Industrials   12.0%   12/11/2013   12/11/2018     20,625        19,934        20,212   

CRS Reprocessing, LLC

  Manufacturing   10.5% (LIBOR
+ 9.5%)
  6/16/2011   6/16/2015     15,461        15,447        14,687   

Dodge Data & Analytics LLC

  IT services   9.8% (LIBOR
+ 8.8%)
  11/20/2014   10/31/2019     13,000        12,745        12,745   

Duff & Phelps Corporation(9)

  Financial
services
  4.5% (LIBOR
+ 3.5%)
  5/15/2013   4/23/2020     246        249        244   

Embarcadero Technologies, Inc.

  IT services   10.7%(6)   2/15/2013   12/28/2017     9,300        9,208        9,300   

Food Processing Holdings, LLC

  Food &
beverage
  10.5% (LIBOR
+9.5%)
  10/31/2013   10/31/2018     22,202        21,842        22,202   

Harrison Gypsum, LLC

  Industrials   10.0% (LIBOR
+ 8.5% and 0.5%
PIK)(10)
  12/21/2012   12/21/2017     25,963        25,699        25,444   

Hart InterCivic, Inc.

  IT services   12.3% (LIBOR
+ 9.8% Cash +
1.0% PIK)
  7/1/2011   7/1/2016     8,556        8,496        8,342   

Hart InterCivic, Inc.(7)

  IT services   11.3% (LIBOR
+ 9.8% Cash)
  7/1/2011   7/1/2016     3,000        2,982        3,000   

HEALTHCAREfirst, Inc.

  Healthcare   13.6%(6)   8/31/2012   8/30/2017     8,558        8,403        8,173   

Holland Intermediate Acquisition Corp.

  Energy /
Utilities
  10.0% (LIBOR
+ 9.0%)
  5/29/2013   5/29/2018     24,227        23,841        23,500   

Holland Intermediate Acquisition Corp.(7)

  Energy /
Utilities
  10.0% (LIBOR
+ 9.0%)
  5/29/2013   5/29/2018     —          —          —     

Igloo Products Corp.

  Consumer
products
  11.3% (LIBOR
+ 9.8%)
  3/28/2014   3/28/2020     38,286        37,479        37,425   

Ingenio Acquisition, LLC

  Media,
entertainment
and leisure
  11.3% (10.3%
Cash + 1.0%
PIK)
  5/9/2013   3/14/2019     9,108        8,971        9,108   

 

(Continued on next page)

See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements

 

111


Table of Contents

THL Credit, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Schedule of Investments—(Continued)

December 31, 2014

(dollar amounts in thousands)

 

Type of Investment/
Portfolio company(1)(2)

  Industry   Interest Rate(3)   Initial
Acquisition
Date
  Maturity/
Dissolution
Date
  Principal(4)
No.  of Shares /

    No. of Units    
    Amortized
Cost
    Fair Value  

Key Brand Entertainment, Inc.

  Media,
entertainment
and leisure
  9.8% (LIBOR
+ 8.5%)
  8/8/2013   8/8/2018     12,849        12,651        12,849   

Key Brand Entertainment, Inc.

  Media,
entertainment
and leisure
  12.5% (LIBOR
+ 11.3%)
  5/29/2014   8/8/2018     2,874        2,823        2,874   

Key Brand Entertainment, Inc.(7)(8)

  Media,
entertainment
and leisure
  9.8% (LIBOR
+ 8.5%)
  8/8/2013   8/8/2018     —          (21     —     

Key Brand Entertainment, Inc.(8)

  Media,
entertainment
and leisure
  12.5% (LIBOR
+ 11.3%)
  5/29/2014   8/8/2018     —          (54     —     

LAI International, Inc.

  Manufacturing   10.1%(6)   10/22/2014   10/22/2019     19,308        18,899        18,899   

LAI International, Inc.

  Manufacturing   10.1%(6)   10/22/2014   10/22/2019     —          —          —     

Loadmaster Derrick & Equipment, Inc.

  Energy /
Utilities
  9.3% (LIBOR
+ 8.3%)
  9/28/2012   9/28/2017     8,828        8,686        7,990   

Loadmaster Derrick & Equipment, Inc.(7) 

  Energy /
Utilities
  9.3% (LIBOR
+ 8.3%)
  9/28/2012   9/28/2017     4,000        4,000        3,620   

Loadmaster Derrick & Equipment, Inc.(7)

  Energy /
Utilities
  9.3% (LIBOR
+ 8.3%)
  7/16/2014   9/28/2017     3,500        3,439        3,168   

OEM Group, Inc.

  Manufacturing   15.0% (12.5%
Cash + 2.5%
PIK)(10)
  10/7/2010   10/7/2015     26,597        26,376        24,735   

OEM Group, Inc.

  Manufacturing   15.0% (12.5%
Cash + 2.5%
PIK)(10)
  6/6/2014   10/7/2015     3,044        3,036        2,892   

Virtus Pharmaceuticals, LLC

  Healthcare   10.7%(6)   7/17/2014   7/17/2019     20,124        19,667        19,822   

Wheels Up Partners, LLC

  Transportation   9.6% (LIBOR
+ 8.6%)
  1/31/2014   10/15/2022     9,629        9,510        9,533   

Wheels Up Partners, LLC

  Transportation   9.6% (LIBOR
+ 8.6%)
  8/27/2014   7/15/2023     3,763        3,763        3,726   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
      Subtotal first lien secured debt   $ 396,753      $ 390,265      $ 387,271   

Second lien debt

             

Aerogroup International Inc.

  Consumer
products
  9.0% (LIBOR
+ 8.0%)
  6/9/2014   12/9/2019   $ 13,648      $ 13,397      $ 13,102   

Aerogroup International Inc.(7)(8)

  Consumer
products
  9.0% (LIBOR
+ 8.0%)
  6/9/2014   12/9/2019     —          (45     —     

Alex Toys, LLC

  Consumer
products
  11.0% (LIBOR
+ 10.0%)
  6/30/2014   12/30/2019     17,000        16,683        16,683   

Allen Edmonds Corporation

  Consumer
products
  10.0% (LIBOR
+ 9.0%)
  11/26/2013   5/27/2019     7,333        7,210        7,223   

BBB Industries US Holding, Inc.

  Manufacturing   9.75% (LIBOR
+ 8.75%)
  10/7/2014   11/18/2022     7,500        7,059        7,144   

Connecture, Inc.

  Healthcare   12.0% (LIBOR
+ 11.0%)
  3/18/2013   7/15/2018     21,831        21,609        22,049   

Expert Global Solutions, Inc.

  Business
services
  12.5% (LIBOR
+ 10.3% and
0.8% PIK)(10)
  6/21/2013   10/3/2018     12,703        12,849        12,576   

 

(Continued on next page)

See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements

 

112


Table of Contents

THL Credit, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Schedule of Investments—(Continued)

December 31, 2014

(dollar amounts in thousands)

 

Type of Investment/
Portfolio company(1)(2)

  Industry   Interest Rate(3)   Initial
Acquisition
Date
  Maturity/
Dissolution
Date
  Principal(4)
No.  of Shares /

    No. of Units    
    Amortized
Cost
    Fair Value  

Expert Global Solutions, Inc.

  Business
services
  13.0% PIK   6/21/2013   10/3/2018     144        —          143   

Hostway Corporation

  IT services   10.0% (LIBOR
+ 8.8%)
  12/27/2013   12/13/2020     12,000        11,785        11,880   

Oasis Legal Finance Holding Company LLC

  Financial
services
  10.5%   9/30/2013   9/30/2018     13,246        13,035        13,312   

Sheplers, Inc.

  Retail &
grocery
  13.2% (LIBOR
+ 11.7%)
  12/20/2011   12/20/2016     11,426        11,292        11,426   

Specialty Brands Holdings, LLC

  Restaurants   11.3% (LIBOR +
9.8%)
  7/16/2013   7/16/2018     20,977        20,656        20,453   

Synarc-Biocore Holdings, LLC

  Healthcare   9.3% (LIBOR +
8.3%)
  3/13/2014   3/13/2022     11,000        10,898        10,010   

Vision Solutions, Inc.

  IT services   9.5% (LIBOR +
8.0%)
  3/31/2011   7/23/2017     11,625        11,577        11,509   

Washington Inventory Service

  Business
services
  10.3% (LIBOR +
9.0%)
  12/27/2012   6/20/2019     11,000        10,886        11,000   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
      Subtotal second lien secured debt       $ 171,433      $ 168,891      $ 168,510   

Subordinated debt

             

A10 Capital, LLC(7)

  Financial
services
  12.0%   8/25/2014   2/25/2021   $ 5,444      $ 5,391      $ 5,431   

Country Pure Foods, LLC

  Food &
beverage
  13.0%   8/13/2010   2/13/2017     16,181        16,181        16,181   

Dr. Fresh, LLC

  Consumer
products
  12.0% and 2.0%
PIK(10)
  5/15/2012   11/15/2017     14,743        14,565        14,448   

Gold, Inc.

  Consumer
products
  12.0%   12/31/2012   6/30/2019     16,788        16,788        16,620   

Martex Fiber Southern Corp.

  Industrials   12.0% and 1.5%
PIK(10)
  4/30/2012   10/31/2019     9,026        8,928        8,394   

Sheplers, Inc.

  Retail &
grocery
  17.0% (10.0%
Cash + 7.0%
PIK)(11)
  12/20/11   12/20/2017     2,040        2,020        2,040   

The Studer Group, L.L.C.

  Healthcare   12.0%   9/29/2011   1/31/2019     16,910        16,910        16,910   

Tri Starr Management Services, Inc.

  IT services   15.8% (12.5%
Cash + 3.3%
PIK)(10)
  3/4/2013   3/4/2019     18,918        18,637        16,080   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
      Subtotal subordinated debt   $ 100,050      $ 99,420      $ 96,104   

Equity investments(13)

             

A10 Capital, LLC(12)(14)(23)

  Financial
services
    8/25/2014       2,967      $ 9,837      $ 9,837   

Aerogroup International Inc.(24)

  Consumer
products
    6/9/2014       253,616        11        —     

Aerogroup International Inc.(25)

  Consumer
products
    6/9/2014       28,180        1,108        467   

AIM Media Texas Operating, LLC(12)(15)(24)

  Media,
entertainment
and leisure
    6/21/2012       0.763636        764        857   

 

(Continued on next page)

See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements

 

113


Table of Contents

THL Credit, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Schedule of Investments—(Continued)

December 31, 2014

(dollar amounts in thousands)

 

Type of Investment/
Portfolio company(1)(2)

  Industry   Interest Rate(3)   Initial
Acquisition
Date
  Maturity/
Dissolution
Date
  Principal(4)
No.  of Shares /

    No. of Units    
    Amortized
Cost
    Fair Value  

Airborne Tactical Advantage Company, LLC(24)

  Aerospace &
defense
    9/7/2011       511,812        113        9   

Airborne Tactical Advantage Company, LLC(23)

  Aerospace &
defense
    9/17/2013       225,000        169        204   

Allied Wireline Services, LLC(12)(15)(24)

  Energy /
Utilities
    2/28/2014       619        619        779   

Allied Wireline Services, LLC(12)(15)(24)

  Energy /
Utilities
    2/28/2014       501        175        302   

Firebirds International, LLC(24)

  Restaurants     5/17/2011       1,906        191        300   

Food Processing Holdings, LLC(24)

  Food &
beverage
    4/20/2010       162.44        163        226   

Food Processing Holdings, LLC(24)

  Food &
beverage
    4/20/2010       406.09        408        642   

Hostway Corporation(24)

  IT services     12/27/2013       20,000        200        —     

Hostway Corporation(24)

  IT services     12/27/2013       1,800        1,800        2,111   

Igloo Products Corp.(12) (24)

  Consumer
products
    4/30/2014       2,406        2,407        2,241   

OEM Group, Inc.(24)(25)

  Manufacturing     10/7/2010       —          —          —     

Surgery Center Holdings, Inc.(12)(24)

  Healthcare     4/20/2013       469,673        —          6,200   

Wheels Up Partners, LLC(12)(15)(24)

  Transportation     1/31/2014       1,000        1,000        1,000   

YP Equity Investors, LLC(12)(15)(24)

  Media,
entertainment
and leisure
    5/8/2012       —          —          4,000   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 
      Subtotal equity     $ 18,965      $ 29,175   

CLO residual interests

             

Adirondack Park CLO Ltd.(5)(16)

  Structured
Products
  12.8%   3/27/2013       —        $ 8,172      $ 8,216   

Dryden CLO, Ltd.(5)(16)

  Structured
Products
  13.8%   9/12/2013       —          8,040        8,244   

Flagship VII, Ltd.(5)(16)

  Structured
Products
  13.8%   12/18/2013       —          4,105        4,305   

Flagship VIII, Ltd.(5)(16)

  Structured
Products
  12.8%   10/3/2014       —          8,450        8,450   

Sheridan Square CLO, Ltd(5)(16)

  Structured
Products
  14.5%   3/12/2013       —          5,446        5,720   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 
      Subtotal CLO residual interests     $ 34,213      $ 34,935   

Investment in payment rights

             

Duff & Phelps Corporation(9)(16)

  Financial
services
  16.8%   6/1/2012       —        $ 11,877      $ 13,488   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 
      Subtotal investment in payment rights     $ 11,877      $ 13,488   

 

(Continued on next page)

See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements

 

114


Table of Contents

THL Credit, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Schedule of Investments—(Continued)

December 31, 2014

(dollar amounts in thousands)

 

Type of Investment/
Portfolio company(1)(2)

  Industry   Interest Rate(3)   Initial
Acquisition
Date
    Maturity/
Dissolution
Date
    Principal(4)
No.  of Shares /

    No. of Units    
    Amortized
Cost
    Fair Value  

Investments in funds(17)

             

Freeport Financial SBIC Fund LP

  Financial
services
      6/14/2013        $ 2,314      $ 2,314      $ 2,316   

Gryphon Partners 3.5, L.P.

  Financial
services
      11/20/2012          1,251        866        1,063   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
        Subtotal investments in funds      $ 3,565      $ 3,180      $ 3,379   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-controlled/non-affiliated investments —170.46% of net asset value

          $ 671,801      $ 726,811      $ 732,862   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Controlled investments —6.32% of net asset value

             

First lien secured debt

             

Thibaut, Inc(18)

  Consumer
products
  12.0%     6/19/2014        $ 6,520      $ 6,445      $ 6,520   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subtotal first lien secured debt

  

  $ 6,520      $ 6,445      $ 6,520   

Subordinated debt

             

Dimont & Associates, Inc.(18)(20)

  Financial
services
  11.0%

PIK

    10/20/2014        4/20/2018      $ 4,556      $ 4,473      $ 4,556   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subtotal subordinated debt

  

  $ 4,556      $ 4,473      $ 4,556   

Equity investments

             

C&K Market, Inc.(18)(19)(24)

  Retail &
grocery
      11/3/2010          1,967,367      $ 2,271      $ 6,036   

C&K Market, Inc.(18)(19)(23)

  Retail &
grocery
      11/3/2010          1,967,367        10,956        9,837   

Dimont & Associates, Inc.(18)(20)(24)

  Financial
services
      10/20/2014          50,004        6,569        2,000   

Thibaut, Inc(12)(13)(18)(21)(23)

  Consumer
products
      6/19/2014          4,747        4,694        4,874   

Thibaut, Inc(12)(13)(18)(24)

  Consumer
products
      6/19/2014          20,639        —          785   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subtotal equity

  

    $ 24,490      $ 23,532   

Investments in Logan JV

             

THL Credit Logan JV LLC(12)(18)(22)(24)

  Financial
services
      12/3/2014          —          16,800        16,741   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subtotal investments in funds

  

    $ 16,800      $ 16,741   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total controlled investments — 6.32% of net asset value

          $ 11,076      $ 52,208      $ 51,349   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(Continued on next page)

See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements

 

115


Table of Contents

THL Credit, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Schedule of Investments—(Continued)

December 31, 2014

(dollar amounts in thousands)

 

Type of Investment/Portfolio
company(1)(2)

  Industry   Interest  Rate(3)     Initial
Acquisition
Date
    Maturity/
Dissolution
Date
    Principal(4)
No.  of Shares /

    No. of Units    
    Amortized
Cost
    Fair Value  

Non-controlled/affiliated investments—0.00% of net asset value

             

Investments in funds

             

THL Credit Greenway Fund LLC(12) (17) (24)

  Financial
services
      1/27/2011            5        5   

THL Credit Greenway Fund II LLC(12) (17) (24)

  Financial
services
      3/1/2013            4        4   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subtotal investments in funds

  

    $ 9      $ 9   
             

Total non-controlled/affiliated investments—0.00% of net asset value

            $ 9      $ 9   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total investments—176.78% of net asset value

          $ 682,877      $ 779,028      $ 784,220   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Derivative Instruments

             

Counterparty

  Instrument   Interest Rate     Expiration
Date
    # of
Contracts
    Notional     Cost     Fair
Value
 

ING Capital Markets, LLC

  Interest
Rate
Swap –
Pay
Fixed/
Receive
Floating
    1.1425%/LIBOR        05/10/17        1      $ 50,000      $ —        $ (213
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total derivative instruments—0.03% of net asset value

          $ 50,000      $ —        $ (213
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

All debt investments are income-producing, unless otherwise noted. Equity and member interests are non-income-producing unless otherwise noted.

(2) 

All investments are pledged as collateral under the Revolving Facility and Term Loan Facility.

(3) 

Variable interest rate investments bear interest in reference to LIBOR or ABR, which are effective as of September 30, 2014. LIBOR loans are typically indexed to 30-day, 60-day, 90-day or 180-day LIBOR rates, at the borrower’s option, and ABR rates are typically indexed to the current prime rate or federal funds rate. Both LIBOR and ABR rates are subject to interest floors.

(4) 

Principal includes accumulated PIK, or paid-in-kind, interest and is net of repayments.

(5) 

Foreign company at the time of investment and, as a result, is not a qualifying asset under Section 55(a) of the 1940 Act.

(6) 

Unitranche investment; interest rate reflected represents the implied interest rate earned on the investment for the most recent quarter.

(7) 

Issuer pays 0.50% unfunded commitment fee on delayed draw term loan and revolving loan facility.

(8) 

The negative cost is the result of the capitalized discount being greater than the principal amount outstanding on the loan.

 

See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements

 

116


Table of Contents

THL Credit, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Schedule of Investments—(Continued)

December 31, 2014

(dollar amounts in thousands)

 

(9) 

Publicly-traded company with a market capitalization in excess of $250 million at the time of investment and, as a result, is not a qualifying asset under Section 55(a) of the Investment Company Act of 1940.

(10) 

At the option of the issuer, interest can be paid in cash or cash and PIK. The percentage of PIK shown is the maximum PIK that can be elected by the company.

(11) 

Issuer has the option to increase its aggregate interest rate to 18.5% all PIK for a period of time under certain conditions in the credit agreement.

(12) 

Member interests of limited liability companies are the equity equivalents of the stock of corporations.

(13) 

Equity ownership may be held in shares or units of companies related to the portfolio company.

(14) 

Preferred stock investment return is income-producing with a stated rate of 12% cash and 2% PIK due on a monthly basis

(15) 

Interest held by a wholly owned subsidiary of THL Credit, Inc.

(16) 

Income-producing security with no stated coupon; interest rate reflects an estimation of the effective yield to expected maturity as of December 31, 2014.

(17)

Non-registered investment company at the time of investment and, as a result, is not a qualifying asset under Section 55(a) of the 1940 Act.

(18) 

As defined in Section 2(a)(9) of the 1940 Act, the Company is deemed to control this portfolio company because it owns more than 25% of the portfolio company’s outstanding voting securities. See Schedule 12-14 in the accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements for transactions during the year ended December 31, 2014 in which the issuer was a portfolio company that the Company is deemed to control.

(19) 

C&K Market, Inc., or C&K, filed for bankruptcy in November 2013. On August 12, 2014, the date C&K emerged from bankruptcy, the cost basis of the senior subordinated note, certain interest due and warrants totaling $14,272 were converted to common and preferred equity. In connection with the extinguishment and conversion to equity, the Company recognized a loss in the amount of $1,000. See Note 4, Realized Gains and Losses on Investments for additional detail.

(20) 

On October 20, 2014, THL Credit restructured its investment in Wingspan Portfolio Holdings, Inc., or Wingspan. As part of the restructuring, THL Credit exchanged the cost basis of its subordinated term loan totaling $18,447 for a controlled equity position of an affiliated entity, Dimont Acquisition Inc., or Dimont. In connection with the restructuring and conversion to equity, the Company recognized a loss in the amount of $11,878 and invested $4,557 in the subordinated term loan of Dimont. See Note 4, Realized Gains and Losses on Investments for additional detail.

(21) 

Part of our preferred stock investment return is income-producing with a stated rate of 3% due on a quarterly basis.

(22) 

On December 3, 2014, the Company entered into an agreement with Perspecta to create THL Credit Logan JV LLC, or Logan JV, a joint venture, which will invest primarily in senior secured first lien term loans. All Logan JV investment decisions must be unanimously approved by the Logan JV investment committee consisting of one representative from each of the Company and Perspecta. Although the Company owns more than 25% of the voting securities of Logan JV, the Company does not believe that it has control over Logan JV for purposes of the 1940 Act or otherwise.

(23) 

Preferred stock

(24) 

Common stock, member interest, and warrants

(25) 

Warrants received at initial acquisition date at no cost to the Company

 

See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements

 

117


Table of Contents

THL Credit, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Schedule of Investments

December 31, 2013

(dollar amounts in thousands)

 

Type of Investment/Portfolio
company(1)

  Industry   Interest Rate(2)   Initial
Acquisition
Date
  Maturity/
Dissolution
Date
  Principal(3)
No. of  Shares /
No. of Units
    Amortized
Cost
    Fair
Value
 

Non-controlled/non-affiliated investments—143.26% of net asset value

             

First lien secured debt

             

20-20 Technologies Inc.(4)

  IT services   13.6%(5)   9/12/2012   9/12/2017   $ 13,650      $ 13,378      $ 13,582   

Airborne Tactical Advantage Company, LLC

  Aerospace &
defense
  11.0%   9/7/2011   3/7/2016     4,000        3,894        3,970   

Charming Charlie, LLC.

  Retail & grocery   9.0% (LIBOR

+ 8.0%)

  12/18/2013   12/31/2019     27,000        26,595        26,595   

Copperweld Bimetallics LLC

  Industrials   12.0%   12/11/2013   12/11/2018     21,725        20,863        20,863   

CRS Reprocessing, LLC

  Manufacturing   10.5% (LIBOR
+ 9.5%)
  6/16/2011   6/16/2015     17,647        17,587        17,647   

Cydcor LLC(20)

  Business services   9.8% (LIBOR +
7.3%)
  6/17/2013   6/12/2017     13,442        13,442        13,442   

Duff & Phelps Corporation(11)

  Financial services   4.5% (LIBOR

+ 3.5%)

  6/1/2012   12/31/2029     249        252        249   

Embarcadero Technologies, Inc.

  IT services   10.7%(5)   2/15/2013   12/28/2017     9,817        9,692        9,743   

Food Processing Holdings, LLC(4)

  Food & beverage   10.5% (LIBOR
+ 9.5%)
  10/31/2013   10/31/2018     22,202        21,770        21,770   

Food Processing Holdings, LLC(10)

  Food & beverage   10.5% (LIBOR
+ 9.5%)
  10/31/2013   10/31/2018     —          —          —     

Harrison Gypsum, LLC

  Industrials   10.5%(6) (LIBOR
+ 8.5% and
0.5% PIK)
  12/21/2012   12/21/2017     24,369        24,065        24,247   

Hart InterCivic, Inc.

  IT services   11.5% (LIBOR
+ 9.0% and 1%
PIK)(6)
  7/1/2011   7/1/2016     8,696        8,597        8,522   

Hart InterCivic, Inc.(10)

  IT services   10.5% (LIBOR
+ 9.0%)
  7/1/2011   7/1/2016     800        770        800   

HEALTHCAREfirst, Inc.

  Healthcare   11.9%(5)   8/31/2012   8/30/2017     9,175        8,958        8,624   

Holland Intermediate Acquisition Corp.

  Energy / Utilities   10.0% (LIBOR
+ 9.0%)
  5/29/2013   5/29/2018     24,227        23,751        24,227   

Holland Intermediate Acquisition Corp.(10)

  Energy / Utilities   10.0% (LIBOR
+ 9.0%)
  5/29/2013   5/29/2018     —          —          —     

Hostway Corporation

  IT services   6.0% (LIBOR

+ 4.8%)

  12/27/2013   12/13/2019     10,000        9,900        9,900   

Ingenio Acquisition, LLC

  Media,
entertainment and
leisure
  12.8%(6) (11.3%
Cash and 1.5%
PIK)
  5/9/2013   5/9/2018     9,606        9,433        9,558   

Key Brand Entertainment, Inc.

  Media,
entertainment and
leisure
  9.8% (LIBOR

+ 8.5%)

  8/8/2013   8/8/2018     13,178        12,931        12,947   

Key Brand Entertainment, Inc.(10)

  Media,
entertainment and
leisure
  9.8% (LIBOR

+ 8.5%)

  8/8/2013   8/8/2018     1,478        1,451        1,478   

Loadmaster Derrick & Equipment, Inc.

  Energy / Utilities   9.3% (LIBOR

+ 8.3%)

  9/28/2012   9/28/2017     8,828        8,642        8,608   

Loadmaster Derrick & Equipment, Inc.(10)

  Energy / Utilities   9.3% (LIBOR

+ 8.3%)

  9/28/2012   9/28/2017     —          —          —     

Loadmaster Derrick & Equipment, Inc.(10)

  Energy / Utilities   9.3% (LIBOR

+ 8.3%)

  9/28/2012   9/28/2017     —          —          —     

NCM Group Holdings, LLC

  Industrials   12.5% (LIBOR
+ 11.5%)
  8/29/2013   8/29/2018     26,727        25,711        26,193   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subtotal First lien secured debt

  $ 266,816      $ 261,682      $ 262,965   

 

(Continued on next page)

See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements

 

118


Table of Contents

THL Credit, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Schedule of Investments—(Continued)

December 31, 2013

(dollar amounts in thousands)

 

Type of Investment/Portfolio
company(1)

  Industry   Interest Rate(2)   Initial
Acquisition
Date
  Maturity/
Dissolution
Date
  Principal(3)
No. of  Shares /
No. of Units
    Amortized
Cost
    Fair
Value
 

Second lien debt

             

Allen Edmonds Corporation

  Consumer products   10% (LIBOR

+ 9.0%)

  11/26/2013   5/27/2019   $ 7,333      $ 7,189      $ 7,189   

Blue Coat Systems, Inc.

  IT services   9.5% (LIBOR

+ 8.5%)

  6/27/2013   6/27/2020     15,000        14,860        15,150   

Connecture, Inc.

  Healthcare   10.0% (LIBOR
+ 9.0%)
  3/18/2013   7/15/2018     7,000        6,875        7,000   

Expert Global Solutions, Inc.

  Business services   12.5%(6)
(LIBOR +10.2%
and 0.8% PIK)
  6/21/2013   10/3/2018     18,727        18,987        18,821   

Hostway Corporation

  IT services   10.0% (LIBOR
+ 8.8%)
  12/27/2013   12/13/2020     12,000        11,760        11,760   

Oasis Legal Finance Holding Company LLC

  Financial services   10.5%   9/30/2013   9/30/2018     13,943        13,676        13,676   

OEM Group, Inc.

  Manufacturing   15.0%(6) (12.5%
Cash and 2.5%
PIK)
  10/7/2010   10/7/2015     15,162        14,974        14,480   

Sheplers, Inc.

  Retail & grocery   13.2% (LIBOR
+ 11.7%)
  12/20/2011   12/20/2016     11,426        11,234        11,425   

Specialty Brands Holdings, LLC

  Restaurants   11.3% (LIBOR
+ 9.8%)
  7/16/2013   7/16/2018     20,977        20,587        20,587   

Surgery Center Holdings, Inc.

  Healthcare   9.8% (LIBOR

+ 8.5%)

  4/19/2013   4/11/2020     15,000        14,652        15,000   

Vision Solutions, Inc.

  IT services   9.5% (LIBOR

+ 8.0%)

  3/31/2011   7/23/2017     11,625        11,561        11,625   

Washington Inventory Service

  Business services   10.3% (LIBOR
+ 9.0%)
  12/27/2012   6/20/2019     11,000        10,861        11,165   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subtotal Second lien secured debt

  $ 159,193      $ 157,216      $ 157,878   

Subordinated debt

             

C&K Market, Inc.

  Retail & grocery   18.0%(18)   11/3/2010   11/3/2015   $ 13,650      $ 13,302      $ 10,237   

Country Pure Foods, LLC

  Food & beverage   13.0%   8/13/2010   2/13/2017     16,181        16,183        16,061   

Dr. Fresh, LLC

  Consumer products   14.0%(6) (12.0%
Cash and 2.0%
PIK)
  5/15/2012   11/15/2017     14,447        14,223        14,375   

Express Courier International, Inc.

  Business services   15.0%(13) (PIK)   1/17/2012   7/17/2016     8,595        7,652        6,601   

Gold, Inc.

  Consumer products   11.0%   12/31/2012   6/30/2019     16,788        16,788        16,788   

Martex Fiber Southern Corp.

  Industrials   13.5%(6) (12.0%
Cash and 1.5%
PIK)
  4/30/2012   10/31/2019     8,890        8,778        8,445   

SeaStar Solutions (f.k.a. Marine Acquisition Corp)

  Manufacturing   13.5%(6) (11.5%
Cash and 2.0%
PIK)
  9/18/2012   5/18/2017     16,500        16,209        16,830   

Sheplers, Inc.

  Retail & grocery   17.0%(17) (10.0%
Cash and 7.0%
PIK)
  12/20/11   12/20/2017     1,904        1,879        1,904   

Tri Starr Management Services, Inc.

  IT services   15.8%(6) (12.5%
Cash and 3.3%
PIK)
  3/4/2013   3/4/2019     18,307        17,981        17,941   

The Studer Group, L.L.C.

  Healthcare   12.0%   9/29/2011   1/31/2019     16,910        16,910        16,910   

Trinity Services Group, Inc.

  Food & beverage   14.5%(6) (12.0%
Cash and 2.5%
PIK)
  3/29/2012   9/29/2017     14,411        14,252        14,122   

Wingspan Portfolio Holdings, Inc.

  Financial services   15.5%(19)   5/21/2013   11/21/2016     18,768        18,447        15,765   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subtotal Subordinated debt

  $ 165,351      $ 162,604      $ 155,979   

 

(Continued on next page)

See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements

 

119


Table of Contents

THL Credit, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Schedule of Investments—(Continued)

December 31, 2013

(dollar amounts in thousands)

 

Type of Investment/

Portfolio  company(1)

  Industry   Interest  Rate(2)     Initial
Acquisition
Date
    Maturity/
Dissolution
Date
    Principal(3)
No. of  Shares /
No. of Units
    Amortized
Cost
    Fair Value  

Equity investments

             

AIM Media Texas Operating, LLC(7)(8)

  Media,
entertainment and
leisure
      6/21/2012        —          0.763636      $ 764      $ 1,000   

Airborne Tactical Advantage Company, LLC(9)

  Aerospace &
defense
      9/7/2011        —          512        112        135   

Airborne Tactical Advantage Company, LLC(9)

  Aerospace &
defense
      9/17/2013        —          225        169        255   

C&K Market, Inc.

  Retail & grocery       11/3/2010        —          —          349        —     

Firebirds International, LLC(9)

  Restaurants       5/17/2011        —          1,906        191        257   

Food Processing Holdings, LLC(9)

  Food & beverage       4/20/2010        —          162.44        163        202   

Food Processing Holdings, LLC(9)

  Food & beverage       4/20/2010        —          406.09        408        150   

Hostway Corporation(9)

  IT services       12/27/2013        —          20        200        200   

Hostway Corporation(9)

  IT services       12/27/2013        —          2        1,800        1,800   

Jefferson Management Holdings, LLC(7)(8)

  Healthcare       4/20/2010        —          1,393        1,393        938   

OEM Group, Inc.

  Manufacturing       10/7/2010        —          —          —          —     

Surgery Center Holdings, Inc.(8)(9)

  Healthcare       4/20/2013        —          469,673        —          2,000   

YP Equity Investors, LLC(7)(8)

  Media,
entertainment and
leisure
      5/8/2012        —          —          —          4,100   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subtotal Equity

  

    $ 5,549      $ 11,037   

CLO residual interests

             

Adirondack Park CLO Ltd.(4)

  Structured
products
    13.7%(12)        3/27/2013        4/15/2024        —        $ 9,171      $ 9,110   

Dryden CLO, Ltd.

  Structured
products
    13.6%(12)        9/12/2013        11/15/2025        —          9,129        9,300   

Flagship VII, Ltd.(4)

  Structured
products
    13.9%(12)        12/18/2013        1/20/2026        —          4,400        4,400   

Octagon Income Note XIV, Ltd.

  Structured
products
    15.5%(12)        12/19/2012        1/15/2024        —          8,579        8,656   

Sheridan Square CLO, Ltd

  Structured
products
    13.2%(12)        3/12/2013        4/15/2025        —          6,064        6,152   
              —          —     
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subtotal CLO residual interests

  

    $ 37,343      $ 37,618   

Investment in payment rights

             

Duff & Phelps Corporation(11)

  Financial services     16.2%(12)        6/1/2012        12/31/2029        —        $ 12,163      $ 13,844   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subtotal Investment in payment rights

  

    $ 12,163      $ 13,844   

 

(Continued on next page)

See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements

 

120


Table of Contents

THL Credit, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Schedule of Investments—(Continued)

December 31, 2013

(dollar amounts in thousands)

 

Type of Investment/

Portfolio company(1)

  Industry   Interest  Rate(2)     Initial
Acquisition
Date
    Maturity/
Dissolution
Date
    Principal(3)
No. of  Shares /
No. of Units
    Amortized
Cost
    Fair Value  

Investments in funds

             

Freeport Financial SBIC Fund LP(16)

  Financial services       6/14/2013        1/0/1900      $ 801      $ 801      $ 801   

Gryphon Partners 3.5, L.P. (16)

  Financial services       11/20/2012        12/21/2018        1,251        199        384   

LCP Capital Fund LLC (8) (15) (16)

  Media,
entertainment and
leisure
    12.6%(12)        4/20/2010        2/15/2015        8,354        8,354        8,354   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subtotal Investments in funds

  

  $ 10,406      $ 9,354      $ 9,539   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-controlled/non-affiliated investments—143.26% of net asset value

          $ 601,766      $ 645,911      $ 648,860   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-controlled/affiliated investments—0.00% of net asset value

             

Investments in funds

             

THL Credit Greenway Fund LLC(8)(16)

  Financial services       1/27/2011        1/14/2021        —        $ 5      $ 5   

THL Credit Greenway Fund II LLC(8)(16)

  Financial services       3/1/2013        10/10/2021        —          2        2   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subtotal Investments in funds

  

    $ 7      $ 7   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-controlled/affiliated investments—0.00% of net asset value

            $ 7      $ 7   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 
             
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total investments—143.26% of net asset value

        $ 601,766      $ 645,918      $ 648,867   
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Derivative Instruments

             

Counterparty

  Instrument   Interest Rate     Expiration
Date
    # of Contracts     Notional     Cost     Fair Value  

ING Capital Markets, LLC

  Interest Rate
Swap—Pay Fixed/
Receive Floating
    1.1425%/LIBOR        05/10/17        1      $ 50,000      $ —        $ (284
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total derivative instruments—0.06% of net asset value

          $ 50,000      $ —        $ (284
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

All debt investments are income-producing. Equity and member interests are non-income-producing unless otherwise noted.

(2) 

Variable interest rate investments bear interest in reference to LIBOR or ABR, which are effective as of December 31, 2013. These variable rates reset monthly or quarterly, subject to interest rate floors.

(3) 

Principal includes accumulated PIK, or paid-in-kind, interest and is net of repayments.

(4) 

Foreign company at the time of investment and, as a result, is not a qualifying asset under Section 55(a) of the 1940 Act.

 

See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements

 

121


Table of Contents

THL Credit, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Schedule of Investments—(Continued)

December 31, 2013

(dollar amounts in thousands)

 

(5) 

Unitranche investment; interest rate reflected represents the implied interest rate earned on the investment for the most recent quarter.

(6) 

At the option of the issuer, interest can be paid in cash or cash and PIK. The percentage of PIK shown is the maximum PIK that can be elected by the company.

(7) 

Interest held by a wholly owned subsidiary of THL Credit, Inc.

(8) 

Member interests of limited liability companies are the equity equivalents of the stock of corporations.

(9) 

Equity ownership may be held in shares or units of companies related to the portfolio company.

(10) 

Issuer pays 0.50% unfunded commitment fee on revolving loan facility.

(11) 

Publicly-traded company with a market capitalization in excess of $250 million at the time of investment and, as a result, is not a qualifying asset under Section 55(a) of the 1940 Act.

(12) 

Income-producing security with no stated coupon; interest rate reflects an estimation of the effective yield to expected maturity as of December 31, 2013.

(13) 

Loan was on non-accrual status as of December 31, 2013. Issuer’s contractual rate is 15.0% PIK until December 31, 2013 and then for each of the quarters ending March 31, 2014 and June 30, 2014, the lesser of excess cash flow for the quarter or 12% paid in cash with the remainder amount paid in PIK up to a total rate of 15%.

(14) 

Debt investment interest held in companies related to the portfolio company.

(15) 

The Company’s investment in LCP Capital Fund LLC is in the form of membership interests and its contributed capital is for the most recent quarter maintained in a collateral account held by a custodian and acts as collateral for certain credit default swaps for the Series 2005-1 equity interest. See Note 2 in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

(16) 

Non-registered investment company at the time of investment and, as a result, is not a qualifying asset under Section 55(a) of the 1940 Act.

(17) 

Issuer has the option to increase its aggregate interest rate to 18.5% all PIK for a period of time under certain conditions in the credit agreement.

(18) 

C&K Market, Inc. filed for bankruptcy in November 2013. Loan was on non-accrual status as of December 31, 2013. Contractual default rate of interest is 18.0%.

(19) 

Contractual default rate of interest is 15.5%. Certain interest payments have been deferred until April 15, 2014.

(20) 

Of the $13,442 senior secured term loans outstanding, $11,981 is based in the United States and $1,461 is based in Canada.

 

See accompanying notes to these consolidated financial statements

 

122


Table of Contents

THL Credit, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

December 31, 2014

(in thousands, except per share data)

1. Organization

THL Credit, Inc., or the Company, was organized as a Delaware corporation on May 26, 2009. The Company has elected to be regulated as a business development company, or BDC, under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, or 1940 Act. The Company has elected to be treated for tax purposes as a regulated investment company, or RIC, under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, or as amended, the Code. In 2009, the Company was treated for tax purposes as a corporation. The Company’s investment objective is to generate both current income and capital appreciation, primarily through privately negotiated investments in debt and equity securities of middle market companies.

On April 20, 2010, in anticipation of completing an initial public offering and formally commencing principal operations, the Company entered into a purchase and sale agreement with THL Credit Opportunities, L.P. and THL Credit Partners BDC Holdings, L.P., or BDC Holdings, an affiliate of the Company, to effectuate the sale by THL Credit Opportunities, L.P. to the Company of certain securities valued at $62,107, as determined by the Company’s board of directors, and on the same day issued 4,140 shares of common stock to BDC Holdings valued at $15.00 per share, pursuant to such agreement, in exchange for the aforementioned securities. Subsequently, the Company filed an election to be regulated as a BDC.

On April 21, 2010, the Company completed its initial public offering, formally commencing principal operations, and sold 9,000 shares of its common stock through a group of underwriters at a price of $13.00 per share, less an underwriting discount and commissions totaling $0.8125 per share. Concurrently, the Company sold 6,308 shares of its common stock to BDC Holdings at $13.00 per share, the sale of which was not subject to an underwriting discount and commission. On April 27, 2010, the Company closed the sale of the aforementioned 15,308 shares and received $190,684 of net proceeds, which includes an underwriting discount and offering expenses.

On May 26, 2010, the underwriters exercised their over-allotment option under the underwriting agreement and elected to purchase an additional 337 shares of common stock at $13.00 per share resulting in additional net proceeds of $3,892, which includes an underwriting discount and offering expenses.

On September 25, 2012, the Company closed a public equity offering selling 6,095 shares of its common stock through a group of underwriters at a price of $14.09 per share, less an underwriting discount and offering expenses, and received $81,657 in net proceeds.

On June 24, 2013, the Company closed a public equity offering selling 7,590 shares of its common stock through a group of underwriters at a price of $14.62 per share, less an underwriting discount and offering expenses, and received $106,179 in net proceeds.

In November 2014, the Company closed a public debt offering selling $50,000 of Notes due 2021, including the exercise of the over allotment option, through a group of underwriters, less an underwriting discount, and received net proceeds of $48,500.

The Company has established wholly owned subsidiaries, THL Credit AIM Media Holdings Inc., THL Credit Holdings, Inc. and THL Credit YP Holdings Inc., which are structured as Delaware entities, or tax blockers, to hold equity or equity-like investments in portfolio companies organized as limited liability companies, or LLCs (or other forms of pass-through entities). Tax blockers are not consolidated for income tax purposes and may incur income tax expense as a result of their ownership of portfolio companies.

The Company has a wholly owned subsidiary, THL Corporate Finance, Inc. and THL Corporate Finance, LLC, its wholly owned subsidiary, serves as the administrative agent on certain investment transactions.

 

123


Table of Contents

2. Significant Accounting Policies

Basis of Presentation

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and its subsidiaries. All inter-company accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation. In accordance with Article 6 of Regulation S-X under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, the Company generally will not consolidate its interest in any company other than in investment company subsidiaries and controlled operating companies substantially all of whose business consists of providing services to the Company.

The accompanying consolidated financial statements of the Company have been presented in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“GAAP”) and pursuant to the requirements for reporting on Form 10-K and Regulation S-X. The financial results of our portfolio companies are not consolidated in the financial statements. The accounting records of the Company are maintained in U.S. dollars.

Consolidation

The Company follows the guidance in ASC Topic 946 Financial Services—Investment Companies and will not generally consolidate its investment in a company other than an investment company subsidiary or a controlled operating company whose business consists of providing services to the Company. Accordingly, the Company consolidated the results of its wholly owned subsidiaries in its consolidated financial statements. The Company does not consolidate its non-controlling interest in THL Credit Logan JV LLC, or Logan JV. See also the disclosure in Note 2, Significant Accounting Policies—THL Credit Logan JV LLC.

Use of Estimates

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that may affect the reported amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Changes in the economic environment, financial markets, credit worthiness of our portfolio companies and any other parameters used in determining these estimates could cause actual results to differ and these differences could be material.

Cash

Cash consists of funds held in demand deposit accounts at several financial institutions and, at certain times, balances may exceed the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation insured limit and is therefore subject to credit risk. There were no cash equivalents as of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013.

Deferred Financing Costs

Deferred financing costs consist of fees and expenses paid in connection with the closing of credit facilities and public debt offering of Notes. These costs are capitalized at the time of payment and are amortized using the straight line and effective yield methods over the term of the credit facilities and notes, respectively.

Deferred Offering Costs

Deferred offering costs consist of fees and expenses incurred in connection with the offer and sale of the Company’s common stock, including legal, accounting, printing fees and other related expenses, as well as costs incurred in connection with the filing of a shelf registration statement. These costs are capitalized when incurred and recognized as a reduction of offering proceeds when the offering becomes effective.

Deferred Revenue

Deferred revenues consists of proceeds received for interest and other fees for which the earnings process is not yet complete. Such amounts will be recognized into income over such time that the income is earned.

 

124


Table of Contents

Escrow Receivable

Escrow receivable represents the Company’s claims to amounts set aside for indemnification claims or purchase price adjustments from the sale of certain investments. Escrow receivable is presented at net realizable value on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.

Interest Rate Derivative

The Company recognizes derivatives as either interest rate derivative assets or liabilities at fair value on its Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities with valuation changes and interest rate payments recorded as net change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation) on interest rate derivative and interest rate derivative periodic interest payments, net, respectively, on the Consolidated Statements of Operations. See also the disclosure in Note 8, Interest Rate Derivative.

Partial Loan Sales

The Company follows the guidance in ASC Topic 860 Transfers and Servicing when accounting for loan participations and other partial loan sales. Such guidance requires a participation or other partial loan sale to meet the definition of a “participating interest”, as defined in the guidance as a pro-rata ownership interest in an entire financial asset, in order for sale treatment to be allowed. Participations or other partial loan sales which do not meet the definition of a participating interest remain on the Company’s consolidated statements of asset and liabilities and the proceeds are recorded as a secured borrowing until the definition is met.

Fair Value of Financial Instruments

The carrying amounts of the Company’s financial instruments, including cash, accounts payable and accrued expenses, approximate fair value due to their short-term nature. The carrying amounts and fair values of the Company’s long-term obligations are disclosed in Note 6, Credit Facility and Note 7, Notes.

Valuation of Investments

Investments, for which market quotations are readily available, are valued using market quotations, which are generally obtained from an independent pricing service or broker-dealers or market makers. Debt and equity securities, for which market quotations are not readily available or are not considered to be the best estimate of fair value, are valued at fair value as determined in good faith by the Company’s board of directors. Because the Company expects that there will not be a readily available market value for many of the investments in the Company’s portfolio, it is expected that many of the Company’s portfolio investments’ values will be determined in good faith by the Company’s board of directors in accordance with a documented valuation policy that has been reviewed and approved by our board of directors in accordance with GAAP. Due to the inherent uncertainty of determining the fair value of investments that do not have a readily available market value, the fair value of the Company’s investments may differ significantly from the values that would have been used had a readily available market value existed for such investments, and the differences could be material.

With respect to investments for which market quotations are not readily available, the Company’s board of directors undertakes a multi-step valuation process each quarter, as described below:

 

   

the Company’s quarterly valuation process begins with each portfolio company or investment being initially valued by the investment professionals responsible for the portfolio investment;

 

   

preliminary valuation conclusions are then documented and discussed with senior management of the THL Credit Advisors LLC, or the Advisor;

 

125


Table of Contents
   

to the extent determined by the audit committee of the Company’s board of directors, independent valuation firms used by the Company to conduct independent appraisals and review the Advisor’s preliminary valuations in light of their own independent assessment;

 

   

the audit committee of the Company’s board of directors reviews the preliminary valuations of the Advisor and independent valuation firms and, if necessary, responds and supplements the valuation recommendation of the independent valuation firms to reflect any comments; and

 

   

the Company’s board of directors discusses valuations and determines the fair value of each investment in the Company’s portfolio in good faith based on the input of the Advisor, the respective independent valuation firms and the audit committee.

The types of factors that the Company may take into account in fair value pricing its investments include, as relevant, the nature and realizable value of any collateral, the portfolio company’s ability to make payments and its earnings and discounted cash flows, the markets in which the portfolio company does business, comparison to publicly traded securities and other relevant factors. The Company utilizes an income approach to value its debt investments and a combination of income and market approaches to value its equity investments. With respect to unquoted securities, the Advisor and the Company’s board of directors, in consultation with the Company’s independent third party valuation firms, values each investment considering, among other measures, discounted cash flow models, comparisons of financial ratios of peer companies that are public and other factors, which valuation is then approved by the board of directors. For debt investments, the Company determines the fair value primarily using an income, or yield, approach that analyzes the discounted cash flows of interest and principal for the debt security, as set forth in the associated loan agreements, as well as the financial position and credit risk of each portfolio investments. The Company’s estimate of the expected repayment date is generally the legal maturity date of the instrument . The yield analysis considers changes in leverage levels, credit quality, portfolio company performance and other factors.

The Company values its interest rate derivative agreement using an income approach that analyzes the discounted cash flows associated with the interest rate derivative agreement. Significant inputs to the discounted cash flows methodology include the forward interest rate yield curves in effect as of the end of the measurement period and an evaluation of the counterparty’s credit risk.

The Company values its residual interest investments in collateralized loan obligations using an income approach that analyzes the discounted cash flows of its residual interest. The discounted cash flows model utilizes prepayment, re-investment and loss assumptions based on historical experience and projected performance, economic factors, the characteristics of the underlying cash flow, and comparable yields for similar collateralized loan obligation fund subordinated notes or equity, when available. Specifically, the Company uses Intex cash flow models, or an appropriate substitute to form the basis for the valuation of the Company’s residual interest. The models use a set of assumptions including projected default rates, recovery rates, reinvestment rates and prepayment rates in order to arrive at estimated cash flows. The assumptions are based on available market data and projections provided by third parties as well as management estimates.

The Company values its investment in payment rights using an income approach that analyzes the discounted projected future cash flow streams assuming an appropriate discount rate, which will among other things consider other transactions in the market, the current credit environment, performance of the underlying portfolio company and the length of the remaining payment stream.

The market approach uses prices and other relevant information generated by market transactions involving identical or comparable assets or liabilities (including a business). The income approach uses valuation techniques to convert future cash flows or earnings to a single present amount (discounted). The measurement is based on the value indicated by current market expectations about those future amounts. In following these approaches, the types of factors that the Company may take into account in fair value pricing the Company’s investments include, as relevant: available current market data, including relevant

and applicable market trading and transaction comparables, applicable market yields and multiples, the

 

126


Table of Contents

current investment performance rating, security covenants, call protection provisions, information rights, the nature and realizable value of any collateral, the portfolio company’s ability to make payments, its earnings and discounted cash flows, the markets in which the portfolio company does business, comparisons of financial ratios of peer companies that are public, transaction comparables, the Company’s principal market as the reporting entity and enterprise values, among other factors.

In accordance with the authoritative guidance on fair value measurements and disclosures under GAAP, the Company discloses the fair value of its investments in a hierarchy that prioritizes the inputs to valuation techniques used to measure fair value. The hierarchy gives the highest priority to unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities (Level 1 measurements) and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs (Level 3 measurements). The guidance establishes three levels of the fair value hierarchy as follows:

Level 1—Unadjusted quoted prices in active markets that are accessible at the measurement date for identical, unrestricted assets or liabilities;

Level 2—Quoted prices in markets that are not considered to be active or financial instruments for which significant inputs are observable, either directly or indirectly;

Level 3—Prices or valuations that require inputs that are both significant to the fair value measurement and unobservable.

The level of an asset or liability within the fair value hierarchy is based on the lowest level of any input that is significant to the fair value measurement. However, the determination of what constitutes “observable” requires significant judgment by management.

The Company considers whether the volume and level of activity for the asset or liability have significantly decreased and identifies transactions that are not orderly in determining fair value. Accordingly, if the Company determines that either the volume and/or level of activity for an asset or liability has significantly decreased (from normal conditions for that asset or liability) or price quotations or observable inputs are not associated with orderly transactions, increased analysis and management judgment will be required to estimate fair value. Valuation techniques such as an income approach might be appropriate to supplement or replace a market approach in those circumstances.

The Company has adopted the authoritative guidance under GAAP for estimating the fair value of investments in investment companies that have calculated net asset value per share in accordance with the specialized accounting guidance for Investment Companies. Accordingly, in circumstances in which net asset value per share of an investment is determinative of fair value, the Company estimates the fair value of an investment in an investment company using the net asset value per share of the investment (or its equivalent) without further adjustment if the net asset value per share of the investment is determined in accordance with the specialized accounting guidance for investment companies as of the reporting entity’s measurement date.

Investment Risk

The value of investments will generally fluctuate with, among other things, changes in prevailing interest rates, federal tax rates, counterparty risk, general economic conditions, the condition of certain financial markets, developments or trends in any particular industry and the financial condition of the issuer. During periods of limited liquidity and higher price volatility, the Company’s ability to dispose of investments at a price and time that the Company deems advantageous may be impaired. The extent of this exposure is reflected in the carrying value of these financial assets and recorded in the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.

Lower-quality debt securities involve greater risk of default or price changes due to changes in the credit quality of the issuer. The value of lower-quality debt securities often fluctuates in response to company, political, or economic developments and can decline significantly over short periods of time or during

 

127


Table of Contents

periods of general or regional economic difficulty. Lower-quality debt securities can be thinly traded or have restrictions on resale, making them difficult to sell at an acceptable price. The default rate for lower-quality debt securities is likely to be higher during economic recessions or periods of high interest rates.

Security Transactions, Payment-in-Kind, Income Recognition, Realized/Unrealized Gains or Losses

Security transactions are recorded on a trade-date basis. The Company measures realized gains or losses by the difference between the net proceeds from the repayment or sale and the amortized cost basis of the investment, using the specific identification method. The Company reports changes in fair value of investments that are measured at fair value as a component of net change in unrealized appreciation on investments in the Consolidated Statements of Operations. The Company reports changes in fair value of the interest rate derivative that is measured at fair value as a component of net change in unrealized appreciation or depreciation on interest rate derivative in the Consolidated Statements of Operations.

Interest income, adjusted for amortization of premium and accretion of discount, is recorded on an accrual basis to the extent that the Company expects to collect such amounts. Dividend income is recognized on the ex-dividend date. Original issue discount, principally representing the estimated fair value of detachable equity or warrants obtained in conjunction with the acquisition of debt securities, and market discount or premium are capitalized and accreted or amortized into interest income over the life of the respective security using the effective yield method. The amortized cost of investments represents the original cost adjusted for the accretion/amortization of discounts and premiums and upfront loan origination fees.

Loans are placed on non-accrual status when principal or interest payments are past due 30 days or more and/or when it is no longer probable that principal or interest will be collected. However, the Company may make exceptions to this policy if the loan has sufficient collateral value and is in the process of collection. The Company records the reversal of any previously accrued income against the same income category reflected in the Consolidated Statement of Operations. As of December 31, 2014, the Company had no loans on non-accrual. As of December 31, 2013, the Company had two loans on non-accrual with an amortized cost basis of $20,954 and fair value of $16,838.

The Company has investments in its portfolio which contain a contractual paid-in-kind, or PIK, interest provision. PIK interest is computed at the contractual rate specified in each investment agreement, is added to the principal balance of the investment, and is recorded as income. The Company will cease accruing PIK interest if there is insufficient value to support the accrual or if the Company does not expect amounts to be collectible and will generally only begin to recognize PIK income again when all principal and interest have been paid or upon the restructuring of the investment where the interest is deemed collectable. To maintain the Company’s status as a RIC, PIK interest income, which is considered investment company taxable income, must be paid out to stockholders in the form of dividends even though the Company has not yet collected the cash. Amounts necessary to pay these dividends may come from available cash.

The following shows a rollforward of PIK income activity for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012:

 

     Years ended December 31,  
     2014      2013      2012  

Accumulated PIK balance, beginning of year

   $ 6,064       $ 5,807       $ 3,488   

PIK income capitalized/receivable

     2,316         3,179         4,124   

PIK received in cash from repayments

     (1,339      (2,922      (1,805
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Accumulated PIK balance, end of year

   $ 7,041       $ 6,064       $ 5,807   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest income from the Company’s TRA and CLO residual interests is recorded based upon an estimation of an effective yield to expected maturity using anticipated cash flows. Amounts in excess of income recognized are recorded as a reduction to the cost basis of the investment. The Company monitors the anticipated cash flows from its TRA and CLO residual interests and will adjust its effective yield periodically as needed.

 

128


Table of Contents

The Company capitalizes and amortizes upfront loan origination fees received in connection with the closing of investments. The unearned income from such fees is accreted into interest income over the contractual life of the loan based on the effective interest method. Upon prepayment of a loan or debt security, any prepayment premiums, unamortized upfront loan origination fees, and unamortized discounts are recorded as interest income.

In certain investment transactions, the Company may provide advisory services. For services that are separately identifiable and external evidence exists to substantiate fair value, income is recognized as earned. The Company had no income from advisory services related to portfolio companies for the years end December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012.

The Company may also generate revenue in the form of fees from the management of Greenway and Greenway II, prepayment premiums, commitment, loan origination, structuring or due diligence fees, exit fees, portfolio company administration fees, fees for providing significant managerial assistance and consulting fees.

The following is a summary of the levels within the fair value hierarchy in which the Company invests as of December 31, 2014:

 

Description

   Fair Value      Level 1      Level 2      Level 3  

First lien secured debt

   $ 393,791       $ —         $ —         $ 393,791   

Second lien debt

     168,510         —           —           168,510   

Subordinated debt

     100,660         —           —           100,660   

Equity investments

     52,707         —           —           52,707   

CLO residual interests

     34,935         —           —           34,935   

Investment in Logan JV

     16,741         —           —           16,741   

Investment in payment rights

     13,488         —           —           13,488   

Investments in funds

     3,388         —           —           3,388   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total investments

   $ 784,220       $ —         $ —         $ 784,220   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest rate derivative

     (213      —           (213      —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liability at fair value

   $ (213    $ —         $ (213    $ —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following is a summary of the levels within the fair value hierarchy in which the Company invests as of December 31, 2013:

 

Description

   Fair Value      Level 1      Level 2      Level 3  

First lien secured debt

   $ 262,965       $ —        $ —        $ 262,965   

Subordinated debt

     155,979         —          —          155,979   

Second lien debt

     157,878         —          —          157,878   

CLO residual interest

     37,618         —          —          37,618   

Investment in payment rights

     13,844         —          —          13,844   

Investments in funds

     9,546         —          —          9,546   

Equity investments

     11,037         —          —          11,037   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total investments

   $ 648,867       $ —        $ —        $ 648,867   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest rate derivative

     (284      —          (284      —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liability at fair value

   $ (284    $ —        $ (284    $ —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

129


Table of Contents

The following is a summary of the industry classification in which the Company invests as of December 31, 2014:

 

Industry

   Amortized Cost      Fair Value      % of
Net Assets
 

Consumer products

   $ 120,742       $ 120,388         27.15

IT services

     108,705         106,567         24.02

Healthcare

     77,487         83,164         18.75

Financial services

     71,420         68,997         15.55

Manufacturing

     70,817         68,357         15.41

Retail & grocery

     52,985         55,798         12.58

Industrials

     54,561         54,050         12.18

Energy / utilities

     50,284         48,989         11.04

Food & beverage

     38,594         39,251         8.85

Structured products

     34,213         34,935         7.87

Business services

     32,182         32,244         7.27

Media, entertainment and leisure

     25,134         29,688         6.69

Restaurants

     20,847         20,753         4.68

Transportation

     14,273         14,259         3.21

Aerospace & defense

     6,784         6,780         1.53
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Investments

   $ 779,028       $ 784,220         176.78
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following is a summary of the industry classification in which the Company invests as of December 31, 2013:

 

Industry

   Amortized Cost      Fair Value      % of
Net Assets
 

IT services

     100,501         101,023         22.31

Industrials

     79,418         79,748         17.61

Financial services

     53,899         53,080         11.72

Food & beverage

     52,774         52,304         11.55

Healthcare

     48,790         50,472         11.14

Retail & grocery

     53,358         50,163         11.07

Business services

     50,941         50,029         11.05

Manufacturing

     48,770         48,956         10.81

Consumer products

     38,200         38,352         8.47

Structured products

     37,343         37,618         8.31

Energy / utilities

     32,393         32,835         7.25

Media, entertainment and leisure

     24,578         29,083         6.42

Restaurants

     20,778         20,844         4.60

Aerospace & defense

     4,175         4,360         0.96
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Investments

   $ 645,918       $ 648,867         143.27
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

130


Table of Contents

The following is a summary of the geographical concentration of our investment portfolio as of December 31, 2014:

 

Region

   Amortized Cost      Fair Value      % of
Net Assets
 

Northeast

   $ 208,928       $ 208,218         46.95

Southwest

     211,098         204,531         46.10

Southeast

     109,082         119,214         26.87

Midwest

     117,329         116,468         26.25

West

     72,861         73,048         16.47

International

     31,275         31,600         7.12

Northwest

     28,455         31,141         7.02
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Investments

   $ 779,028       $ 784,220         176.78
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following is a summary of the geographical concentration of our investment portfolio as of December 31, 2013:

 

Region

   Amortized Cost      Fair Value      % of
Net Assets
 

Northeast

   $ 138,835       $ 140,292         30.97

West

     126,770         128,423         28.35

Midwest

     124,248         124,817         27.56

Southwest

     119,357         116,573         25.74

Southeast

     109,679         114,943         25.38

International

     13,378         13,582         3.00

Northwest

     13,651         10,237         2.26
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Investments

   $ 645,918       $ 648,867         143.26
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following table rolls forward the changes in fair value during the year ended December 31, 2014 for investments classified within Level 3:

 

    First lien
secured debt
    Second lien
debt
    Subordinated
debt
    Investments
in funds(2)
    Equity
investments
    Investment
in payment
rights
    CLO
residual
interest
    Totals  

Beginning balance, January 1, 2014

  $ 262,965      $ 157,878      $ 155,979      $ 9,546      $ 11,037      $ 13,844      $ 37,618      $ 648,867   

Purchases

    176,376        117,195        18,036        19,115        39,593        —          8,451        378,766   

Sales and repayments

    (73,440     (77,765     (67,117     (8,487     (938     (286     (11,718     (239,751

Unrealized appreciation

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

(depreciation)(1)

    (2,415     (2,828     3,390        (45     3,765        (70     446        2,243   

Realized loss

    —          (250     (11,955     —          (804     —          —          (13,009

Net amortization of premiums,

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

discounts and fees

    2,465        1,378        804        —          10        —          138        4,795   

PIK

    213        529        1,523        —          44        —          —          2,309   

Transfers between categories(3)

    27,627        (27,627     —          —          —          —          —          —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance, December 31, 2014

  $ 393,791      $ 168,510      $ 100,660      $ 20,129      $ 52,707      $ 13,488      $ 34,935      $ 784,220   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net change in unrealizedappreciation (depreciation) from investments still held as of the reporting date(1)

  $ (1,933   $ (2,191   $ (2,916   $ (45   $ 2,960      $ (70   $ 524      $ (3,671
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

All unrealized appreciation (depreciation) in the table above is reflected in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations.

(2)

Includes investment in Logan JV.

 

131


Table of Contents
(3)

Transfers represent a transfer of $27,627 out of second lien debt into first lien secured debt due to the change in the nature of the investment in OEM Group, Inc.

The following table rolls forward the changes in fair value during the year ended December 31, 2013 for investments classified within Level 3:

 

    First lien
secured debt
    Second lien
debt
    Subordinated
debt
    Investments
in funds
    Equity
investments
    Investment
in payment
rights
    CLO
residual
interests
    Totals  

Beginning balance, January 1, 2013

  $ 102,256      $ 70,035      $ 183,319      $ 10,259      $ 6,818      $ 12,262      $ 9,400      $ 394,349   

Purchases

    203,789        129,343        49,645        1,076        2,169        —         29,514        415,536   

Sales and repayments

    (45,377     (44,167     (75,754     (1,273     (469     (100     (1,834     (168,974

Unrealized appreciation (depreciation)(1)

    909        1,188        (5,748     (516     2,519        1,682        275        309   

Net amortization of premiums, discounts and fees

    1,235        1,062        1,837        —         —         —         263        4,397   

PIK

    153        417        2,680        —         —         —         —         3,250   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance, December 31, 2013

  $ 262,965      $ 157,878      $ 155,979      $ 9,546      $ 11,037      $ 13,844      $ 37,618      $ 648,867   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net change in unrealized appreciation from investments still held as of the reporting date(1)

  $ 1,098      $ 1,304      $ (6,086   $ (515   $ 2,519      $ 1,682      $ 275      $ 277   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

All unrealized appreciation (depreciation) in the table above is reflected in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations.

The following provides quantitative information about Level 3 fair value measurements as of December 31, 2014:

 

Description

   Fair Value     

Valuation Technique

   Unobservable
Inputs
  Range
(Average)(1)

First lien secured debt

   $ 393,791       Discounted cash flows (income approach)    Weighted average
cost of capital
(WACC)
  13% - 14% (13%)

Second lien debt

     168,510       Discounted cash flows (income approach)    Weighted average
cost of capital
(WACC)
  11% - 13% (12%)

Subordinated debt

     100,660       Discounted cash flows (income approach)    Weighted average
cost of capital
(WACC)
  15% - 16% (15%)

Investments in funds

     3,388       Net asset value, as a practical expedient    Net asset value   N/A

Equity investments

     42,870       Market comparable companies (market approach)    EBITDA
Multiple
  5.8x - 6.5x (6.2x)
     9,837       Discounted cash flows (income approach)    Weighted average
cost of capital
(WACC)
  15% - 17% (16%)

Investment in Logan JV

     16,741       Net asset value, as a practical expedient    Net asset value   N/A

Investment in payment rights

     13,488       Discounted cash flows (income approach)    Weighted average
cost of capital
(WACC)
  14% - 15% (15%)
         Federal Tax
Rates
  35% - 40% (38%)

CLO residual interests

     34,935       Discounted cash flows (income approach)    Weighted average
cost of capital
(WACC)
  13% - 15% (14%)
         Weighted average
prepayment
premium
  25%
         Weighted average
default rate
  2%
  

 

 

         

Total Investments

   $ 784,220           
  

 

 

         

 

132


Table of Contents

 

(1) 

Ranges were determined using a weighted average based upon the fair value of the investments in each investment category.

The following provides quantitative information about Level 3 fair value measurements as of December 31, 2013:

 

Description:

  Fair Value    

Valuation Technique

 

Unobservable
Inputs

  Range
(Average)(1)

First lien secured debt

  $ 262,965      Discounted cash flows (income approach)   Weighted average cost of capital (WACC)   11% - 13% (12%)

Second lien debt

    157,878      Discounted cash flows (income approach)   Weighted average cost of capital (WACC)   12% - 14% (13%)

Subordinated debt

    155,979      Discounted cash flows (income approach)   Weighted average cost of capital (WACC)   14% - 17% (15%)

Investments in funds

    8,361      Discounted cash flows (income approach)   Weighted average cost of capital (WACC)   13%
    1,185      Net asset value, as a practical expedient   Net asset value   N/A

Equity investments

    10,100      Market comparable companies (market approach)   EBITDA multiple   6.7x - 7.4x (7.1x)
    937      Recent transaction   Sale price   N/A

Investment in payment rights

    13,844      Discounted cash flows (income approach)   Weighted average cost of capital (WACC)   14% - 15% (15%)
      Federal tax rates   35% - 40% (38%)

CLO residual interest

    37,618      Discounted cash flows (income approach)   Weighted average cost of capital (WACC)   14%
      Weighted average prepayment premium   24%
      Weighted average default rate   2%
 

 

 

       

Total investments

  $ 648,867         
 

 

 

       

 

(1) 

Ranges were determined using a weighted average based upon the fair value of the investments in each investment category.

The primary significant unobservable input used in the fair value measurement of the Company’s debt securities (first lien secured debt, second lien debt and subordinated debt), including income-producing investments in funds and income producing securities, payment rights and structured products is the weighted average cost of capital, or WACC. Significant increases (decreases) in the WACC in isolation would result in a significantly lower (higher) fair value measurement. In determining the WACC, for the income, or yield approach, the Company considers current market yields and multiples, portfolio company performance, leverage levels, credit quality, among other factors, including federal tax rates, in its analysis. In the case of structured products, the Company considers prepayment, re-investment and loss assumptions based upon historical and projected performance as well as comparable yields for other similar structured products. In the case of the TRA, the Company considers the risks associated with changes in tax rates, the performance of the portfolio company and the expected term of the investment. Changes in one or more of these factors can have a similar directional change on other factors in determining the appropriate WACC to use in the income approach.

The primary significant unobservable input used in the fair value measurement of the Company’s equity investments is the EBITDA multiple adjusted by management for differences between the investment and referenced comparables, or the Multiple. Significant increases (decreases) in the Multiple in isolation would result in a significantly higher (lower) fair value measurement. To determine the Multiple for the market approach, the Company considers current market trading and/or transaction multiples, portfolio company performance (financial ratios) relative to public and private peer companies and leverage levels, among

 

133


Table of Contents

other factors. Changes in one or more of these factors can have a similar directional change on other factors in determining the appropriate Multiple to use in the market approach.

THL Credit Logan JV LLC

On December 3, 2014, the Company entered into an agreement with Perspecta Trident LLC, an affiliate of Perspecta Trust LLC, or Perspecta,, to create THL Credit Logan JV LLC, or Logan JV, a joint venture, which will invest primarily in senior secured first lien term loans. All Logan JV investment decisions must be unanimously approved by the Logan JV investment committee consisting of one representative from each of the Company and Perspecta.

Logan JV is capitalized with equity contributions which are generally called from its members as transactions are completed. As of December 31, 2014, Logan JV had equity commitments totaling $150,000, of which the Company committed $120,000 and Perspecta committed $30,000. Equity contributions are called from each member pro-rata, based on their equity commitments. As of December 31, 2014, Logan JV had received $8,000 in aggregate capital of which the Company funded $6,400. As of December 31, 2014, Logan JV had called but not yet received an additional $13,000 in aggregate capital of which the Company’s pro-rata share is $10,400 and, which is record as a payable for investments purchased in the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities. As of December 31, 2014, remaining equity commitments to Logan JV totaled $129,000, of which the Company’s share is $103,200 and Perspecta’s share is $25,800, respectively.

The Company has determined that Logan JV is an investment company under ASC 946 and as such the Company will not consolidate our non-controlling interest in Logan JV.

On December 17, 2014, Logan JV entered into a senior credit facility, or the Logan JV Credit Facility, with Deutsche Bank AG which allows Logan JV to borrow up to $50,000 subject to leverage and borrowing base restrictions. The Logan JV Credit Facility can be increased to $200,000 subject to certain conditions. The revolving loan period ends on December 17, 2016 and the final maturity date is December 17, 2019. As of December 31, 2014, Logan JV had no outstanding debt under the credit facility. The Logan JV Credit Facility bears interest at three month LIBOR (with no LIBOR floor) plus 2.50%.

As of December 31, 2014, Logan JV had total investments at fair value of $30,678. As of December 31, 2014, Logan JV’s portfolio was comprised of senior secured first lien loans and a second lien loan to 22 different borrowers. As of December 31, 2014, none of these loans was on non-accrual status. Additionally, as of December 31, 2014, Logan JV had commitments to fund a delayed draw loan to one portfolio company totaling $170. The portfolio companies in Logan JV are in industries similar to those in which the Company may invest directly.

Below is a summary of Logan JV’s portfolio, followed by a listing of the individual loans in Logan JV’s portfolio as of December 31, 2014:

 

     As of December 31,  
     2014  
     (Dollars in thousands)  

First lien secured debt(1)

   $ 30,237   

Second lien debt(1)

     1,000   
  

 

 

 

Total debt investments

   $ 31,237   
  

 

 

 

Weighted average yield on senior secured loans(2)

     6.70

Weighted average yield on second lien loans(2)

     10.0

Number of borrowers in Logan JV

     22   

Largest loan to a single borrower(1)

   $ 2,500   

Total of five largest loans to borrowers(1)

   $ 8,994   

 

(1) 

At current principal amount.

(2) 

Weighted average yield at their current cost.

 

134


Table of Contents

Logan JV Loan Portfolio as of December 31, 2014

(dollar amounts in thousands)

 

Portfolio Company

  Industry   Interest Rate(1)   Initial
Acquisition
Date
    Maturity
Date
    Principal     Amortized
Cost
    Fair
Value(2)
 

Senior Secured First Lien Term Loans

             

Albertson’s Holdings LLC

  Retail   5.5% (LIBOR + 4.5%)     12/05/14        08/25/2021      $ 2,000      $ 2,004      $ 2,003   

American Pacific Corporation

  Chemicals, Plastics &
Rubber
  7% (LIBOR + 6%)     12/10/14        02/27/2019        997        997        996   

AP NMT Acquisition B.V.

  Media: Broadcasting &
Subscription
  6.75% (LIBOR + 5.75%)     12/18/14        08/13/2021        1,496        1,474        1,474   

Avaya Inc.

  Telecommunications   6.5% (LIBOR + 5.5%)     12/18/14        03/31/2018        1,496        1,481        1,476   

BioScrip, Inc.

  Healthcare &
Pharmaceuticals
  6.5% (LIBOR + 5.25%)     12/22/14        07/31/2020        1,500        1,504        1,496   

Birch Communications, Inc.

  Telecommunications   7.75% (LIBOR + 6.75%)     12/05/14        07/17/2020        972        950        957   

Cengage Learning Acquisitions, Inc.

  Media: Advertising,
Printing & Publishing
  7% (LIBOR + 6%)     12/15/14        03/31/2020        2,494        2,470        2,473   

Compuware Corp

  Services: Business   6.25% (LIBOR + 5.25%)     12/11/14        12/15/2021        1,500        1,426        1,427   

CWGS Group, LLC

  Automotive   5.75% (LIBOR + 4.75%)     12/22/14        02/20/2020        1,490        1,494        1,494   

Delta 2 Lux Sarl

  Telecommunications   4.75% (LIBOR + 3.75%)     12/18/14        07/30/2021        1,500        1,466        1,468   

FR Utility Services LLC

  Construction & Building   6.75% (LIBOR + 5.75%)     12/18/14        10/18/2019        1,496        1,493        1,491   

GTCR Valor Companies, Inc.

  Services: Business   6% (LIBOR + 5%)     12/05/14        05/30/2021        995        975        972   

IMG LLC/William Morris Endeavor Entertainment, LLC

  Media: Diversified &
Production
  5.25% (LIBOR + 4.25%)     12/31/14        05/06/2021        1,496        1,463        1,451   

Mood Media Corporation

  Media: Broadcasting &
Subscription
  7% (LIBOR + 6%)     12/05/14        05/01/2019        997        983        979   

Novitex Acquisition, LLC

  Consumer goods: Non-
Durable
  7.5% (LIBOR + 6.25%)     12/05/14        07/07/2020        998        980        958   

Parq Holdings L.P.(3)

  Hotel, Gaming & Leisure   8.5% (LIBOR + 7.5%)     12/05/14        12/17/2020        —          (3     —     

Parq Holdings L.P.

  Hotel, Gaming & Leisure   8.5% (LIBOR + 7.5%)     12/05/14        12/17/2020        830        814        818   

Radio One, Inc.

  Media: Broadcasting &
Subscription
  7.5% (LIBOR + 6%)     12/22/14        03/31/2016        1,496        1,492        1,491   

RentPath, Inc.

  Media: Diversified &
Production
  6.25% (LIBOR + 5.25%)     12/11/14        12/17/2021        1,500        1,470        1,476   

Sirva Worldwide, Inc.

  Transportation: Cargo   7.5% (LIBOR + 6.25%)     12/18/14        03/27/2019        1,496        1,489        1,492   

TOMS Shoes LLC

  Retail   6.5% (LIBOR + 5.5%)     12/18/14        10/31/2020        1,500        1,388        1,388   

Varsity Brands

  Consumer goods:
Durable
  6% (LIBOR + 5%)     12/10/14        12/11/2021        1,000        990        1,001   

Verdesian Life Sciences LLC

  Chemicals, Plastics &
Rubber
  6% (LIBOR + 5%)     12/09/14        07/01/2020        987        986        982   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Senior Secured First Lien Term Loans

            $ 29,786      $ 29,763   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

Second Lien Term Loans

             

RentPath, Inc.

  Media: Diversified &
Production
  10% (LIBOR + 9%)     12/11/14        12/17/22      $ 1,000      $ 911      $ 915   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Second Lien Term Loans

            $ 911      $ 915   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 
            $ 30,697      $ 30,678   
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

Variable interest rates indexed to 30-day, 60-day, 90-day or 180-day LIBOR rates, at the borrower’s option. LIBOR rates are subject to interest rate floors.

(2) 

Represents fair value in accordance with ASC Topic 820. The determination of such fair value is not included in our board of director’s valuation process described elsewhere herein.

(3) 

Represents a delayed draw commitment of $0.2 million, which was unfunded as of December 31, 2014.

 

135


Table of Contents

Below is certain summarized financial information for Logan JV as of December 31, 2014 and for the period from December 3, 2014 (commencement of operations) to December 31, 2014:

Selected Balance Sheet Information

 

     As of
December 31,
2014
 

Investments at fair value (cost of $30,697)

   $ 30,678   

Capital contributions receivable

     13,000   

Cash

     3,898   

Other assets

     898   
  

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 48,474   
  

 

 

 

Payable for investments purchased

   $ 26,732   

Other liabilities

     813   
  

 

 

 

Total liabilities

   $ 27,545   
  

 

 

 

Net assets

   $ 20,929   
  

 

 

 

Total liabilities and net assets

   $ 48,474   
  

 

 

 

Selected Statement of Operations Information

 

     For the period
from
December 3,
2014
(commencement
of operations)
through
December 31,
2014
 

Total revenues

   $ 27   

Total expenses

     79   

Net change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation) on investments

     (19
  

 

 

 

Net decrease in net assets

   $ (71
  

 

 

 

Investment in Tax Receivable Agreement Payment Rights

In June 2012, the Company invested in a TRA that entitles it to certain payment rights, or TRA Payment Rights, from Duff & Phelps Corporation, or Duff & Phelps. The TRA transfers the economic value of certain tax deductions, or tax benefits, taken by Duff & Phelps to the Company and entitles the Company to a stream of payments to be received. The TRA payment right is, in effect, a subordinated claim on the issuing company which can be valued based on the credit risk of the issuer, which includes projected future earnings, the liquidity of the underlying payment right, risk of tax law changes, the effective tax rate and any other factors which might impact the value of the payment right.

Through the TRA, the Company is entitled to receive an annual tax benefit payment based upon 85% of the savings from certain deductions along with interest. The payments that the Company is entitled to receive result from cash savings, if any, in U.S. federal, state or local income tax that Duff & Phelps realizes (i) from the tax savings derived from the goodwill and other intangibles created in connection with the Duff & Phelps initial public offering and (ii) from other income tax deductions. These tax benefit payments will continue until the relevant deductions are fully utilized, which is projected to be 16 years. Pursuant to

 

136


Table of Contents

the TRA, the Company maintains the right to enforce Duff & Phelps payment obligations as a transferee of the TRA contract. If Duff & Phelps chooses to pre-pay and terminate the TRA, the Company will be entitled to the present value of the expected future TRA payments. If Duff & Phelps breaches any material obligation than all obligations are accelerated and calculated as if an early termination occurred. Failure to make a payment is a breach of a material obligation if the failure occurs for more than three months.

The projected annual tax benefit payment will be accrued on a quarterly basis and paid annually. The payment will be allocated between a reduction in the cost basis of the investment and interest income based upon an amortization schedule. Based upon the characteristics of the investment, the Company has chosen to categorize the investment in the TRA payment rights as investment in payment rights in the fair value hierarchy.

The amortized cost basis and fair value of the TRA as of December 31, 2014 was $11,877 and $13,488, respectively. The amortized cost basis and fair value of the TRA as of December 31, 2013 was $12,163 and $13,844, respectively. For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, the Company recognized interest income totaling $2,069, $1,974, and $1,171, respectively, related to the TRA.

Managed Funds

The Advisor and its affiliates may also manage other funds in the future that may have investment mandates that are similar, in whole and in part, with ours. For example, the Advisor may serve as investment adviser to one or more private funds or registered closed-end funds, and presently serves as an investment adviser to a collateralized loan obligation (CLO), THL Credit Wind River 2013-2 CLO, Ltd., THL Credit Wind River 2014-1 CLO, Ltd., THL Credit Wind River 2014-2 CLO, Ltd., and a subadviser to a closed-end fund, THL Credit Senior Loan Fund (NYSE: TSLF). In addition, the Company’s officers may serve in similar capacities for one or more private funds or registered closed-end funds. The Advisor and its affiliates may determine that an investment is appropriate for us and for one or more of those other funds. In such event, depending on the availability of such investment and other appropriate factors, the Advisor or its affiliates may determine that the Company should invest side-by-side with one or more other funds. Any such investments will be made only to the extent permitted by applicable law and interpretive positions of the SEC and its staff, and consistent with the Advisor’s allocation procedures.

Greenway

On January 14, 2011, THL Credit Greenway Fund LLC, or Greenway, was formed as a Delaware limited liability company. Greenway is a portfolio company of the Company. Greenway is a closed-end investment fund which provides for no liquidity or redemption options and is not readily marketable. Greenway operates under a limited liability agreement dated January 19, 2011, or the Agreement. Greenway will continue in existence until January 14, 2021, subject to earlier termination pursuant to certain terms of the Agreement. The term may also be extended for up to three additional one-year periods pursuant to certain terms of the Agreement. Greenway had a two year investment period.

Greenway has $150,000 of capital committed by affiliates of a single institutional investor and is managed by the Company. The Company’s capital commitment to Greenway is $15. The Company’s nominal investment in Greenway is reflected in the December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013 Consolidated Schedules of Investments.

The Company acts as the investment adviser to Greenway and is entitled to receive certain fees relating to its investment management services provided, including a base management fee, a performance fee and a portion of the closing fees on each investment transaction. As a result, Greenway is classified as an affiliate of the Company. For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, the Company earned $940, $1,692 and $2,592 , respectively, in fees related to Greenway, which are included in other income from non-controlled, affiliated investment in the Consolidated Statements of Operations. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $277 and $240 of fees related to Greenway, respectively, were included in due from affiliate on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.

 

137


Table of Contents

Greenway invests in securities similar to those of the Company pursuant to investment and allocation guidelines which address, among other things, the size of the borrowers, the types of transactions and the concentration and investment ratio amongst Greenway and the Company. However, the Company has the discretion to invest in other securities.

Greenway II

On January 31, 2013, THL Credit Greenway Fund II, LLC, or Greenway II LLC, was formed as a Delaware limited liability company and is a portfolio company of the Company. Greenway II LLC is a closed-end investment fund which provides for no liquidity or redemption options and is not readily marketable. Greenway II LLC operates under a limited liability agreement dated February 11, 2013, as amended, or the Greenway II LLC Agreement. Greenway II LLC will continue in existence for eight years from the final closing date, subject to earlier termination pursuant to certain terms of the Greenway II LLC Agreement. The term may also be extended for up to three additional one-year periods pursuant to certain terms of the Greenway II LLC Agreement. Greenway II LLC has a two year investment period.

As contemplated in the Greenway II LLC Agreement, the Company has established a related investment vehicle and entered into an investment management agreement with an account set up by an unaffiliated third party investor to invest alongside Greenway II LLC pursuant to similar economic terms. The account is also managed by the Company. References to “Greenway II” herein include Greenway II LLC and the account of the related investment vehicle. The Company’s capital commitment to Greenway II is $5. The Company’s nominal investment in Greenway II LLC is reflected in the December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013 Consolidated Schedules of Investments. Greenway II LLC is managed by the Company.

The Company acts as the investment adviser to Greenway II and is entitled to receive certain fees relating to its investment management services provided, including a base management fee, a performance fee and a portion of the closing fees on each investment transaction. As a result, Greenway II is classified as an affiliate of the Company. For the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Company earned $2,057 and $1,307, respectively, in fees related to Greenway II, which are included in other income from non-controlled, affiliated investment in the Consolidated Statements of Operations. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $748 and $760, respectively, of fees related to Greenway II were included in due from affiliate on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities. During the year ended December 31, 2013, the Company sold a portion of its investments in seven portfolio companies at fair value, for total proceeds of $19,533, to Greenway II. Fair value was determined in accordance with the Company’s valuation policies.

Other deferred costs consist of placement agent expenses incurred in connection with the offer and sale of partnership interests in Greenway II. These costs are capitalized when the partner signs the Greenway II subscription agreement and are recognized as an expense over the period when the Company expects to collect management fees from Greenway II. For the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Company recognized $225 and $75, respectively, in expenses related to placement agent expenses, which are included in other general and administrative expenses in the Consolidated Statements of Operations. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $600 and $825, respectively, was included in other deferred costs on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.

Greenway II invests in securities similar to those of the Company pursuant to investment and allocation guidelines which address, among other things, the size of the borrowers, the types of transactions and the concentration and investment ratio amongst Greenway II and the Company. However, the Company has the discretion to invest in other securities.

Investment in Funds

LCP Capital Fund LLC

The Company had invested in a membership interest of LCP Capital Fund LLC, or LCP, a private investment company that was organized to participate in investment opportunities that arose when a special

 

138


Table of Contents

purpose entity, or SPE, or sponsor thereof, needed to raise capital to achieve ratings, regulatory, accounting, tax, or other objectives. LCP was a closed investment vehicle which provided for no liquidity or redemption options and was not readily marketable. LCP was managed by an unaffiliated third party. The Company had originally contributed $12,000 of capital in the form of membership interests in LCP, which was invested in an underlying SPE referred to as Series 2005-01.

The Company expected that Series 2005-01 would terminate on February 15, 2015; however, on February 3, 2014, LCP was liquidated and the Company received proceeds of $8,354, which was the remaining value of the Company’s interest.

The Company’s contributed capital in LCP was maintained in a collateral account held by a third-party custodian, who was neither affiliated with the Company nor with LCP, and acted as collateral on certain credit default swaps for the Series 2005-01 for which LCP received fixed premium payments throughout the year, adjusted for expenses incurred by LCP. The SPE purchased assets on a non-recourse basis and LCP agreed to reimburse the SPE up to a specified amount for potential losses. LCP held the contributed cash invested for an SPE transaction in a segregated account that secured the payment obligation of LCP.

CLO Residual Interests

As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Company had investments in the CLO residual interests, or subordinated notes, which can also be structured as income notes. The subordinated notes are subordinated to the secured notes issued in connection with each CLO. The secured notes in each structure are collateralized by portfolios consisting primarily of broadly syndicated senior secured bank loans.

The following table shows a summary of the Company investments in CLO residual interests:

 

                    As of December 31,
2014
    As of December 31,
2013
 

Issuer

 

Security Description

  Ownership
Interest
    Total
CLO
Amount at
initial par
    THL
Credit
Residual
Amount at
Amortized
Cost
    THL
Credit
Residual
Amount at
Fair Value
    THL
Credit
Residual
Amount at
Amortized
Cost
    THL
Credit
Residual
Amount at
Fair Value
 

Adirondack Park CLO Ltd.

  Subordinated Notes, Residual Interest     18.7   $ 517,000      $ 8,172      $ 8,216      $ 9,171      $ 9,110   

Dryden CLO, Ltd.

  Subordinated Notes, Residual Interest     23.1     516,400        8,040        8,244        9,128        9,300   

Flagship VII, Ltd.

  Subordinated Notes, Residual Interest     12.6     441,810        4,105        4,305        4,400        4,400   

Flagship VIII, Ltd.

  Subordinated Notes, Residual Interest     25.1     470,895        8,450        8,450        —          —     

Sheridan Square CLO, Ltd

  Income Notes, Residual Interest     10.4     724,534        5,446        5,720        6,064        6,152   

Octagon Income Note XIV, Ltd.

  Income Notes, Residual Interest     17.7     625,900        —          —          8,579        8,656   
       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  Total CLO residual interestss      $ 34,213      $ 34,935      $ 37,342      $ 37,618   
       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The subordinated notes and income notes do not have a stated rate of interest, but are entitled to receive distributions on quarterly payment dates subject to the priority of payments to secured note holders in the structures if and to the extent funds are available for such purpose. The payments on the subordinated notes and income notes are subordinated not only to the interest and principal claims of all secured notes issued, but to certain administrative expenses, taxes, and the base and subordinated fees paid to the collateral manager. Payments to the subordinated notes and income notes may vary significantly quarter to quarter for a variety of reasons and may be subject to 100% loss. Investments in subordinated notes and income notes, due to the structure of the CLO, can be significantly impacted by change in the market value of the assets, the distributions on the assets, defaults and recoveries on the assets, capital gains and losses on the assets along with prices, interest rates and other risks associated with the assets.

 

139


Table of Contents

For the years ended December 2014, 2013 and 2012, the Company recognized interest income totaling $4,661, $3,536, and $52, respectively, related to CLO residual interests.

Revolving and Unfunded Delayed Draw Loans

For the Company’s investments in revolving and delayed draw loans, the cost basis of the investments purchased is adjusted for the cash received for the discount on the total balance committed. The fair value is also adjusted for price appreciation or depreciation on the unfunded portion. As a result, the purchase of commitments not completely funded may result in a negative value until it is offset by the future amounts called and funded.

Income Taxes, Including Excise Tax

The Company has elected to be taxed as a RIC under Subchapter M of the Code and currently qualifies, and intends to continue to qualify each year, as a RIC under the Code. Accordingly, the Company is not subject to federal income tax on the portion of its taxable income and gains distributed to stockholders.

In order to qualify for favorable tax treatment as a RIC, the Company is required to distribute annually to its stockholders at least 90% of its investment company taxable income, as defined by the Code. To avoid a 4% federal excise tax on undistributed earnings, the Company is required to distribute each calendar year the sum of (i) 98% of its ordinary income for such calendar year (ii) 98.2% of its net capital gains for the one-year period ending October 31 of that calendar year (iii) any income recognized, but not distributed, in preceding years and on which the Company paid no federal income tax. The Company, at its discretion, may choose not to distribute all of its taxable income for the calendar year and pay a non-deductible 4% excise tax on this income. If the Company chooses to do so, all other things being equal, this would increase expenses and reduce the amount available to be distributed to stockholders. To the extent that the Company determines that its estimated current year annual taxable income will be in excess of estimated current year dividend distributions from such taxable income, the Company accrues excise taxes on estimated excess taxable income as taxable income is earned using an annual effective excise tax rate. The annual effective excise tax rate is determined by dividing the estimated annual excise tax by the estimated annual taxable income. See also the disclosure in Note 11, Dividends, for a summary of the dividends paid. For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, the Company incurred excise tax expense of $348, $175 and $125, respectively.

Certain consolidated subsidiaries of the Company are subject to U.S. federal and state income taxes. These taxable entities are not consolidated for income tax purposes and may generate income tax liabilities or assets from permanent and temporary differences in the recognition of items for financial reporting and income tax purposes at the subsidiaries.

 

140


Table of Contents

The following shows the breakdown of current and deferred income tax provisions for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012:

 

     For the years ended December 31,  
         2014              2013              2012      

Current income tax provision:

        

Current income tax provision

   $ 692       $ 336       $ 456   

Current provision for taxes on realized gain on investments

     249         —           —     

Deferred income tax provision:

        

Provision for taxes on unrealized gain on investments

     151         1,960         454   

These current and deferred income taxes are determined from taxable income estimates provided by portfolio companies where the Company holds equity or equity-like investments organized as pass-through entities in its tax blocker corporations. These tax estimates may be subject to further change once tax information is finalized for the year. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $162 and $381, respectively, of income tax receivable was included in prepaid expenses and other assets and $0 and $71, respectively, was included as income taxes payable on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $2,565 and $2,414, respectively, were included in deferred tax liability on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities primarily relating to deferred taxes on unrealized gains on investments held in tax blocker corporations. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $285 and $0, respectively of deferred tax assets were included in prepaid expenses and other assets on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities relating to net operating loss carryforwards that are expected to be used in future periods.

Because federal income tax regulations differ from GAAP, distributions in accordance with tax regulations may differ from net investment income and realized gains recognized for financial reporting purposes. Differences may be permanent or temporary. Permanent differences are reclassified among capital accounts in the consolidated financial statements to reflect their tax character. Temporary differences arise when certain items of income, expense, gain or loss are recognized at some time in the future. Differences in classification may also result from the treatment of short-term gains as ordinary income for tax purposes.

The Company follows the provisions under the authoritative guidance on accounting for and disclosure of uncertainty in tax positions. The provisions require management to determine whether a tax position of the Company is more likely than not to be sustained upon examination, including resolution of any related appeals or litigation processes, based on the technical merits of the position. For tax positions not meeting the more likely than not threshold, the tax amount recognized in the consolidated financial statements is reduced by the largest benefit that has a greater than fifty percent likelihood of being realized upon ultimate settlement with the relevant taxing authority. There are no unrecognized tax benefits or obligations in the accompanying consolidated financial statements. Although the Company files federal and state tax returns, the Company’s major tax jurisdiction is federal. The Company’s inception-to-date federal tax years remain subject to examination by taxing authorities.

Dividends

Dividends and distributions to stockholders are recorded on the applicable record date. The amount to be paid out as a dividend is determined by the Company’s board of directors on a quarterly basis. Net realized capital gains, if any, are generally distributed at least annually out of assets legally available for such distributions, although the Company may decide to retain such capital gains for investment.

Capital transactions in connection with the Company’s dividend reinvestment plan are recorded when shares are issued.

 

141


Table of Contents

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

In June 2013, the FASB issued ASU 2013-08, “Financial Services – Investment Companies (Topic 946): Amendments to the Scope, Measurement, and Disclosure Requirements,” which amends the criteria that define an investment company and clarifies the measurement guidance and requires new disclosures for investment companies. Under ASU 2013-08, an entity already regulated under the 1940 Act will be automatically deemed an investment company under the new GAAP definition. The Company has adopted this standard effective January 1, 2014. The adoption resulted in no additional disclosure requirements.

In February 2015, the FASB issued ASU 2015-02, “Consolidation (Topic 810) – Amendments to the Consolidation Analysis,” which amends the current consolidation guidance and ends the deferral granted to investment companies from applying the VIE guidance. ASU 2015-02 changes the manner in which a reporting entity assesses on of the five characteristics that determine if an entity is a variable interest entity. The Company is currently assessing any additional disclosure requirements. ASU 2015-2 will be effective for annual reporting periods in fiscal years that begin after December 15, 2015.

3. Related Party Transactions

Investment Management Agreement

On March 6, 2015, the Company’s investment management agreement was re-approved by its board of directors, including a majority of our directors who are not interested persons of the Company. Under the investment management agreement, the Advisor, subject to the overall supervision of the Company’s board of directors, manages the day-to-day operations of, and provides investment advisory services to the Company.

The Advisor receives a fee for investment advisory and management services consisting of a base management fee and a two-part incentive fee.

The base management fee is calculated at an annual rate of 1.5% of the Company’s gross assets payable quarterly in arrears on a calendar quarter basis. For purposes of calculating the base management fee, “gross assets” is determined as the value of the Company’s assets without deduction for any liabilities. The base management fee is calculated based on the value of the Company’s gross assets at the end of the most recently completed calendar quarter, and appropriately adjusted for any share issuances or repurchases during the current calendar quarter.

For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, the Company incurred base management fees of $11,142, $7,521 and $4,943, respectively. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $2,810 and $2,243, respectively, was payable to the Advisor.

The incentive fee has two components, ordinary income and capital gains, as follows:

The ordinary income component is calculated, and payable, quarterly in arrears based on our preincentive fee net investment income for the immediately preceding calendar quarter, subject to a cumulative total return requirement and to deferral of non-cash amounts. The preincentive fee net investment income, which is expressed as a rate of return on the value of our net assets attributable to our common stock, for the immediately preceding calendar quarter, will have a 2.0% (which is 8.0% annualized) hurdle rate (also referred to as “minimum income level”). Preincentive fee net investment income means interest income, dividend income and any other income (including any other fees, such as commitment, origination, structuring, diligence, managerial assistance and consulting fees or other fees that we receive from portfolio companies) accrued during the calendar quarter, minus our operating expenses for the quarter (including the base management fee, expenses payable under our administration agreement (discussed below), and any interest expense and any dividends paid on any issued and outstanding preferred stock, but excluding the incentive fee and any offering expenses and other expenses not charged to operations but excluding certain reversals to the extent such reversals have the effect of reducing previously accrued incentive fees based on the deferral of non-cash interest. Preincentive fee net investment income includes, in the case of investments with a deferred interest feature (such as original issue discount, debt instruments with PIK interest and zero coupon securities),

 

142


Table of Contents

accrued income that we have not yet received in cash. The Advisor receives no incentive fee for any calendar quarter in which our preincentive fee net investment income does not exceed the minimum income level. Subject to the cumulative total return requirement described below, the Advisor receives 100% of our preincentive fee net investment income for any calendar quarter with respect to that portion of the preincentive net investment income for such quarter, if any, that exceeds the minimum income level but is less than 2.5% (which is 10.0% annualized) of net assets (also referred to as the “catch-up” provision) and 20.0% of our preincentive fee net investment income for such calendar quarter, if any, greater than 2.5% (10.0% annualized) of net assets. The foregoing incentive fee is subject to a total return requirement, which provides that no incentive fee in respect of our preincentive fee net investment income is payable except to the extent 20.0% of the cumulative net increase in net assets resulting from operations over the then current and 11 preceding calendar quarters exceeds the cumulative incentive fees accrued and/or paid for the 11 preceding quarters. In other words, any ordinary income incentive fee that is payable in a calendar quarter is limited to the lesser of (i) 20% of the amount by which our preincentive fee net investment income for such calendar quarter exceeds the 2.0% hurdle, subject to the “catch-up” provision, and (ii) (x) 20% of the cumulative net increase in net assets resulting from operations for the then current and 11 preceding quarters minus (y) the cumulative incentive fees accrued and/or paid for the 11 preceding calendar quarters. For the foregoing purpose, the “cumulative net increase in net assets resulting from operations” is the amount, if positive, of the sum of our preincentive fee net investment income, base management fees, realized gains and losses and unrealized appreciation and depreciation for the then current and 11 preceding calendar quarters. In addition, the portion of such incentive fee that is attributable to deferred interest (sometimes referred to as payment-in-kind interest, or PIK, or original issue discount, or OID) will be paid to THL Credit Advisors, together with interest thereon from the date of deferral to the date of payment, only if and to the extent we actually receive such interest in cash, and any accrual thereof will be reversed if and to the extent such interest is reversed in connection with any write-off or similar treatment of the investment giving rise to any deferred interest accrual. There is no accumulation of amounts on the hurdle rate from quarter to quarter and accordingly there is no clawback of amounts previously paid if subsequent quarters are below the quarterly hurdle rate and there is no delay of payment if prior quarters are below the quarterly hurdle rate.

For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, the Company incurred $11,868, $10,414 and $7,442, respectively, of incentive fees related to ordinary income. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $3,119 and $2,074, respectively, of such incentive fees are currently payable to the Advisor. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, $1,056 and $1,277, respectively of incentive fees incurred by the Company were generated from deferred interest (i.e. PIK, certain discount accretion and deferred interest) and are not payable until such amounts are received in cash.

The second component of the incentive fee (capital gains incentive fee) is determined and payable in arrears as of the end of each calendar year (or upon termination of the investment management agreement, as of the termination date). This component is equal to 20.0% of the cumulative aggregate realized capital gains from inception through the end of that calendar year, computed net of the cumulative aggregate realized capital losses and cumulative aggregate unrealized capital depreciation through the end of such year. The aggregate amount of any previously paid capital gains incentive fees is subtracted from such capital gains incentive fee calculated. There was no capital gains incentive fee payable to our Advisor under the investment management agreement as of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013.

GAAP requires that the incentive fee accrual considers the cumulative aggregate realized gains and losses and unrealized capital appreciation or depreciation of investments or other financial instruments, such as an interest rate derivative, in the calculation, as an incentive fee would be payable if such realized gains and losses or unrealized capital appreciation or depreciation were realized, even though such realized gains and losses and unrealized capital appreciation or depreciation is not permitted to be considered in calculating the fee actually payable under the investment management agreement (“GAAP Incentive Fee”). There can be no assurance that such unrealized appreciation or depreciation will be realized in the future. Accordingly, such fee, as calculated and accrued, would not necessarily be payable under the investment management agreement, and may never be paid based upon the computation of incentive fees in subsequent periods. For

 

143


Table of Contents

the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, the Company (reversed) incurred $(684), $268 and $(459), respectively, of incentive fees related to the GAAP incentive fee.

Administration Agreement

The Company has also entered into an administration agreement with the Advisor under which the Advisor will provide administrative services to the Company. Under the administration agreement, the Advisor performs, or oversees the performance of administrative services necessary for the operation of the Company, which include, among other things, being responsible for the financial records which the Company is required to maintain and preparing reports to the Company’s stockholders and reports filed with the SEC. In addition, the Advisor assists in determining and publishing the Company’s net asset value, oversees the preparation and filing of the Company’s tax returns and the printing and dissemination of reports to the Company’s stockholders, and generally oversees the payment of the Company’s expenses and the performance of administrative and professional services rendered to the Company by others. The Company will reimburse the Advisor for its allocable portion of the costs and expenses incurred by the Advisor for overhead in performance by the Advisor of its duties under the administration agreement and the investment management agreement, including facilities, office equipment and our allocable portion of cost of compensation and related expenses of our chief financial officer and chief compliance officer and their respective staffs, as well as any costs and expenses incurred by the Advisor relating to any administrative or operating services provided by the Advisor to the Company. Such costs are reflected as administrator expenses in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations. Under the administration agreement, the Advisor provides, on behalf of the Company, managerial assistance to those portfolio companies to which the Company is required to provide such assistance. To the extent that our Advisor outsources any of its functions, the Company pays the fees associated with such functions on a direct basis without profit to the Advisor.

For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, the Company incurred administrator expenses of $3,780, $3,608 and $3,225, respectively. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $0 and $158, respectively, was payable to the Advisor.

License Agreement

The Company and the Advisor have entered into a license agreement with THL Partners, L.P., or THL Partners, under which THL Partners has granted to the Company and the Advisor a non-exclusive, personal, revocable, worldwide, non-transferable license to use the trade name and service mark THL, which is a proprietary mark of THL Partners, for specified purposes in connection with the Company’s and the Advisor’s respective businesses. This license agreement is royalty-free, which means the Company is not charged a fee for its use of the trade name and service mark THL. The license agreement is terminable either in its entirety or with respect to the Company or the Advisor by THL Partners at any time in its sole discretion upon 60 days prior written notice, and is also terminable with respect to either the Company or the Advisor by THL Partners in the case of certain events of non-compliance. After the expiration of its first one year term, the entire license agreement is terminable by either the Company or the Advisor at the Company or its sole discretion upon 60 days prior written notice. Upon termination of the license agreement, the Company and the Advisor must cease to use the name and mark THL, including any use in the Company’s respective legal names, filings, listings and other uses that may require the Company to withdraw or replace the Company’s names and marks. Other than with respect to the limited rights contained in the license agreement, the Company and the Advisor have no right to use, or other rights in respect of, the THL name and mark. The Company is an entity operated independently from THL Partners, and third parties who deal with the Company have no recourse against THL Partners.

Due To and From Affiliates

The Advisor paid certain other general and administrative expenses on behalf of the Company. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $0 and $14, respectively, of expenses were included in due to

 

144


Table of Contents

affiliate on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Company overpaid $145 and $0 of Administrator expense to the Advisor, respectively, which was included in due from affiliate on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.

The Company acts as the investment adviser to Greenway and Greenway II and is entitled to receive certain fees. As a result, Greenway and Greenway II are classified as affiliates of the Company. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $1,026 and $1,011 of total fees and expenses related to Greenway and Greenway II, respectively, were included in due from affiliate on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, $0 and $463 was included in due to affiliate on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities related to the portion of the escrow receivable, due to THL Corporate Finance, Inc., as the administrative agent, to Greenway.

We paid certain professional fees related to organizing Logan JV, on behalf of Logan JV. As of December 31, 2014, $45 of expenses were included in due to affiliate on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.

4. Realized Gains and Losses on Investments, net of income tax provision

The following shows the breakdown of realized gains and losses for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012:

 

     For the years ended December 31,  
         2014              2013              2012      

Escrow receivable settlement(a)

   $ (1,030    $ —         $ —     

BBB Industries, Inc.

     135         —           —     

Blue Coat Systems, Inc.

     563         —           —     

Expert Global Solutions, Inc.

     (250      —           —     

C&K Market, Inc.(b)

     (1,000      —           —     

Jefferson Management Holdings, LLC

     (455      —           —     

Octagon Income Note XIV, Ltd.

     191         —           —     

Surgery Center Holdings, Inc.

     716         688         —     

YP Equity Investors, LLC(c)

     —           2,027         —     

Wingspan Portfolio Holdings, Inc.(d)

     (11,878      —           —     

Other

     153         (111      353   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net realized (losses)/gains

   $ (12,855    $ 2,604       $ 353   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) 

Escrow receivable settlement in connection with arbitration proceedings. Escrow related to the sale of IMDS Corporation in a prior period. In addition to the realized loss, the Company reversed $270 of previously accelerated amortization income against interest income recognized for the year ended December 31, 2014.

(b) 

On August 12, 2014, the date C&K emerged from bankruptcy, the cost basis of the subordinated note, certain interest due and warrants totaling $14,272 were converted to common and preferred equity. In connection with the extinguishment and conversion to equity, the Company recognized a realized loss in the amount of $1,000, which was offset by a corresponding change in unrealized appreciation.

(c)

For the year ended December 31, 2014, an offsetting tax provision of $249 was recorded in the Consolidated Statements of Operations. For the years ending December 31, 2013 and 2012 there was no tax provision. These amounts reflect a revision to previously recognized estimated realized gains and dividend income as a result of adjusted tax estimates from the portfolio company.

(d)

On October 20, 2014, the cost basis of the subordinated note totaling $18,447 was converted to common equity as part of a restructuring of the business. In connection with the extinguishment and conversion to equity of an affiliate, Dimont & Associates, Inc., the Company recognized a realized loss in the amount of $11,878, which was offset by a corresponding change in unrealized appreciation.

 

145


Table of Contents

The change in realized (losses) and gains for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 is primarily attributable to realized losses recognized on C&K Market Inc., and Wingspan Portfolio Holdings, Inc. as a result of converting subordinated debt and warrants into controlling equity ownership interests as part of a restructuring of each business as well as the loss on the IMDS Corporation escrow.

The change in realized (losses) and gains for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012 is primarily attributable to distributions from equity investments in Surgery Center Holdings, Inc. and YP Equity Investors, LLC.

5. Net Increase in Net Assets Per Share Resulting from Operations

The following information sets forth the computation of basic and diluted net increase in net assets per share resulting from operations:

 

     For the years ended December 31,  
         2014              2013              2012      

Numerator—net increase in net assets resulting from operations:

   $ 36,791       $ 42,678       $ 27,617   

Denominator—basic and diluted weighted average common shares:

     33,905         30,287         21,852   

Basic and diluted net increase in net assets per common share resulting from operations:

   $ 1.08       $ 1.41       $ 1.26   

Diluted net increase in net assets per share resulting from operations equals basic net increase in net assets per share resulting from operations for each period because there were no common stock equivalents outstanding during the above periods.

6. Credit Facility

On April 30, 2014, the Company entered into an amendment, or the Revolving Amendment, to its existing revolving credit agreement, or Revolving Facility, and entered into an amendment, or the Term Loan Amendment, to its Term Loan Facility. The Revolving Facility and Term Loan Facility are collectively referred to as the Facilities.

The Revolving Loan Amendment revised the Facility dated May 10, 2012 to, among other things, increase the amount available for borrowing under the Revolving Facility from $232,000 to $303,500 and extend the maturity date from May 2017 to April 2018 (with a one year term out period beginning in April 2017). The one year term out period is the one year anniversary between the revolver termination date, or the end of the availability period, and the maturity date. During this time, the Company is required to make mandatory prepayments on its loans from the proceeds it receives from the sale of assets, extraordinary receipts, returns of capital or the issuances of equity or debt. The Revolving Amendment also changes the interest rate of the Revolving Facility to LIBOR plus 2.5% (with no LIBOR floor). The non-use fee is 1.0% annually if the Company uses 35% or less of the Revolving Facility and 0.50% annually if the Company uses more than 35% of the Revolving Facility. The Company elects the LIBOR rate on the loans outstanding on its Revolving Facility, which can have a maturity date that is one, two, three or nine months. The LIBOR rate on the borrowings outstanding on its Revolving Facility currently has a one month maturity.

The Term Loan Amendment revised the Term Loan Facility dated May 10, 2012 to, among other things, increase the amount borrowed from $93,000 to $106,500 and extend the maturity date from May 2018 to April 2019. The Term Loan Amendment also changes the interest rate of the Term Loan Facility to LIBOR plus 3.25% (with no LIBOR Floor) and has substantially similar terms to the existing Revolving Facility (as amended by the Revolving Amendment). The Company elects the LIBOR rate on its Term Loan, which can have a maturity date that is one, two, three or nine months. The LIBOR rate on its Term Loan currently has a one month maturity.

 

146


Table of Contents

Each of the Facilities includes an accordion feature permitting the Company to expand the Facilities if certain conditions are satisfied; provided, however, that the aggregate amount of the Facilities, collectively, is capped at $600,000.

The Facilities generally require payment of interest on a quarterly basis for ABR loans (commonly based on the Prime Rate or the Federal Funds Rate), and at the end of the applicable interest period for Eurocurrency loans bearing interest at LIBOR, the interest rate benchmark used to determine the variable rates paid on the Facilities. LIBOR maturities can range between one and nine months at the election of the Company. All outstanding principal is due upon each maturity date. The Facilities also require a mandatory prepayment of interest and principal upon certain customary triggering events (including, without limitation, the disposition of assets or the issuance of certain securities).

Borrowings under the Facilities are subject to, among other things, a minimum borrowing/collateral base. The Facilities have certain collateral requirements and/or financial covenants, including covenants related to: (a) limitations on the incurrence of additional indebtedness and liens, (b) limitations on certain investments, (c) limitations on certain restricted payments, (d) limitations on the creation or existence of agreements that prohibit liens on certain properties of the Company and its subsidiaries, and (e) compliance with certain financial maintenance standards including (i) minimum stockholders’ equity, (ii) a ratio of total assets (less total liabilities not represented by senior securities) to the aggregate amount of senior securities representing indebtedness, of the Company and its subsidiaries, of not less than 2.10:1.0, (iii) minimum liquidity, (iv) minimum net worth, and (v) a consolidated interest coverage ratio. In addition to the financial maintenance standards, described in the preceding sentence, borrowings under the Facilities (and the incurrence of certain other permitted debt) are subject to compliance with a borrowing base that applies different advance rates to different types of assets in the Company’s portfolio.

The Facilities’ documents also include default provisions such as the failure to make timely payments under the Facilities, the occurrence of a change in control, and the failure by the Company to materially perform under the operative agreements governing the Facilities, which, if not complied with, could, at the option of the lenders under the Facilities, accelerate repayment under the Facilities, thereby materially and adversely affecting the Company’s liquidity, financial condition and results of operations. Each loan originated under the Revolving Facility is subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions. The Company cannot be assured that it will be able to borrow funds under the Revolving Facility at any particular time or at all. The Company is currently in compliance with all financial covenants under the Facilities.

For the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company borrowed $334,800 and repaid $244,249 under the Facilities. For the year ended December 31, 2013, the Company borrowed $453,700 and repaid $299,400 under the Facilities. For the year ended December 31, 2012, the Company borrowed $189,900 and repaid $144,900 under the Facilities.

 

147


Table of Contents

The following shows a summary of the Revolving Facility and Term Loan Facility as of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013:

 

As of December 31, 2014                     
in thousands                     

Facility

   Commitments      Borrowings
Outstanding
     Weighted
Average
Interest Rate
 

Revolving Facility

   $ 303,500       $ 188,351         2.69

Term Loan Facility

     106,500         106,500         3.44
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

Total

   $ 410,000       $ 294,851         2.96
  

 

 

    

 

 

    
As of December 31, 2013                     
in thousands                     

Facility

   Commitments      Borrowings
Outstanding
     Weighted
Average
Interest Rate
 

Revolving Facility

   $ 232,000       $ 111,300         3.19

Term Loan Facility

     93,000         93,000         4.17
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

Total

   $ 325,000       $ 204,300         3.63
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the carrying amount of the Company’s outstanding Facilities approximated fair value. The fair values of the Company’s Facilities are determined in accordance with ASC 820, which defines fair value in terms of the price that would be paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date under current market conditions. The fair value of the Company’s Facilities are estimated based upon market interest rates and entities with similar credit risk. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the Facilities would be deemed to be Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.

Interest expense and related fees, excluding amortization of deferred financing costs, of $9,781, $5,623 and $3,138 were incurred in connection with the Facilities during the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

In accordance with the 1940 Act, with certain exceptions, the Company is only allowed to borrow amounts such that its asset coverage, as defined in the 1940 Act, is at least 200% after such borrowing. The asset coverage as of December 31, 2014 is in excess of 200%.

7. Notes

On November 18, 2014, we closed a public offering of $50,000 in aggregate principal amount of 6.75% notes, or the Notes. The Notes mature on November 15, 2021, and may be redeemed in whole or in part at any time or from time to time at our option on or after November 15, 2017. The Notes bear interest at a rate of 6.75% per year payable quarterly on March 30, June 30, September 30 and December 30, of each year, beginning December 30, 2014 and trade on the New York Stock Exchange under the trading symbol “TCRX.”

As of December 31, 2014, the carrying amount and fair value of our Notes was $50,000 and $51,620, respectively. The fair value of our Notes are determined in accordance with ASC 820, which defines fair value in terms of the price that would be paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date under current market conditions. The fair value of the Notes is based on the closing price of the security, which is a Level 2 input under ASC 820 due to the trading volume. In connection with the issuance of the Notes, we incurred $2,109 of fees and expenses. These amounts were capitalized and are being amortized using the effective yield method over the term of the Notes. For the year ended December 31, 2014, we amortized approximately $36 of deferred financing costs, which is listed

 

148


Table of Contents

under Amortization of Deferred Financing Costs on the Consolidated Statements of Operations. As of December 31, 2014, we had approximately $2,073 of remaining deferred financing costs on the Notes, which is listed under Deferred Financing Costs on our Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.

For the year ending December 31, 2014, we incurred interest expense on the Notes of approximately $394. This interest expense was paid on December 30, 2014.

The indenture and supplements relating to the Notes contain certain covenants, including but not limited to (i) an inability to incur additional borrowings, including through the issuance of additional debt or the sale of additional debt securities unless the Company’s asset coverage, as defined in the 1940 Act, is at least 200% after such borrowing and (ii) if we are not subject to the reporting requirements under the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934 to file periodic reports with the SEC we will provide interim and consolidated financial information to the holders of the Notes and the trustee.

8. Interest Rate Derivative

On May 10, 2012, the Company entered into a five-year interest rate swap agreement, or swap agreement, with ING Capital Markets, LLC. Under the swap agreement, with a notional value of $50,000, the Company pays a fixed rate of 1.1425% and receives a floating rate based upon the current three-month LIBOR rate. The Company entered into the swap agreement to manage interest rate risk and not for speculative purposes.

The Company records the change in valuation of the swap agreement in unrealized appreciation (depreciation) as of each measurement period. When the quarterly interest rate swap amounts are paid or received under the swap agreement, the amounts are recorded as a realized gain (loss) through interest rate derivative periodic interest payments, net on the Consolidated Statement of Operations.

The Company recognized a realized loss for years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 of $458, $433 and $180, respectively, which is reflected as interest rate derivative periodic interest payments, net on the Consolidated Statements of Operations.

For the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Company recognized $71 and $769, respectively, of net change in unrealized depreciation from the swap agreement, which is listed under net change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation) on interest rate derivative in the Consolidated Statements of Operations. As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the Company’s fair value of its swap agreement is ($213) and ($284), respectively, which is listed as an interest rate derivative liability on the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.

9. Contractual Obligations and Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

From time to time, the Company, or the Advisor, may become party to legal proceedings in the ordinary course of business, including proceedings related to the enforcement of the Company’s rights under contracts with its portfolio companies. Neither the Company, nor the Advisor, is currently subject to any material legal proceedings.

Unfunded commitments to provide funds to portfolio companies are not reflected on the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities. The Company’s unfunded commitments may be significant from time to time. These commitments will be subject to the same underwriting and ongoing portfolio maintenance as are the on-balance sheet financial instruments that the Company holds. Since these commitments may expire without being drawn upon, the total commitment amount does not necessarily represent future cash requirements. The Company intends to use cash flow from normal and early principal repayments and proceeds from borrowings and offerings to fund these commitments. Funding to Logan JV will only be made pursuant to unanimous approval from the Company and Perspecta.

 

149


Table of Contents

As of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the Company has the following unfunded commitments to portfolio companies:

 

     As of  
     December 31, 2014      December 31, 2013  

Unfunded delayed draw facilities

   $ 29,826       $ 9,500   

Unfunded revolving commitments

     4,478         9,200   

Unfunded commitments to investments in funds

     1,854         3,970   

Unfunded commitments to Logan JV

     113,600         —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total unfunded commitments

   $ 149,758       $ 22,670   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

10. Distributable Taxable Income

The following reconciles net increase in net assets resulting from operations to taxable income:

 

     For the years ended December 31,  
             2014                      2013          

Net increase in net assets resulting from operations

   $ 36,791       $ 42,678   

Net change in unrealized depreciation on investments

     (2,243      (309

Provision for taxes on unrealized gain on investments

     151         1,960   

Net change in unrealized depreciation on interest rate derivative

     (71      (769

Expenses not currently deductible and income and realized losses not currently includable

     13,767         704   

Non-deductible expenses and income not includable

     1,316         150   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Taxable income before deductions for dividends paid or deemed paid

   $ 49,711       $ 44,414   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The above amount of 2014 taxable income before deductions for dividends is an estimate. Taxable income will be finalized before the Company files its Federal tax return by September 2015.

The tax character of distributions declared and paid in 2014 represented $44,191 from ordinary income, $1,921 from capital gains and $0 from tax return of capital. The tax character of distributions declared and paid in 2013 represented $42,999 from ordinary income, $400 from capital gains and $0 from tax return of capital. Generally accepted accounting principles require adjustments to certain components of net assets to reflect permanent differences between financial and tax reporting. These adjustments have no affect on net asset value per share.

For the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Company recorded the following adjustments for permanent book to tax differences to reflect their tax characteristics. The adjustments only change the classification in net assets in the Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities.

 

     For the years ended December 31,  
         2014              2013      

Accumulated undistributed net realized gains (losses)

   $ (358    $ (529

Accumulated undistributed net investment income

     1,216         (54

Interest rate derivative periodic interest payments, net

     458         433   

Paid-in capital in excess of par

     (1,316      150   

At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the cost of investments for tax purposes was $796,456 and $647,021, respectively, resulting in net unrealized (depreciation) appreciation of $(12,236) and $1,846 , respectively. At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Company had estimated net operating losses of $712 and $0, respectively, which can be carried back to the two preceding tax years or carried forward twenty years before expiration. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Company had estimated net capital loss carryforwards not subject to expiration of $584 and $0, respectively.

 

150


Table of Contents

11. Dividends

The Company has elected to be taxed as a RIC under Subchapter M of the Code. In order to maintain its status as a RIC, it is required to distribute annually to its stockholders at least 90% of its investment company taxable income, as defined by the Code. To avoid a 4% excise tax on undistributed earnings, the Company is required to distribute each calendar year the sum of (i) 98% of its ordinary income for such calendar year (ii) 98.2% of its net capital gains for the one-year period ending October 31 of that calendar year (iii) any income recognized, but not distributed, in preceding years and on which the Company paid no federal income tax. The Company intends to make distributions to stockholders on a quarterly basis of substantially all of its net investment income. In addition, although the Company intends to make distributions of net realized capital gains, if any, at least annually, out of assets legally available for such distributions, it may in the future decide to retain such capital gains for investment.

In addition, the Company may be limited in its ability to make distributions due to the BDC asset coverage test for borrowings applicable to the Company as a BDC under the 1940 Act.

The following table summarizes the Company’s dividends declared and paid or to be paid on all shares, including dividends reinvested, if any:

 

Date Declared    Record Date    Payment Date    Amount Per Share

August 5, 2010

   September 2, 2010    September 30, 2010    $0.05

November 4, 2010

   November 30, 2010    December 28, 2010    $0.10

December 14, 2010

   December 31, 2010    January 28, 2011    $0.15

March 10, 2011

   March 25, 2011    March 31, 2011    $0.23

May 5, 2011

   June 15, 2011    June 30, 2011    $0.25

July 28, 2011

   September 15, 2011    September 30, 2011    $0.26

October 27, 2011

   December 15, 2011    December 30, 2011    $0.28

March 6, 2012

   March 20, 2012    March 30, 2012    $0.29

March 6, 2012

   March 20, 2012    March 30, 2012    $0.05

May 2, 2012

   June 15, 2012    June 29, 2012    $0.30

July 26, 2012

   September 14, 2012    September 28, 2012    $0.32

November 2, 2012

   December 14, 2012    December 28, 2012    $0.33

December 20, 2012

   December 31, 2012    January 28, 2013    $0.05

February 27, 2013

   March 15, 2013    March 29, 2013    $0.33

May 2, 2013

   June 14, 2013    June 28, 2013    $0.34

August 2, 2013

   September 16, 2013    September 30, 2013    $0.34

August 2, 2013

   September 16, 2013    September 30, 2013    $0.08

October 30, 2013

   December 16, 2013    December 31, 2013    $0.34

March 4, 2014

   March 17, 2014    March 31, 2014    $0.34

May 7, 2014

   June 16, 2014    June 30, 2014    $0.34

August 7, 2014

   September 15, 2014    September 30, 2014    $0.34

November 4, 2014

   December 15, 2014    December 31, 2014    $0.34

March 6, 2015

   March 20, 2015    March 31, 2015    $0.34

The Company may not be able to achieve operating results that will allow it to make distributions at a specific level or to increase the amount of these distributions from time to time. If the Company does not distribute a certain percentage of its income annually, it will suffer adverse tax consequences, including possible loss of its status as a regulated investment company. The Company cannot assure stockholders that they will receive any distributions at a particular level.

The Company maintains an “opt in” dividend reinvestment plan for our common stockholders. As a result, unless stockholders specifically elect to have their dividends automatically reinvested in additional shares of common stock, stockholders will receive all such dividends in cash. There were no dividends reinvested for the year ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 under the dividend reinvestment plan. With respect to our dividends and distributions paid to stockholders during the year ended December 31, 2012, dividends reinvested pursuant to our dividend reinvestment plan totaled $26.

 

151


Table of Contents

Under the terms of our dividend reinvestment plan, dividends will primarily be paid in newly issued shares of common stock. However, the Company reserves the right to purchase shares in the open market in connection with the implementation of the plan. This feature of the plan means that, under certain circumstances, the Company may issue shares of our common stock at a price below net asset value per share, which could cause our stockholders to experience dilution.

Distributions in excess of our current and accumulated profits and earnings would be treated first as a return of capital to the extent of the stockholder’s tax basis, and any remaining distributions would be treated as a capital gain. The determination of the tax attributes of our distributions will be made annually as of the end of our fiscal year based upon our taxable income for the full year and distributions paid for the full year. Therefore, a determination made on a quarterly basis may not be representative of the actual tax attributes of our distributions for a full year. Each year, a statement on Form 1099-DIV identifying the source of the distribution will be mailed to the Company’s stockholders of record.

12. Financial Highlights

 

     For the years ended December 31,  
     2014     2013     2012     2011     2010  

Per Share Data:

          

Net asset value, beginning of period

   $ 13.36      $ 13.20      $ 13.24      $ 13.06      $ 12.99   

Net investment income, after taxes(1)

     1.42        1.37        1.38        1.04        0.31   

Net realized (loss) gains on investments(1)

     (0.38     0.09        0.01        0.05        —     

Income tax provision, realized gain(1)

     (0.01     —          —          —          —     

Net change in unrealized appreciation on investments(1)(2)

     0.06        0.01        (0.06     0.11        0.06   

Provision for taxes on unrealized gain on investments(1)

     —          (0.07     (0.02     —          —     

Net change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation) of interest rate derivative(1)(2)

     —          0.02        (0.06     —          —     

Interest rate derivative periodic interest payments, net

     (0.01     (0.01     —          —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase in net assets resulting from operations

     1.08        1.41        1.25        1.20        0.37   

Accretive effect of share issuance

     —          0.18        0.05        —          —     

Distributions to stockholders from net investment income

     (1.30     (1.42     (1.29     (1.02     (0.30

Distributions to stockholders from net realized gains

     (0.06     (0.01     (0.05     —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net asset value, end of period

   $ 13.08      $ 13.36      $ 13.20      $ 13.24      $ 13.06   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Per share market value at end of period

   $ 11.76      $ 16.49      $ 14.79      $ 12.21      $ 13.01   

Total return(3)

     (20.96 %)      22.10     33.43     1.87     2.38

Shares outstanding at end of period

     33,905        33,905        26,315        20,220        19,616   

Ratio/Supplemental Data:

          

Net assets at end of period

   $ 443,621      $ 452,942      $ 347,484      $ 267,617      $ 260,016   

Ratio of total expenses to average net assets(4)

     9.79     8.73     8.14     6.18     3.47

Ratio of net investment income to average net assets

     10.70     10.25     10.39     7.94     3.39

Portfolio turnover

     28.98     33.09     53.95     15.43     8.63

 

(1) 

Calculated based on weighted average common shares outstanding.

(2) 

Includes the cumulative effect of rounding.

(3) 

Total return is based on the change in market price per share during the period. Total return takes into account dividends and distributions, if any, reinvested in accordance with the Company’s dividend reinvestment plan.

 

152


Table of Contents
(4) 

For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, 2012, 2011 and 2010, the ratio components included 2.47%, 1.86%, 1.72%, 1.51% and 1.49% of base management fee, 2.48%, 2.64%, 2.43%, 1.80% and 0.00% of incentive fee, 2.47%, 1.76%, 1.43%, 0.65% and 0.00% of the cost of borrowing, 2.05%, 1.85%, 2.19%, 2.20% and 1.95% of other operating expenses, and 0.09%, 0.49%, 0.16%, 0.00% and 0.00% of the impact of all taxes, respectively.

13. Subsequent Events

From January 1, 2015 through March 10, 2015, the Company made follow-on investments totaling $15,347 in the industrials, transportation and financial services industries. Of the follow-on investments, 47.9% were floating rate first lien secured debt investments and 52.1% were an investment in funds. The follow-on debt investments had a weighted average yield based upon cost at the time of the investment of 10.4%.

From January 1, 2015 through March 10, 2015, the Company sold $9,987 of a first lien secured term loan in Charming Charlie, LLC and $3,000 of a second lien term loan in BBB Industries and recognized a nominal gain.

On February 12, 2015, the Company received proceeds of $16,910 from the prepayment of a subordinated term loan in The Studer Group, LLC at par.

On February 24, 2015, the Company received proceeds of $16,181 from the prepayment of a subordinated term loan in Country Pure Foods, LLC at par.

On March 6, 2015, the Company’s investment management agreement was re-approved by the Company’s board of directors.

On March 6, 2015, the Company’s board of directors declared a dividend of $0.34 per share payable on March 31, 2015 to stockholders of record at the close of business on March 20, 2015.

On March 6, 2015, the Company’s board of directors authorized a $25.0 million stock repurchase program. The timing and amount of any stock repurchases will depend on the terms and conditions of the repurchase program and no assurances can be given that any common stock, or any particular amount, will be purchased. The Company will provide our stockholders with notice of our intention to repurchase shares of our common stock in accordance with 1940 Act requirements. Unless extended by the Company’s board of directors, the stock repurchase program will terminate on March 6, 2016 and may be modified or terminated at any time for any reason without prior notice.

On March 6, 2015, upon the recommendation of the Governance Committee, the Company’s Board of Directors approved the appointment of Sam W. Tillinghast and Christopher J. Flynn as directors of the Company, with immediate effect.

As of March 10, 2015, Logan JV has $49,907 of investments in 37 companies with a weighted average yield, based upon cost at the time of the investment, of 7.0%.

 

153


Table of Contents

Schedule 12-14

THL Credit, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Schedule of Investments in and Advances to Affiliates

(dollar amounts in thousands)

 

Type of Investment/Portfolio company(1)

  Amount of
interest or fees
credited in
income(2)
    Fair Value at
December 31,
2013
    Gross
Additions(3)
    Gross
Reductions(4)
    Fair Value at
December 31,
2014
 

Control Investments

         

C&K Market, Inc.(5)

         

1,967,367 shares of common stock

  $ 150      $ —        $ 6,036      $ —        $ 6,036   

1,967,367 shares of preferred stock

    —          —          10,956        (1,119     9,837   

Dimont & Associates, Inc.(6)

         

Subordinated term loan 11.0% PIK due 4/16/2018

    104        —          4,556          4,556   

50,004 shares of common stock

    —          —          6,569        (4,569     2,000   

Thibaut, Inc

         

Senior secured term loan 12.0% cash due 6/19/19

    423        —          6,552        (32     6,520   

4,747 shares of series A preferred stock

    83        —          4,874        —          4,874   

20,639 shares of common stock

    —          —          785        —          785   

THL Credit Logan JV LLC(7)

         

80% economic interest

    —          —          16,800        (59     16,741   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Control Investments

  $ 760      $ —        $ 57,128      $ (5,779   $ 51,349   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Affiliate Investments

         

THL Credit Greenway Fund LLC(8)

         

Investment in fund

    940        5        —          (1     4   

THL Credit Greenway Fund II LLC(8)

         

Investment in fund

    2,057        2        3        —          5   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Affiliate Investments

  $ 2,997      $ 7      $ 3      $ (1   $ 9   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Control and Affiliate Investments

  $ 3,757      $ 7      $ 57,131      $ (5,780   $ 51,358   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

The principal amount and ownership detail as shown in the Consolidated Schedule of Investments as of December 31, 2014. Common stock and preferred stock, in some cases, are generally non-income producing.

(2)

Represents the total amount of interest and fees credited to income for the portion of the year an investment was included in the Control and Affiliate categories

(3)

Gross additions include increases in the cost basis of investments resulting from new portfolio investments, follow-on investments, accrued PIK interest and the exchange of one or more existing securities for one or more new securities. Gross additions also include net increases in unrealized appreciation.

(4)

Gross reductions include decreases in the cost basis of investments resulting from principal payments or sales and exchanges of one or more existing securities for one or more new securities. Gross reductions also include net increases in unrealized depreciation.

(5)

C&K Market, Inc., or C&K, filed for bankruptcy in November 2013. On August 12, 2014, the date C&K emerged from bankruptcy, the cost basis of the senior subordinated note, certain interest due and warrants totaling $14,272 were converted to common and preferred equity.

(6) 

On October 20, 2014, THL Credit restructured its investment in Wingspan Portfolio Holdings, Inc., or Wingspan. As part of the restructuring, THL Credit exchanged the cost basis of its subordinated term loan totaling $18,447 for a controlled equity position of an affiliated entity, Dimont Acquisition Inc., or Dimont.

 

154


Table of Contents
(7) 

Together with Perspecta Trident LLC, or Perspecta, an affiliate of Perspecta Trust LLC, the Company invests in THL Credit Logan JV LLC, of Logan JV. Logan JV is capitalized through equity contributions from its members and investment decisions must be unanimously approved by the Logan JV investment committee consisting of one representative from each of the Company and Perspecta.

(8)

Income includes certain fees relating to investment management services provided by the Company, including a base management fee, a performance fee and a portion of the closing fees on each investment transaction.

 

155


Table of Contents
Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

None.

 

Item 9A. Controls and Procedures

(a) Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

Our Co-Chief Executive Officers and Chief Financial Officer, under the supervision and with the participation of our management, conducted an evaluation of our disclosure controls and procedures, as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. As of the end of the period covered by this annual report on Form 10-K, our Co-Chief Executive Officers and Chief Financial Officer have concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were effective to ensure that information required to be disclosed by us in reports that we file or submit under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 is recorded, processed, summarized, and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms, and that information required to be disclosed by us in the reports that we file or submit under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 is accumulated and communicated to our management, including our Co-Chief Executive Officers and Chief Financial Officer, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.

(b) Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

The management of THL Credit, Inc. and its Subsidiaries (except where the context suggests otherwise, the terms “we,” “us,” “our,” and “THL Credit” refer to THL Credit, Inc. and its Subsidiaries) is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting as such term is defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(f), and for performing an assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014. Internal control over financial reporting is a process designed by, or under the supervision of, our principal executive and principal financial officers, or persons performing similar functions, and effected by our board of directors, management and other personnel, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. Our internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that in reasonable detail accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of our assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Therefore, even those systems determined to be effective can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation and presentation.

Management performed an assessment of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014 based upon the criteria set forth in Internal Control—Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”). Based on our assessment, management determined that our internal control over financial reporting was effective as of December 31, 2014.

(c) Report of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

The effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014 has been audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report which appears herein.

 

156


Table of Contents

(d) Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

There have been no changes in our internal control over financial reporting, as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 that occurred during our most recently completed fiscal quarter that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.

 

Item 9B. Other Information

On March 6, 2015, upon the recommendation of the Governance Committee, our Board of Directors approved the appointment of Sam W. Tillinghast and Christopher J. Flynn as directors of the Company, with immediate effect. Both Messrs. Tillinghast and Flynn are interested directors as a result of their role as our Co-Chief Executive Officers and Co-Chief Investment Officers. Neither Mr. Tillinghast nor Mr. Flynn will receive any additional compensation for their role as an interested director.

In connection with the appointment, the Board approved expanding the size of the Board from seven to nine directors. Each of the Company’s directors hold office until the next annual meeting of stockholders (the “Annual Meeting”) or until his or her successor is duly elected and qualified or such director’s earlier resignation, death or removal. As a result, the current terms for Messrs. Tillinghast and Flynn will expire at the 2015 Annual Meeting unless each is re-elected.

There is no arrangement or understanding under which Messrs. Tillinghast and Flynn were appointed. There are no transactions involving either Mr. Tillinghast or Mr. Flynn requiring disclosure under Item 404(a) of Regulation S-K.

 

157


Table of Contents

PART III

We will file a definitive Proxy Statement for our 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders with the Securities and Exchange Commission pursuant to Regulation 14A, not later than 120 days after the end of our fiscal year. Accordingly, certain information required by Part III has been omitted under General Instruction G(3) to Form 10-K. Only those sections of our definitive Proxy Statement that specifically address the items set forth herein are incorporated by reference.

 

Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

The information required by Item 10 is hereby incorporated by reference from our definitive Proxy Statement relating to our 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, to be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission within 120 days following the end of our fiscal year.

 

Item 11. Executive Compensation

The information required by Item 11 is hereby incorporated by reference from our definitive Proxy Statement relating to our 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, to be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission within 120 days following the end of our fiscal year.

 

Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

The information required by Item 12 is hereby incorporated by reference from our definitive Proxy Statement relating to our 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, to be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission within 120 days following the end of our fiscal year.

 

Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence.

The information required by Item 13 is hereby incorporated by reference from our definitive Proxy Statement relating to our 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, to be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission within 120 days following the end of our fiscal year.

 

Item 14. Principal Accountant Fees and Services

The information required by Item 14 is hereby incorporated by reference from our definitive Proxy Statement relating to our 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, to be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission within 120 days following the end of our fiscal year.

 

158


Table of Contents

PART IV

 

Item 15. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

The following documents are filed or incorporated by reference as part of this Annual Report:

1. Consolidated Financial Statements

 

     Page  

Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     106   

Consolidated Statements of Assets and Liabilities as of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013

     107   

Consolidated Statements of Operations for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012

     108   

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Net Assets for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012

     109   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012

     110   

Consolidated Schedules of Investments as of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2012

     111   

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

     123   

2. Financial Statement Schedule

Schedule 12-14 – Page 154

3. Exhibits required to be filed by Item 601 of Regulation S-K

Please note that the agreements included as exhibits to this Form 10-K are included to provide information regarding their terms and are not intended to provide any other factual or disclosure information about us or the other parties to the agreements. The agreements contain representations and warranties by each of the parties to the applicable agreement that have been made solely for the benefit of the other parties to the applicable agreement and may not describe the actual state of affairs as of the date they were made or at any other time.

The following exhibits are filed as part of this report or hereby incorporated by reference to exhibits previously filed with the SEC:

 

3.1    Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s pre-effective Amendment No. 4 to the Registration Statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, on Form N-2, filed on April 20, 2010)
3.2    Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation (Incorporated by reference from Exhibit A to the Registrant’s Proxy Statement, filed on April 24, 2012)
3.3    Bylaws (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s pre-effective Amendment No. 1 to the Registration Statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, on Form N-2, filed on July 15, 2009)
4    Form of Specimen Certificate (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s pre-effective Amendment No. 4 to the Registration Statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, on Form N-2, filed on April 20, 2010)
4.2    Form of Indenture and related exhibits. (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s pre-effective Amendment No. 1 to the Registration Statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, on Form N-2, filed on August 25, 2011).
4.3    First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of November 18, 2014, between the Registrant and U.S. Bank National Association. (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form N-2 filed on November 18, 2014).
4.4    Form of 6.75% Note due 2021 (included as part of Exhibit 4.3).

 

159


Table of Contents
4.5    Form of 6.75% Note due 2021 (Over-Allotment Note) (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s post-effective Amendment No. 2 to the Registration Statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, on Form N-2, filed on December 11, 2014).
10.1    Dividend Reinvestment Plan (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q, filed on August 9, 2010)
10.2    Investment Management Agreement (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s pre-effective Amendment No. 4 to the Registration Statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, on Form N-2, filed on April 20, 2010)
10.3    Purchase Agreement (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q, filed on August 9, 2010)
10.4    Custodian Agreement (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q, filed on August 9, 2010)
10.5    Administration Agreement (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s pre-effective Amendment No. 4 to the Registration Statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, on Form N-2, filed on April 20, 2010)
10.6    Sub-Administration Agreement (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q, filed on August 9, 2010)
10.7    Purchase and Sale Agreement (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s pre-effective Amendment No. 4 to the Registration Statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, on Form N-2, filed on April 20, 2010)
10.8    License Agreement (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s pre-effective Amendment No. 4 to the Registration Statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, on Form N-2, filed on April 20, 2010)
10.9    Subscription Agreement—THL Credit Opportunities, L.P. (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s pre-effective Amendment No. 4 to the Registration Statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, on Form N-2, filed on April 20, 2010)
10.10    Subscription Agreement—THL Credit Partners BDC Holdings, L.P. (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q, filed on August 9, 2010)
10.11    Senior Secured Revolving Credit Agreement between THL Credit and ING Capital LLC, dated March 11, 2011 (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on March 15, 2011)
10.12    Amendment No. 1 to Senior Secured Revolving Credit Agreement between THL Credit and ING Capital LLC, dated May 10, 2012 (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on May 15, 2012)
10.13    Amendment No. 2 to Senior Secured Revolving Credit Agreement between THL Credit and ING Capital LLC, dated February 13, 2013 (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K, filed on March 7, 2014)
10.14    Amendment No. 3 to Senior Secured Revolving Credit Agreement between THL Credit and ING Capital LLC, dated March 15, 2013 (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on March 20, 2013)
10.15    Amendment No. 4 to Senior Secured Revolving Credit Agreement between THL Credit and ING Capital LLC, dated October 9, 2013 (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q, filed on November 4, 2013)
10.16    Amendment No. 5 to the Senior Secured Revolving Credit Agreement, dated as of April 30, 2014, by and among the Company as borrower, each of the subsidiary guarantors party thereto, the Lenders party thereto and ING Capital LLC, as Administrative Agent. (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on May 1, 2014)
10.17    Amendment No. 7 to the Senior Secured Revolving Credit Agreement, dated as of March 5, 2015, by and among the Company as borrower, each of the subsidiary guarantors party thereto, the Lenders party thereto and ING Capital LLC, as Administrative Agent.*

 

160


Table of Contents
10.18    Senior Secured Term Loan Credit Agreement between THL Credit and ING Capital LLC, dated May 10, 2012 (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on May 15, 2012)
10.19    Amendment No. 1 to Senior Secured Term Loan Agreement between THL Credit and ING Capital LLC, dated February 13, 2013 (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K, filed on March 7, 2014)
10.20    Amendment No. 2 to Senior Secured Term Loan Agreement between THL Credit and ING Capital LLC, dated March 15, 2013 (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on March 20, 2013)
10.21    Amendment No. 3 to Senior Secured Term Loan Agreement between THL Credit and ING Capital LLC, dated October 9, 2013 (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q, filed on November 4, 2013)
10.22    Amendment No. 4 to the Senior Secured Term Loan Credit Agreement dated as of April 30, 2014, by and among the Company as borrower, each of the subsidiary guarantors party thereto, the Lenders party thereto and ING Capital LLC, as Administrative Agent. (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on May 1, 2014)
10.23    Amendment No. 6 to the Senior Secured Term Loan Credit Agreement dated as of March 5, 2015, by and among the Company as borrower, each of the subsidiary guarantors party thereto, the Lenders party thereto and ING Capital LLC, as Administrative Agent.*
10.24    THL Credit Logan JV LLC Limited Liability Company Agreement dated December 3, 2014 between THL Credit, Inc. and Perspecta Trident LLC (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on December 3, 2014)
11    Computation of Per Share Earnings (included in the notes to the financial statements contained in this report)
14    Code of Ethics (Incorporated by reference from the Registrant’s pre-effective Amendment No. 4 to the Registration Statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, on Form N-2, filed on April 20, 2010)
21   

Subsidiaries of the Registrant

THL Credit Holdings, Inc.—Delaware

THL Corporate Finance, Inc.—Delaware

THL Credit SBIC, L.P. —Delaware

THL Credit SBIC GP, LLC—Delaware

THL Credit AIM Media Holdings, Inc.—Delaware

THL Credit YP Holdings, Inc.—Delaware

31.1    Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934*
31.2    Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934*
31.3    Certification of Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934*
32.1    Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (18 U.S.C. 1350)*
32.2    Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (18 U.S.C. 1350)*
32.3    Certification of Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (18 U.S.C. 1350)*

 

(*) Filed herewith

 

161


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned thereunto duly authorized.

 

    THL CREDIT, INC.
Date: March 10, 2015   By:  

/S/    SAM W. TILLINGHAST        

Sam W. Tillinghast

Co-Chief Executive Officer

 

Date: March 10, 2015

  By:  

/s/    CHRISTOPHER J. FLYNN        

   

Christopher J. Flynn

Co-Chief Executive Officer

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

 

Date: March 10, 2015

  By:  

/S/    SAM W. TILLINGHAST        

Sam W. Tillinghast

Director and Co-Chief Executive Officer

(Principal Executive Officer)

Date: March 10, 2015

  By:  

/S/    CHRISTOPHER J. FLYNN        

Christopher J. Flynn

Director and Co-Chief Executive Officer

(Principal Executive Officer)

Date: March 10, 2015

  By:  

/S/    TERRENCE W. OLSON        

Terrence W. Olson

Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)

Date: March 10, 2015

  By:  

/S/    JAMES K. HUNT        

James K. Hunt

Chairman of the Board of Directors

Date: March 10, 2015

  By:  

/S/    DAVID K. DOWNES        

David K. Downes

Director

Date: March 10, 2015

  By:  

/S/    NANCY HAWTHORNE        

Nancy Hawthorne

Director

Date: March 10, 2015

  By:  

/S/    KEITH W. HUGHES        

Keith W. Hughes

Director

Date: March 10, 2015

  By:  

/S/    JOHN A. SOMMERS        

John A. Sommers

Director

Date: March 10, 2015

  By:  

/S/    DAVID P. SOUTHWELL        

David P. Southwell

Director

Date: March 10, 2015

  By:  

/S/    JAMES D. KERN        

James D. Kern

Director

 

162